Digi RabbitFLEX Reference manual
Below you will find brief information for Dynamic C. This manual serves as a comprehensive function reference for the Dynamic C Integrated C Development System, designed for Rabbit Microprocessors. It details a wide range of functions, from basic math and string manipulation to more advanced features like DMA, file system operations, and real-time operating system (RTOS) functions. The manual includes alphabetical and grouped listings of functions, along with detailed descriptions of each function's purpose, syntax, and usage.
Advertisement
Advertisement
Integrated C Development System
For Rabbit Microprocessors
Function Reference
Manual
019–0113_N
Dynamic C Function Reference Manual
Part Number 019-0113 • Printed in U.S.A.
Digi International Inc.
©
2007-2010 • All rights reserved.
Digi International Inc reserves the right to make changes and improvements to its products without providing notice.
Trademarks
RabbitSys™ is a trademark of Digi International Inc.
Rabbit and Dynamic C
®
are registered trademarks of Digi International Inc.
Windows
®
is a registered trademark of Microsoft Corporation
The latest revision of this manual is available at www.rabbit.com
.
ii
Table of Contents
Alphabetical Listing of Dynamic C Functions
Group Listing of Dynamic C Functions
Chapter 1: Function Descriptions
Dynamic C Function Reference rabbit.com
iii
iv rabbit.com
Alphabetical Listing of Dynamic C Functions
New releases of Dynamic C often contain new API functions. You can check if your version of Dynamic C contains a particular function by checking the Function Lookup feature in the Help menu. If you see functions described in this manual that you want but do not have, please consider updating your version of
Dynamic C. To update Dynamic C, go to: www.rabbit.com/products/dc/ or call 1.530.757.8400.
Symbols
_GetSysMacroIndex
.....................................178
_GetSysMacroValue
.....................................179
_sysIsSoftReset
...........................................517
_xalloc
.......................................................542
_xavail
.......................................................545
A
abs
................................................................2
acos
...............................................................2
acot
...............................................................3
acsc
...............................................................3
AESdecrypt4x4
...............................................4
AESdecryptStream4x4_CBC
..............................5
AESencrypt4x4
...............................................6
AESencryptStream4x4_CBC
..............................7
AESexpandKey4
..............................................8
AESinitStream4x4
...........................................9
asec
.............................................................10
asin atan
.............................................................10
.............................................................11
atan2 atof
...........................................................12
.............................................................13
atoi
..............................................................14
atol
..............................................................15
B
BIT bit
.............................................................17
...............................................................16
BitRdPortE
...................................................18
BitRdPortI
....................................................19
BitWrPortE
...................................................20
BitWrPortI
....................................................21
C
CalculateECC256
...........................................22
ceil
..............................................................24
ChkCorrectECC256
........................................23
chkHardReset
................................................25
chkSoftReset
.................................................25
chkWDTO
....................................................26
clockDoublerOff
............................................27
clockDoublerOn
............................................27
CloseInputCompressedFile
..............................28
CloseOutputCompressedFile
............................28
CoBegin
.......................................................29
cof_pktAreceive
............................................29
cof_pktAsend
................................................30
cof_pktBreceive
.............................................29
cof_pktBsend
................................................30
cof_pktCreceive
.............................................29
cof_pktCsend
................................................30
cof_pktDreceive
............................................29
cof_pktDsend
................................................30
cof_pktEreceive
.............................................29
cof_pktEsend
................................................30
cof_pktFreceive
.............................................29
cof_pktFsend
................................................30
cof_serAgetc
.................................................31
cof_serAgets
.................................................32
cof_serAputc
.................................................33
cof_serAputs
.................................................34
cof_serAread
.................................................35
cof_serAwrite
................................................36
cof_serBgetc
.................................................31
cof_serBgets
.................................................32
cof_serBputc
.................................................33
cof_serBputs
.................................................34
cof_serBread
.................................................35
cof_serBwrite
................................................36
cof_serCgetc
.................................................31
cof_serCgets
.................................................32
cof_serCputc
.................................................33
cof_serCputs
.................................................34
cof_serCread
.................................................35
cof_serCwrite
................................................36
cof_serDgetc
.................................................31
cof_serDgets
.................................................32
cof_serDputc
.................................................33
cof_serDputs
.................................................34
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
v
cof_serDread
.................................................35
cof_serDwrite
................................................36
cof_serEgetc cof_serEgets
.................................................31
.................................................32
cof_serEputc
.................................................33
cof_serEputs cof_serEread
.................................................34
.................................................35
cof_serEwrite
................................................36
cof_serFgetc
.................................................31
cof_serFgets
..................................................32
cof_serFputc cof_serFputs
.................................................33
.................................................34
cof_serFread cof_serFwrite
.................................................35
................................................36
CompressFile
CoPause
................................................37
.......................................................38
CoReset
.......................................................38
CoResume
....................................................39
cos
..............................................................40
cosh
.............................................................40
D
DecompressFile
.............................................41
defineErrorHandler
.........................................42
deg
..............................................................43
DelayMs
DelaySec
......................................................43
......................................................44
DelayTicks
...................................................45
Disable_HW_WDT
........................................45
DMAalloc
....................................................47
DMAcompleted
.............................................48
DMAhandle2chan
DMAioe2mem
..........................................49
..............................................50
DMAioi2mem
...............................................52
DMAloadBufDesc
DMAmatchSetup
.........................................53
...........................................54
DMAmem2ioe
DMAmem2ioi
..............................................55
...............................................56
DMAmem2mem
............................................57
DMApoll
......................................................58
DMAprintBufDesc
.........................................59
DMAprintRegs
..............................................60
DMAsetBufDesc
............................................61
DMAsetDirect
...............................................62
DMAsetParameters
DMAstartAuto
........................................63
..............................................64
DMAstartDirect
.............................................65
DMAstop
.....................................................66
DMAstopDirect
.............................................67
DMAtimerSetup
DMAunalloc
............................................67
.................................................68
E
enableIObus
..................................................69
vi rabbit.com
errlogFormatEntry
..........................................71
errlogFormatRegDump errlogFormatStackDump
...................................72
.................................72
errlogGetHeaderInfo
.......................................70
errlogGetMessage
..........................................73
errlogGetNthEntry errlogReadHeader
.........................................71
..........................................73
error_message
...............................................74
exception
......................................................75
exit
..............................................................76
exp
..............................................................76
F
fabs
.............................................................77
fat_AutoMount
..............................................78
fat_Close
......................................................81
fat_CreateDir
................................................82
fat_CreateFile
................................................83
fat_CreateTime
..............................................84
fat_Delete
.....................................................85
fat_EnumDevice
............................................86
fat_EnumPartition
..........................................87
fat_FileSize
..................................................88
fat_FormatDevice
..........................................89
fat_FormatPartition fat_GetAttr
........................................90
fat_Free
........................................................91
...................................................92
fat_GetName
.................................................93
fat_GetPartition
.............................................94
fat_Init
.........................................................95
fat_InitUCOSMutex
.......................................96
fat_IsClosed
..................................................97
fat_IsOpen
....................................................98
fat_LastAccess fat_LastWrite
..............................................99
..............................................100
fat_MountPartition
.......................................101
fat_Open
....................................................102
fat_OpenDir
................................................104
fat_PartitionDevice
.......................................105
fat_Read
.....................................................106
fat_ReadDir
................................................107
fat_Seek
.....................................................109
fat_SetAttr
..................................................111
fat_Split fat_Status
.....................................................112
...................................................113
fat_SyncFile
................................................114
fat_SyncPartition fat_Tell
.........................................115
......................................................116
fat_tick
......................................................117
fat_Truncate
................................................118
fat_UnmountDevice fat_UnmountPartition
.....................................119
...................................120
fat_Write
....................................................121
fat_xRead
........................................... 122
,
Dynamic C Functions
fat_xWrite
..................................................124
fclose
.........................................................125
fcreate
........................................................126
fcreate (FS2)
...............................................127
fcreate_unused
............................................128
fcreate_unused (FS2)
....................................129
fdelete
........................................................130
fdelete (FS2) fflush (FS2)
...............................................131
................................................132
fftcplx
........................................................133
fftcplxinv
....................................................134
fftreal
.........................................................135
fftrealinv
....................................................136
flash_erasechip
............................................137
flash_erasesector
..........................................138
flash_gettype
...............................................139
flash_init
....................................................140
flash_read
...................................................141
flash_readsector
...........................................142
flash_sector2xwindow
..................................143
flash_writesector
..........................................144
floor
..........................................................145
fmod
..........................................................145
fopen_rd (FS1) fopen_rd (FS2)
............................................146
............................................147
fopen_wr
....................................................148
fopen_wr (FS2)
...........................................149
forceSoftReset
.............................................150
fread
..........................................................150
fread (FS2)
.................................................151
frexp
..........................................................152
fs_format (FS1) fs_format (FS2)
...........................................153
...........................................154
fs_get_flash_lx (FS2)
....................................160
fs_get_lx (FS2)
............................................161
fs_get_lx_size (FS2)
.....................................162
fs_get_other_lx (FS2) fs_get_ram_lx (FS2)
...................................163
.....................................164
fs_init (FS1)
................................................155
fs_init (FS2)
................................................156
fs_reserve_blocks (FS1) fs_set_lx (FS2)
................................157
............................................165
fs_setup (FS2)
.............................................166
fs_sync (FS2) fsck
..............................................168
...........................................................157
fseek (FS1) fseek (FS2)
.................................................158
.................................................159
fshift
..........................................................171
ftell (FS1)
...................................................169
ftell (FS2)
...................................................170
ftoa
...........................................................175
fwrite (FS1)
................................................173
fwrite (FS2)
................................................174
Dynamic C Functions
G
get_cpu_frequency
.......................................176
getchar
.......................................................175
getcrc
........................................................176
getdivider19200
...........................................177
gets
...........................................................177
GetVectExtern2000
......................................180
GetVectExtern3000
......................................181
GetVectIntern
..............................................182
gps_get_position
..........................................182
gps_get_utc
................................................183
gps_ground_distance
....................................183
H
hanncplx hannreal
....................................................184
.....................................................185
HDLCabortE
...............................................186
HDLCabortF
...............................................186
HDLCcloseE
...............................................186
HDLCcloseF
...............................................186
HDLCdropE
...............................................187
HDLCdropF
................................................187
HDLCerrorE
...............................................187
HDLCerrorF
...............................................187
HDLCextClockE
.........................................188
HDLCextClockF
..........................................188
HDLCopenE
...............................................189
HDLCopenF
HDLCpeekE
...............................................189
...............................................190
HDLCpeekF
...............................................190
HDLCreceiveE
............................................191
HDLCreceiveF
............................................191
HDLCsendE
...............................................192
HDLCsendF
................................................192
HDLCsendingE
HDLCsendingF
...........................................193
...........................................193
hexstrtobyte
................................................193
hitwd
.........................................................194
htoa
...........................................................194
I
i2c_check_ack
.............................................206
i2c_init
......................................................207
i2c_read_char
..............................................207
i2c_send_ack i2c_send_nak
..............................................208
..............................................208
i2c_start_tx
.................................................209
i2c_startw_tx i2c_stop_tx
..............................................210
.................................................211
i2c_write_char
.............................................211
IntervalMs
..................................................195
IntervalSec
IntervalTick
.................................................195
................................................196
rabbit.com
vii
ipres ipset
..........................................................196
..........................................................197
isalnum isalpha
......................................................197
.......................................................198
iscntrl
........................................................198
isCoDone
...................................................199
isCoRunning
...............................................199
isdigit
........................................................200
isgraph
.......................................................201
islower
.......................................................201
isprint ispunct
........................................................202
.......................................................203
isspace
.......................................................202
isupper
.......................................................204
isxdigit
.......................................................204
itoa
............................................................205
K
kbhit
..........................................................212
L
labs ldexp
...........................................................212
.........................................................213
log
............................................................213
log_clean
....................................................214
log_close
....................................................215
log_condition log_format
..............................................216
..................................................217
log_map
.....................................................218
log_next
.....................................................219
log_open log_put
....................................................220
log_prev
.....................................................221
......................................................222
log_seek
.....................................................223
log10
.........................................................224
longjmp
......................................................224
loophead loopinit
....................................................225
......................................................225
lsqrt
...........................................................226
ltoa
............................................................226
ltoan
..........................................................227
lx_format
....................................................228
M
mbr_CreatePartition mbr_EnumDevice
.....................................229
........................................230
mbr_FormatDevice
.......................................231
mbr_MountPartition
.....................................232
mbr_UnmountPartition
..................................233
mbr_ValidatePartitions
..................................234
md5_append md5_finish
...............................................235
.................................................236
md5_ini
......................................................235
viii memchr
......................................................237
memcmp
....................................................238
memcpy
.....................................................239
memmove
...................................................240
memset mktime
......................................................241
......................................................242
mktm
.........................................................243
modf
..........................................................244
N
nf_eraseBlock
.............................................245
nf_getPageCount
.........................................246
nf_getPageSize
............................................247
nf_initDevice
..............................................248
nf_InitDriver
...............................................250
nf_isBusyRBHW nf_isBusyStatus
.........................................251
...........................................252
nf_readPage
................................................253
nf_writePage
...............................................254
nf_XD_Detect
.............................................255
O
OpenInputCompressedFile
.............................256
OpenOutputCompressedFile
OS_ENTER_CRITICAL
...............................258
OS_EXIT_CRITICAL
..................................258
OSFlagAccept
.............................................259
OSFlagCreate
..............................................261
OSFlagDel
..................................................262
OSFlagPend
................................................263
OSFlagPost
.................................................265
OSFlagQuery
..............................................266
OSInit
........................................................267
OSMboxAccept
...........................................267
OSMboxCreate
............................................268
OSMboxDel
................................................269
OSMboxPend
..............................................270
OSMboxPost
...............................................271
OSMboxPostOpt
..........................................272
OSMboxQuery
............................................273
OSMemCreate
.............................................274
OSMemGet
................................................275
OSMemPut
.................................................276
OSMemQuery
.............................................277
OSMutexAccept
..........................................278
OSMutexCreate
...........................................279
OSMutexDel
...............................................280
OSMutexPend
.............................................281
OSMutexPost
..............................................282
OSMutexQuery
...........................................283
OSQAccept
.................................................284
OSQCreate
OSQDel
.................................................285
.....................................................286
OSQFlush
...................................................287
rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
OSQPend
OSQPost
...................................................288
....................................................289
OSQPostFront
.............................................290
OSQPostOpt
...............................................291
OSQQuery
..................................................292
OSSchedLock
.............................................293
OSSchedUnlock
..........................................293
OSSemAccept
.............................................294
OSSemCreate
..............................................295
OSSemPend
................................................295
OSSemPost
.................................................296
OSSemQuery
..............................................297
OSSetTickPerSec
.........................................298
OSStart
......................................................298
OSStatInit
...................................................299
OSTaskChangePrio
OSTaskCreate
......................................299
.............................................300
OSTaskCreateExt
.........................................301
OSTaskCreateHook
......................................302
OSTaskDel
.................................................303
OSTaskDelHook
..........................................304
OSTaskDelReq
............................................305
OSTaskIdleHook
.........................................306
OSTaskQuery
..............................................306
OSTaskResume
OSTaskStatHook
...........................................307
.........................................307
OSTaskStkChk
............................................308
OSTaskSuspend
...........................................309
OSTaskSwHook
OSTCBInitHook
..........................................310
..........................................310
OSTimeDly
................................................311
OSTimeDlyHMSM
......................................312
OSTimeDlyResume
......................................313
OSTimeDlySec
............................................314
OSTimeGet
.................................................315
OSTimeSet
.................................................315
OSTimeTick
...............................................316
OSTimeTickHook
........................................316
OSVersion
..................................................317
outchrs
.......................................................317
outstr
.........................................................318
P
paddr
.........................................................319
paddrDS
.....................................................320
paddrSS
.....................................................321
palloc
.........................................................322
palloc_fast
..................................................323
pavail
.........................................................324
pavail_fast
..................................................325
pcalloc
.......................................................326
pfirst
..........................................................327
pfirst_fast
...................................................328
pfree
..........................................................329
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
pfree_fast phwm
...................................................330
........................................................331
pktAclose
...................................................332
pktAgetErrors
..............................................332
pktAinitBuffers pktAopen
...........................................333
...................................................334
pktAreceive
................................................336
pktAsend
....................................................337
pktAsending
................................................338
pktAsetParity pktBclose
..............................................338
...................................................332
pktBgetErrors
..............................................332
pktBinitBuffers
............................................333
pktBopen
....................................................334
pktBreceive pktBsend
................................................336
....................................................337
pktBsending
................................................338
pktBsetParity pktCclose
..............................................338
...................................................332
pktCgetErrors
..............................................332
pktCinitBuffers
............................................333
pktCopen
....................................................334
pktCreceive pktCsend
................................................336
....................................................337
pktCsending
................................................338
pktCsetParity pktDclose
..............................................338
...................................................332
pktDgetErrors
..............................................332
pktDinitBuffers pktDopen
...........................................333
...................................................334
pktDreceive
................................................336
pktDsend
....................................................337
pktDsending
................................................338
pktDsetParity pktEclose
..............................................338
...................................................332
pktEgetErrors
..............................................332
pktEinitBuffers
............................................333
pktEopen
....................................................334
pktEreceive
.................................................336
pktEsend
....................................................337
pktEsending
................................................338
pktEsetParity
...............................................338
pktFclose
....................................................332
pktFgetErrors
..............................................332
pktFinitBuffers
............................................333
pktFopen
....................................................334
pktFreceive
.................................................336
pktFsend
....................................................337
pktFsending
................................................338
pktFsetParity
...............................................338
plast
..........................................................339
plast_fast
....................................................340
pmovebetween
............................................341
pmovebetween_fast
......................................343
ix
pnel
...........................................................344
pnext
.........................................................345
pnext_fast
...................................................346
poly
...........................................................347
pool_append
...............................................348
pool_init
.....................................................349
pool_link
....................................................350
pool_xappend
..............................................351
pool_xinit
...................................................352
pow
...........................................................353
pow10
........................................................353
powerspectrum pprev
............................................354
.........................................................355
pprev_fast
...................................................356
pputlast
......................................................357
pputlast_fast
................................................358
premain
......................................................358
preorder printf
.....................................................359
.........................................................361
putchar
.......................................................367
puts
...........................................................367
pwm_init
....................................................368
pwm_set
.....................................................369
pxalloc
.......................................................370
pxalloc_fast pxcalloc
................................................371
.....................................................372
pxfirst
........................................................373
pxfirst_fast pxfree
.................................................374
........................................................375
pxfree_fast
..................................................376
pxlast
.........................................................377
pxlast_fast
..................................................378
pxnext
........................................................379
pxnext_fast
.................................................380
pxprev
.......................................................381
pxprev_fast
.................................................382
Q
qd_error qd_init
.....................................................383
.......................................................384
qd_read
......................................................385
qd_zero
......................................................385
qsort
..........................................................386
R
rad
............................................................387
rand
...........................................................387
randb
.........................................................388
randg
.........................................................388
RdPortE
RdPortI
.....................................................389
......................................................390
read_rtc
......................................................392
read_rtc_32kHz
...........................................392
ReadCompressedFile
....................................391
x rabbit.com
readUserBlock
.............................................393
readUserBlockArray
.....................................394
registry_enumerate
.......................................395
registry_finish_read
......................................398
registry_finish_write
.....................................399
registry_get
.................................................397
registry_prep_read registry_prep_write
.......................................400
......................................403
registry_read
...............................................405
registry_update
............................................406
registry_write
..............................................407
RES
..........................................................411
res
.............................................................411
ResetErrorLog
.............................................412
root2vram
...................................................412
root2xmem rtc_timezone
.................................................413
...............................................414
runwatch
....................................................415
S
sdspi_debounce sdspi_get_scr
...........................................415
sdspi_get_csd
..............................................416
..............................................417
sdspi_get_status_reg
.....................................418
sdspi_getSectorCount sdspi_init_card
...................................418
............................................419
sdspi_initDevice
..........................................420
sdspi_isWriting
...........................................421
sdspi_notbusy
..............................................421
sdspi_print_dev
...........................................422
sdspi_process_command
...............................423
sdspi_read_sector
.........................................424
sdspi_reset_card sdspi_sendingAP
..........................................425
.........................................426
sdspi_set_block_length
.................................427
sdspi_setLED
..............................................426
sdspi_write_sector
........................................429
sdspi_WriteContinue serAclose
....................................428
...................................................448
serAdatabits
................................................448
serAdmaOff
................................................449
serAdmaOn
.................................................450
serAflowcontrolOff
......................................451
serAflowcontrolOn
.......................................452
serAgetc
.....................................................453
serAgetError
...............................................454
serAopen
....................................................455
serAparity
...................................................456
serApeek
....................................................457
serAputc
.....................................................458
serAputs
.....................................................459
serArdFlush
................................................460
serArdFree
..................................................460
serArdUsed
.................................................461
Dynamic C Functions
serAread
.....................................................462
serAwrFlush serAwrFree
...............................................463
.................................................463
serAwrite
....................................................464
serAwrUsed
................................................465
serBclose
....................................................448
serBdatabits serBdmaOff
................................................448
................................................449
serBdmaOn
.................................................450
serBflowcontrolOff serBflowcontrolOn
......................................451
.......................................452
serBgetc
.....................................................453
serBgetError serBopen
...............................................454
....................................................455
serBparity
...................................................456
serBpeek
....................................................457
serBputc
.....................................................458
serBputs
.....................................................459
serBrdFlush serBrdFree
................................................460
..................................................460
serBrdUsed
.................................................461
serBread
.....................................................462
serBwrFlush
................................................463
serBwrFree
.................................................463
serBwrite
....................................................464
serBwrUsed
................................................465
serCclose
....................................................448
serCdatabits serCdmaOff
................................................448
................................................449
serCdmaOn
.................................................450
serCflowcontrolOff serCflowcontrolOn
......................................451
.......................................452
serCgetc
.....................................................453
serCgetError serCopen
...............................................454
....................................................455
serCparity
...................................................456
serCpeek
....................................................457
serCputc
.....................................................458
serCputs
.....................................................459
serCrdFlush serCrdFree
................................................460
..................................................460
serCrdUsed
.................................................461
serCread
.....................................................462
serCwrFlush
................................................463
serCwrFree
.................................................463
serCwrite
....................................................464
serCwrUsed
................................................465
serDclose
....................................................448
serDdatabits
................................................448
serDdmaOff
................................................449
serDdmaOn
.................................................450
serDflowcontrolOff
......................................451
serDflowcontrolOn
.......................................452
serDgetc
.....................................................453
Dynamic C Functions serDgetError
...............................................454
serDopen
....................................................455
serDparity
...................................................456
serDpeek
....................................................457
serDputc
.....................................................458
serDputs
.....................................................459
serDrdFlush
................................................460
serDrdFree
..................................................460
serDrdUsed
.................................................461
serDread
.....................................................462
serDwrFlush serDwrFree
...............................................463
.................................................463
serDwrite
...................................................464
serDwrUsed
................................................465
serEclose
....................................................448
serEdatabits serEdmaOff
................................................448
................................................449
serEdmaOn
.................................................450
serEflowcontrolOff serEflowcontrolOn
......................................451
.......................................452
serEgetc
.....................................................453
serEgetError
................................................454
serEopen
....................................................455
serEparity
...................................................456
serEpeek serEputc
....................................................457
.....................................................458
serEputs
.....................................................459
serErdFlush
................................................460
serErdFree
..................................................460
serErdUsed
.................................................461
serEread
.....................................................462
serEwrFlush
................................................463
serEwrFree
.................................................463
serEwrite
....................................................464
serEwrUsed serFclose
................................................465
....................................................448
serFdatabits serFdmaOff
................................................448
................................................449
serFdmaOn
.................................................450
serFflowcontrolOff
.......................................451
serFflowcontrolOn serFgetc
.......................................452
.....................................................453
serFgetError
................................................454
serFopen serFparity
....................................................455
...................................................456
serFpeek
.....................................................457
serFputc serFputs
.....................................................458
.....................................................459
serFrdFlush
.................................................460
serFrdFree
..................................................460
serFrdUsed serFread
.................................................461
.....................................................462
serFwrFlush
................................................463
serFwrFree
.................................................463
rabbit.com
xi
serFwrite
....................................................464
serFwrUsed
.................................................465
servo_alloc_table
.........................................430
servo_closedloop servo_disable_0
.........................................430
...........................................431
servo_disable_1
...........................................432
servo_enable_0
............................................433
servo_enable_1
............................................434
servo_gear
..................................................435
servo_graph servo_init
................................................437
...................................................438
servo_millirpm2vcmd
...................................438
servo_move_to servo_openloop
............................................439
...........................................440
servo_qd_zero_0
..........................................441
servo_qd_zero_1
..........................................441
servo_read_table
..........................................442
servo_set_coeffs
..........................................443
servo_set_pos
..............................................444
servo_set_vel
..............................................445
servo_stats_reset
..........................................445
servo_torque serXdatabits
...............................................446
................................................448
serXdmaOff
................................................449
serXdmaOn
.................................................450
serXflowcontrolOff
......................................451
serXflowcontrolOn
.......................................452
serXgetc
.....................................................453
serXgetError serXpeek
...............................................454
serXparity
...................................................456
....................................................457
serXputc
.....................................................458
serXputs
.....................................................459
serXrdFlush
................................................460
serXrdFree
..................................................460
serXrdUsed
.................................................461
serXread
.....................................................462
serXwrFlush serXwrFree
...............................................463
.................................................463
serXwrite
....................................................464
serXwrUsed
................................................465
SET
...........................................................466
set
.............................................................466
set_cpu_power_mode set32kHzDivider
...................................469
..........................................467
setClockModulation
.....................................468
setjmp
........................................................471
SetSerialTATxRValues
.................................472
SetVectExtern2000
.......................................473
SetVectExtern3000
.......................................474
SetVectExtern4000
.......................................475
SetVectIntern
..............................................476
sf_getPageCount
..........................................478
sf_getPageSize
............................................478
xii sf_init
........................................................479
sf_initDevice
...............................................480
sf_isWriting
................................................481
sf_pageToRAM
...........................................481
sf_RAMToPage
...........................................482
sf_readDeviceRAM
......................................483
sf_readPage sf_readRAM
................................................484
...............................................485
sf_writeDeviceRAM
.....................................486
sf_writePage sf_writeRAM
...............................................487
..............................................488
sfspi_init
....................................................488
sin
.............................................................489
sinh
...........................................................489
snprintf
SPIinit
......................................................490
.......................................................491
SPIRead
.....................................................492
SPIWrite
....................................................493
SPIWrRd
....................................................494
sprintf
........................................................495
sqrt
............................................................496
srand strcat
.........................................................496
.........................................................497
strchr
.........................................................498
strcmp
........................................................499
strcmpi
.......................................................500
strcpy strcspn
........................................................501
.......................................................502
strlen
.........................................................503
strncat
........................................................504
strncmp
......................................................505
strncmpi
.....................................................506
strncpy
.......................................................507
strpbrk
.......................................................508
strrchr
........................................................509
strspn
.........................................................510
strstr
..........................................................511
strtod
.........................................................512
strtok
.........................................................514
strtol
..........................................................515
sysResetChain
.............................................517
T
tan
.............................................................518
tanh
...........................................................519
TAT1R_SetValue
........................................520
tm_rd
.........................................................521
tm_wr
........................................................522
tolower toupper
......................................................523
......................................................523
U
updateTimers use32kHzOsc
..............................................524
..............................................524
rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
useClockDivider
..........................................525
useClockDivider3000
...................................526
useMainOsc
................................................527
utoa
...........................................................527
V
VdGetFreeWd
.............................................529
VdInit
........................................................530
VdReleaseWd
.............................................531
vram2root
...................................................528
W
write_rtc
.....................................................534
WriteFlash2
................................................532
WriteFlash2Array
........................................533
writeUserBlock
............................................535
writeUserBlockArray
....................................537
WrPortE
.....................................................539
WrPortI
......................................................540
X
xalloc
.........................................................541
xalloc_stats
.................................................543
xavail
.........................................................544
xCalculateECC256
.......................................546
xChkCorrectECC256
....................................547
xgetfloat
.....................................................548
xgetint
.......................................................548
xgetlong
.....................................................549
xmem2root
.................................................550
xmem2xmem
..............................................551
xmemchr
....................................................552
xmemcmp
...................................................553
xrelease
......................................................554
xsetfloat
.....................................................555
xsetint
........................................................555
xsetlong
.....................................................556
xstrlen
........................................................556
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
xiii
xiv rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
Group Listing of Dynamic C Functions
New releases of Dynamic C often contain new API functions. You can check if your version of Dynamic C contains a particular function by checking the Function Lookup feature in the Help menu. If you see functions described in this manual that you want but do not have, please consider updating your version of
Dynamic C. To update Dynamic C, go to: www.rabbit.com/products/dc/ or call 1.530.757.8400.
A
Arithmetic
B abs
..........................................................2
getcrc ..................................................176
lsqrt ....................................................226
D
ispunct ................................................203
isspace ................................................202
isupper ................................................204
isxdigit
...............................................204
Bit Manipulation
BIT
.......................................................17
bit .........................................................16
RES ....................................................411
res ......................................................411
SET ....................................................466
set ......................................................466
Data Encryption
AESdecrypt4x4
.......................................4
AESdecryptStream4x4_CBC
AESencrypt4x4
.......................................6
AESencryptStream4x4_CBC
AESexpandKey4 .....................................8
AESinitStream4x4 ...................................9
Bus Operation (Rabbit 3000, 4000)
C disableIObus
.........................................46
enableIObus ..........................................69
Character
isalnum ...............................................197
isalpha
................................................198
iscntrl .................................................198
isdigit .................................................200
isgraph
................................................201
islower
................................................201
isprint .................................................202
Direct Memory Access (Rabbit 4000,
5000)
DMAalloc .............................................47
DMAcompleted
.....................................48
DMAhandle2chan .................................49
DMAioe2mem ......................................50
DMAioi2mem
.......................................52
DMAloadBufDesc
.................................53
DMAmatchSetup
...................................54
DMAmem2ioe ......................................55
DMAmem2ioi
.......................................56
DMAmem2mem ...................................57
DMApoll
..............................................58
DMAprintBufDesc
................................59
DMAprintRegs
......................................60
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
xv
DMAsetBufDesc ...................................61
DMAsetDirect
.......................................62
DMAsetParameters
................................63
DMAstartAuto
......................................64
DMAstartDirect
....................................65
DMAstop
..............................................66
DMAstopDirect .....................................67
DMAtimerSetup
....................................67
DMAunalloc
.........................................68
serAdmaOff ........................................449
serAdmaOn
.........................................450
serBdmaOff ........................................449
serBdmaOn
.........................................450
serCdmaOff ........................................449
serCdmaOn
.........................................450
serDdmaOff ........................................449
serDdmaOn
.........................................450
serEdmaOff
.........................................449
serEdmaOn
.........................................450
serFdmaOff
.........................................449
serFdmaOn
.........................................450
serXdmaOff ........................................449
serXdmaOn
.........................................450
Dynamic Memory Allocation
palloc ..................................................322
palloc_fast ..........................................323
pavail ..................................................324
pavail_fast ..........................................325
pcalloc
................................................326
pfirst
...................................................327
pfirst_fast
............................................328
pfree
...................................................329
pfree_fast
............................................330
phwm .................................................331
plast ....................................................339
plast_fast ............................................340
pmovebetween
....................................341
pmovebetween_fast
.............................343
xvi pnel
....................................................344
pnext ..................................................345
pnext_fast ...........................................346
pool_append
........................................348
pool_init
.............................................349
pool_link
............................................350
pool_xappend
......................................351
pool_xinit ...........................................352
pprev ..................................................355
pprev_fast ...........................................356
pputlast
...............................................357
pputlast_fast
........................................358
preorder ..............................................359
pxalloc ................................................370
pxalloc_fast .........................................371
pxcalloc ..............................................372
pxfirst
.................................................373
pxfirst_fast
..........................................374
pxfree
.................................................375
pxfree_fast
..........................................376
pxlast
..................................................377
pxlast_fast
...........................................378
pxnext ................................................379
pxnext_fast .........................................380
pxprev ................................................381
pxprev_fast .........................................382
E
ECC
CalculateECC256 ..................................22
ChkCorrectECC256 ...............................23
xCalculateECC256
..............................546
xChkCorrectECC256 ...........................547
Error Handling
errlogFormatEntry .................................71
errlogFormatRegDump ..........................72
errlogFormatStackDump ........................72
errlogGetHeaderInfo
..............................70
rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
errlogGetMessage
..................................73
errlogGetNthEntry .................................71
errlogReadHeader
..................................73
error_message .......................................74
exception ..............................................75
ResetErrorLog .....................................412
Extended Memory
_xalloc
................................................542
_xavail
................................................545
paddr
..................................................319
paddrDS
.............................................320
paddrSS
..............................................321
root2xmem
..........................................413
xalloc ..................................................541
xalloc_stats
.........................................543
xavail ..................................................544
xgetfloat
.............................................548
xgetint
................................................548
xgetlong
..............................................549
xmem2root
..........................................550
xmem2xmem
......................................551
xmemchr .............................................552
xmemcmp
...........................................553
xrelease
..............................................554
xsetfloat
..............................................555
xsetint
.................................................555
xsetlong
..............................................556
xstrlen
.................................................556
F
Fast Fourier Transforms
fftcplx
.................................................133
fftcplxinv
............................................134
fftreal ..................................................135
fftrealinv .............................................136
hanncplx .............................................184
hannreal
..............................................185
powerspectrum
....................................354
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
File Compression
CloseInputCompressedFile .....................28
CloseOutputCompressedFile
CompressFile ........................................37
DecompressFile
.....................................41
OpenInputCompressedFile ...................256
OpenOutputCompressedFile .................257
ReadCompressedFile
...........................391
File System, FAT
fat_AutoMount
......................................78
fat_Close
..............................................81
fat_CreateDir ........................................82
fat_CreateFile
.......................................83
fat_CreateTime
.....................................84
fat_Delete .............................................85
fat_EnumDevice ....................................86
fat_EnumPartition .................................87
fat_FileSize ...........................................88
fat_FormatDevice ..................................89
fat_FormatPartition
................................90
fat_Free ................................................91
fat_GetAttr ............................................92
fat_GetName .........................................93
fat_GetPartition
.....................................94
fat_Init ..................................................95
fat_InitUCOSMutex
..............................96
fat_IsClosed
..........................................97
fat_IsOpen
............................................98
fat_LastAccess ......................................99
fat_LastWrite ......................................100
fat_MountPartition
..............................101
fat_Open
.............................................102
fat_OpenDir
........................................104
fat_PartitionDevice
..............................105
fat_Read
.............................................106
fat_ReadDir
........................................107
fat_Seek ..............................................109
fat_SetAttr
..........................................111
xvii
fat_Split fat_Status
...............................................116
...............................................117
fat_UnmountDevice fat_UnmountPartition
..............................................112
fat_xRead
............................................113
........................................114
.................................115
........................................118
.............................119
............................................121
...................................122, 123
...........................................124
fs_get_lx
.............................................161
fs_get_lx_size
.....................................162
fs_get_other_lx
...................................163
fs_get_ram_lx
.....................................164
fs_init
.................................................156
fs_set_lx .............................................165
fs_setup ..............................................166
fs_sync
...............................................168
fseek ...................................................159
fshift ...................................................171
ftell .....................................................170
fwrite
..................................................174
lx_format ............................................228
File System, FS1
fcreate
.................................................126
fcreate_unused
....................................128
fdelete
.................................................130
fopen_rd .............................................146
fopen_wr ............................................148
fread
...................................................150
fs_format ............................................153
fs_init .................................................155
fs_reserve_blocks
................................157
fsck ....................................................157
fseek
...................................................158
ftell
.....................................................169
fwrite ..................................................173
File System, Registry
registry_enumerate
registry_finish_write
registry_get .........................................397
registry_prep_read
registry_write
..............................395
.............................398
............................399
...............................400
..............................403
.......................................405
....................................406
......................................407
File System, FS2
fclose ..................................................125
fcreate
.................................................127
fcreate_unused
....................................129
fdelete
.................................................131
fflush ..................................................132
fopen_rd .............................................147
fopen_wr ............................................149
fread
...................................................151
fs_format ............................................154
fs_get_flash_lx
....................................160
xviii
Flash, NAND
nf_eraseBlock
.....................................245
nf_getPageCount
.................................246
nf_getPageSize
nf_isBusyRBHW nf_isBusyStatus nf_readPage
....................................247
......................................248
.......................................250
.................................251
...................................252
........................................253
.......................................254
nf_XD_Detect
.....................................255
Flash, Parallel
flash_erasechip
....................................137
flash_erasesector .................................138
rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
flash_gettype
.......................................139
flash_init .............................................140
flash_read
...........................................141
flash_readsector ..................................142
flash_sector2xwindow .........................143
flash_writesector .................................144
WriteFlash2 ........................................532
WriteFlash2Array
................................533
Flash, SD
sdspi_debounce ...................................415
sdspi_get_csd ......................................416
sdspi_get_scr
.......................................417
sdspi_get_status_reg ............................418
sdspi_getSectorCount
sdspi_init_card
....................................419
sdspi_initDevice
..................................420
sdspi_isWriting ...................................421
sdspi_notbusy ......................................421
sdspi_print_dev ...................................422
sdspi_process_command
sdspi_read_sector ................................424
sdspi_reset_card
..................................425
sdspi_sendingAP .................................426
sdspi_set_block_length
sdspi_setLED ......................................426
sdspi_write_sector
...............................429
sdspi_WriteContinue ...........................428
Flash, Serial
sf_getPageCount
.................................478
sf_getPageSize
....................................478
sf_init .................................................479
sf_initDevice
.......................................480
sf_isWriting ........................................481
sf_pageToRAM ...................................481
sf_RAMToPage ..................................482
sf_readDeviceRAM
.............................483
sf_readPage
.........................................484
Dynamic C Functions sf_readRAM
.......................................485
sf_writeDeviceRAM
............................486
sf_writePage
.......................................487
sf_writeRAM ......................................488
sfspi_init
.............................................488
Floating-Point Math
acos
........................................................2
acot
........................................................3
acsc
........................................................3
asec
......................................................10
asin .......................................................10
atan ......................................................11
atan2 ....................................................12
ceil .......................................................24
cos ........................................................40
cosh
......................................................40
deg .......................................................43
exp .......................................................76
fabs
......................................................77
floor
...................................................145
fmod ...................................................145
frexp ...................................................152
labs .....................................................212
ldexp ..................................................213
log
......................................................213
log10 ..................................................224
modf ...................................................244
poly
....................................................347
pow
....................................................353
pow10 ................................................353
rad
......................................................387
rand
....................................................387
randb
..................................................388
randg
..................................................388
sin
......................................................489
sinh ....................................................489
sqrt .....................................................496
srand ..................................................496
rabbit.com
xix
tan ......................................................518
tanh ....................................................519
G
Global Positioning System
gps_get_position
.................................182
gps_get_utc
.........................................183
gps_ground_distance ...........................183
H
I
HDLC Protocol (Rabbit 3000, 4000,
5000)
HDLCabortE
.......................................186
HDLCabortF
.......................................186
HDLCcloseE
.......................................186
HDLCcloseF
.......................................186
HDLCdropE ........................................187
HDLCdropF ........................................187
HDLCerrorE
.......................................187
HDLCerrorF .......................................187
HDLCextClockE .................................188
HDLCextClockF .................................188
HDLCopenE
.......................................189
HDLCopenF
.......................................189
HDLCpeekE .......................................190
HDLCpeekF ........................................190
HDLCreceiveE
....................................191
HDLCreceiveF
....................................191
HDLCsendE ........................................192
HDLCsendF ........................................192
HDLCsendingE ...................................193
HDLCsendingF ...................................193
I/O
BitRdPortE
...........................................18
BitRdPortI ............................................19
BitWrPortE
...........................................20
xx
BitWrPortI
............................................21
RdPortE ..............................................389
RdPortI
...............................................390
WrPortE .............................................539
WrPortI
..............................................540
I2C Protocol
i2c_check_ack .....................................206
i2c_init
...............................................207
i2c_read_char
......................................207
i2c_send_ack ......................................208
i2c_send_nak ......................................208
i2c_start_tx .........................................209
i2c_startw_tx ......................................210
i2c_stop_tx .........................................211
i2c_write_char ....................................211
Interrupts
GetVectExtern2000 .............................180
GetVectExtern3000 .............................181
GetVectIntern
.....................................182
ipres
...................................................196
ipset
....................................................197
SetVectExtern2000
..............................473
SetVectExtern3000
..............................474
SetVectExtern4000
..............................475
SetVectIntern
......................................476
L
Logging Subsystem
log_clean
............................................214
log_close
............................................215
log_condition ......................................216
log_format
..........................................217
log_map ..............................................218
log_next ..............................................219
log_open
.............................................220
log_prev .............................................221
log_put
...............................................222
rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
log_seek
.............................................223
M
MD5
md5_append ........................................235
md5_finish ..........................................236
md5_init .............................................235
MicroC/OS-II
OOSQDel
...........................................286
OS_ENTER_CRITICAL
OS_EXIT_CRITICAL
OSFlagAccept
.....................................259
OSFlagCreate ......................................261
OSFlagDel ..........................................262
OSFlagPend ........................................263
OSFlagPost
.........................................265
OSFlagQuery
......................................266
OSInit
.................................................267
OSMboxAccept ...................................267
OSMboxCreate ...................................268
OSMboxDel ........................................269
OSMboxPend ......................................270
OSMboxPost
.......................................271
OSMboxPostOpt
.................................272
OSMboxQuery
....................................273
OSMemCreate
....................................274
OSMemGet
.........................................275
OSMemPut
.........................................276
OSMemQuery
.....................................277
OSMutexAccept
..................................278
OSMutexCreate ...................................279
OSMutexDel
.......................................280
OSMutexPend .....................................281
OSMutexPost
......................................282
OSMutexQuery ...................................283
OSQAccept
.........................................284
OSQCreate
..........................................285
OSQFlush
...........................................287
Dynamic C Functions
OSQPend ............................................288
OSQPost
.............................................289
OSQPostFront
.....................................290
OSQPostOpt
.......................................291
OSQQuery
..........................................292
OSSchedLock
.....................................293
OSSchedUnlock ..................................293
OSSemAccept
.....................................294
OSSemCreate
......................................295
OSSemPend
........................................295
OSSemPost .........................................296
OSSemQuery ......................................297
OSSetTickPerSec
................................298
OSStart
...............................................298
OSStatInit ...........................................299
OSTaskChangePrio .............................299
OSTaskCreate
.....................................300
OSTaskCreateExt ................................301
OSTaskCreateHook .............................302
OSTaskDel .........................................303
OSTaskDelHook .................................304
OSTaskDelReq
...................................305
OSTaskIdleHook
.................................306
OSTaskQuery
.....................................306
OSTaskResume
...................................307
OSTaskStatHook
.................................307
OSTaskStkChk ....................................308
OSTaskSuspend ..................................309
OSTaskSwHook ..................................310
OSTCBInitHook .................................310
OSTimeDly .........................................311
OSTimeDlyHMSM .............................312
OSTimeDlyResume .............................313
OSTimeDlySec
...................................314
OSTimeGet .........................................315
OSTimeSet .........................................315
OSTimeTick
.......................................316
OSTimeTickHook ...............................316
OSVersion
..........................................317
rabbit.com
xxi
Miscellaneous
hexstrtobyte ........................................193
longjmp
..............................................224
qsort
...................................................386
runwatch .............................................415
setjmp
.................................................471
Multitasking
CoBegin
...............................................29
CoPause
................................................38
CoReset
................................................38
CoResume ............................................39
DelayMs ...............................................43
DelaySec ..............................................44
DelayTicks ............................................45
IntervalMs ..........................................195
IntervalSec ..........................................195
IntervalTick ........................................196
isCoDone
............................................199
isCoRunning
.......................................199
loophead .............................................225
loopinit ...............................................225
N
Number-to-String Conversion
ftoa
.....................................................175
htoa ....................................................194
itoa
.....................................................205
ltoa
.....................................................226
ltoan
...................................................227
utoa ....................................................527
P
Partitions
mbr_CreatePartition
.............................229
mbr_EnumDevice
................................230
mbr_FormatDevice ..............................231
mbr_MountPartition
............................232
xxii
mbr_UnmountPartition ........................233
mbr_ValidatePartitions ........................234
Pulse Width Modulation (Rabbit 3000,
4000, 5000)
pwm_init
............................................368
pwm_set
.............................................369
Q
Quadrature Decoder (Rabbit 3000, 4000,
5000)
qd_error ..............................................383
qd_init ................................................384
qd_read
...............................................385
qd_zero
...............................................385
R
Rabbit 3000, 4000
disableIObus .........................................46
enableIObus
..........................................69
servo_alloc_table
.................................430
servo_closedloop
.................................430
servo_disable_0
...................................431
servo_disable_1
...................................432
servo_enable_0
...................................433
servo_enable_1
...................................434
servo_gear
..........................................435
servo_graph ........................................437
servo_init ............................................438
servo_millirpm2vcmd ..........................438
servo_move_to ....................................439
servo_openloop
...................................440
servo_qd_zero_0 .................................441
servo_qd_zero_1 .................................441
servo_read_table .................................442
servo_set_coeffs ..................................443
servo_set_pos
......................................444
servo_set_vel ......................................445
servo_stats_reset .................................445
rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
servo_torque .......................................446
Rabbit 3000, 4000, 5000
cof_pktEreceive
....................................29
cof_pktEsend
........................................30
cof_pktFreceive .....................................29
cof_pktFsend
.........................................30
cof_serEgetc
.........................................31
cof_serEgets ..........................................32
cof_serEputc
.........................................33
cof_serEputs .........................................34
cof_serEread
.........................................35
cof_serEwrite ........................................36
cof_serFgetc ..........................................31
cof_serFgets ..........................................32
cof_serFputc .........................................33
cof_serFputs ..........................................34
cof_serFread
.........................................35
cof_serFwrite
........................................36
HDLCabortE
.......................................186
HDLCabortF
.......................................186
HDLCcloseE
.......................................186
HDLCcloseF
.......................................186
HDLCdropE ........................................187
HDLCdropF ........................................187
HDLCerrorE
.......................................187
HDLCerrorF .......................................187
HDLCextClockE .................................188
HDLCextClockF .................................188
HDLCopenE
.......................................189
HDLCopenF
.......................................189
HDLCpeekE .......................................190
HDLCpeekF ........................................190
HDLCreceiveE
....................................191
HDLCreceiveF
....................................191
HDLCsendE ........................................192
HDLCsendF ........................................192
HDLCsendingE ...................................193
HDLCsendingF ...................................193
Dynamic C Functions pwm_init
............................................368
pwm_set
.............................................369
qd_error ..............................................383
qd_init ................................................384
qd_read
...............................................385
qd_zero
...............................................385
Rabbit 4000, 5000
DMAalloc .............................................47
DMAcompleted
.....................................48
DMAhandle2chan .................................49
DMAioe2mem ......................................50
DMAioi2mem
.......................................52
DMAloadBufDesc
.................................53
DMAmatchSetup
...................................54
DMAmem2ioe ......................................55
DMAmem2ioi
.......................................56
DMAmem2mem ...................................57
DMApoll
..............................................58
DMAprintBufDesc
................................59
DMAprintRegs
......................................60
DMAsetBufDesc
...................................61
DMAsetDirect .......................................62
DMAsetParameters ................................63
DMAstartAuto ......................................64
DMAstartDirect
....................................65
DMAstop ..............................................66
DMAstopDirect
.....................................67
DMAtimerSetup ....................................67
DMAunalloc .........................................68
root2vram ...........................................412
serAdmaOff
........................................449
serAdmaOn .........................................450
serBdmaOff
........................................449
serBdmaOn .........................................450
serCdmaOff
........................................449
serCdmaOn .........................................450
serDdmaOff
........................................449
serDdmaOn .........................................450
rabbit.com
xxiii
xxiv serEdmaOff
.........................................449
serEdmaOn
.........................................450
serFdmaOff
.........................................449
serFdmaOn
.........................................450
serXdmaOff ........................................449
serXdmaOn
.........................................450
vram2root
...........................................528
Real-Time Clock
mktime ...............................................242
mktm ..................................................243
read_rtc
..............................................392
read_rtc_32kHz ...................................392
rtc_timezone .......................................414
set32kHzDivider
.................................467
tm_rd ..................................................521
tm_wr .................................................522
updateTimers
......................................524
use32kHzOsc
......................................524
write_rtc .............................................534
S
Serial Communication
cof_serAgetc
.........................................31
cof_serAgets
.........................................32
cof_serAputc
.........................................33
cof_serAputs
.........................................34
cof_serAread
.........................................35
cof_serAwrite ........................................36
cof_serBgetc
.........................................31
cof_serBgets .........................................32
cof_serBputc
.........................................33
cof_serBputs
.........................................34
cof_serBread
.........................................35
cof_serBwrite ........................................36
cof_serCgetc
.........................................31
cof_serCgets .........................................32
cof_serCputc
.........................................33
cof_serCputs
.........................................34
rabbit.com
cof_serCread .........................................35
cof_serCwrite
........................................36
cof_serDgetc .........................................31
cof_serDgets .........................................32
cof_serDputc .........................................33
cof_serDputs .........................................34
cof_serDread .........................................35
cof_serDwrite
.......................................36
cof_serEgetc
.........................................31
cof_serEgets
..........................................32
cof_serEputc .........................................33
cof_serEputs
.........................................34
cof_serEread .........................................35
cof_serEwrite
........................................36
cof_serFgetc
..........................................31
cof_serFgets
..........................................32
cof_serFputc
.........................................33
cof_serFputs
..........................................34
cof_serFread
.........................................35
cof_serFwrite ........................................36
serAclose ............................................448
serAdatabits
........................................448
serAdmaOff
........................................449
serAdmaOn .........................................450
serAflowcontrolOn
..............................452
serAgetc .............................................453
serAgetError
.......................................454
serAopen
............................................455
serAparity ...........................................456
serApeek
.............................................457
serAputc
.............................................458
serAputs .............................................459
serArdFlush
........................................460
serArdFree
..........................................460
serArdUsed .........................................461
serAread
.............................................462
serAwrFlush
........................................463
serAwrFree .........................................463
serAwrite ............................................464
Dynamic C Functions
serAwrUsed ........................................465
serBclose ............................................448
serBdatabits ........................................448
serBdmaOff ........................................449
serBdmaOn
.........................................450
serBflowcontrolOn ..............................452
serBgetc
..............................................453
serBgetError ........................................454
serBopen .............................................455
serBparity
...........................................456
serBpeek .............................................457
serBputc
.............................................458
serBputs
..............................................459
serBrdFlush
.........................................460
serBrdFree ..........................................460
serBrdUsed
.........................................461
serBread
.............................................462
serBwrFlush ........................................463
serBwrFree
.........................................463
serBwrite
............................................464
serBwrUsed ........................................465
serCclose ............................................448
serCdatabits ........................................448
serCdmaOff ........................................449
serCdmaOn
.........................................450
serCflowcontrolOn ..............................452
serCgetc
..............................................453
serCgetError ........................................454
serCheckParity
....................................447
serCopen .............................................455
serCparity
...........................................456
serCpeek .............................................457
serCputc
.............................................458
serCputs
..............................................459
serCrdFlush
.........................................460
serCrdFree ..........................................460
serCrdUsed
.........................................461
serCread
.............................................462
serCwrFlush ........................................463
Dynamic C Functions
serCwrFree .........................................463
serCwrite
............................................464
serCwrUsed
........................................465
serDclose ............................................448
serDdatabits
........................................448
serDdmaOff
........................................449
serDdmaOn .........................................450
serDflowcontrolOff .............................451
serDflowcontrolOn
..............................452
serDgetc
.............................................453
serDgetError
.......................................454
serDopen
............................................455
serDparity ...........................................456
serDpeek
.............................................457
serDputc .............................................458
serDputs .............................................459
serDrdFlush
........................................460
serDrdFree
..........................................460
serDrdUsed .........................................461
serDread
.............................................462
serDwrFlush
........................................463
serDwrFree .........................................463
serDwrite ............................................464
serDwrUsed
........................................465
serEclose
............................................448
serEdatabits .........................................448
serEdmaOff .........................................449
serEdmaOn .........................................450
serEflowcontrolOff
..............................451
serEflowcontrolOn
..............................452
serEgetc ..............................................453
serEgetError
........................................454
serEopen
.............................................455
serEparity ...........................................456
serEpeek
.............................................457
serEputc ..............................................458
serEputs ..............................................459
serErdFlush .........................................460
serErdFree
..........................................460
rabbit.com
xxv
xxvi serErdUsed
.........................................461
serEread
..............................................462
serEwrFlush ........................................463
serEwrFree
..........................................463
serEwrite ............................................464
serEwrUsed
.........................................465
serFclose .............................................448
serFdatabits
.........................................448
serFdmaOff
.........................................449
serFdmaOn
.........................................450
serFflowcontrolOff ..............................451
serFflowcontrolOn ...............................452
serFgetc
..............................................453
serFgetError ........................................454
serFopen .............................................455
serFparity
............................................456
serFpeek .............................................457
serFputc
..............................................458
serFputs
..............................................459
serFrdFlush
.........................................460
serFrdFree ...........................................460
serFrdUsed
..........................................461
serFread
..............................................462
serFwrFlush ........................................463
serFwrFree
..........................................463
serFwrite .............................................464
serFwrUsed
.........................................465
serXdatabits ........................................448
serXdmaOff ........................................449
serXdmaOn
.........................................450
serXflowcontrolOff
.............................451
serXflowcontrolOn ..............................452
serXgetc
.............................................453
serXgetError .......................................454
serXparity
...........................................456
serXpeek .............................................457
serXputc .............................................458
serXputs
.............................................459
serXrdFlush ........................................460
rabbit.com
serXrdFree
serXread
..........................................460
serXwrUsed
.........................................461
.............................................462
serXwrFlush
........................................463
.........................................463
............................................464
........................................465
Serial Packet Driver
cof_pktAreceive ....................................29
cof_pktAsend
........................................30
cof_pktBreceive ....................................29
cof_pktBsend ........................................30
cof_pktCreceive ....................................29
cof_pktCsend ........................................30
cof_pktDreceive ....................................29
cof_pktDsend
........................................30
cof_pktEreceive
....................................29
cof_pktEsend ........................................30
cof_pktFreceive
.....................................29
cof_pktFsend ........................................30
pktAclose ............................................332
pktAgetErrors
.....................................332
pktAinitBuffers
...................................333
pktAopen ............................................334
pktAreceive .........................................336
pktAsend
............................................337
pktAsending
........................................338
pktAsetParity ......................................338
pktBclose ............................................332
pktBgetErrors
......................................332
pktBinitBuffers
...................................333
pktBopen
............................................334
pktBreceive .........................................336
pktBsend
.............................................337
pktBsending
........................................338
pktBsetParity ......................................338
pktCclose ............................................332
pktCgetErrors
......................................332
Dynamic C Functions
pktCinitBuffers ...................................333
pktCopen ............................................334
pktCreceive
.........................................336
pktCsend .............................................337
pktCsending ........................................338
pktCsetParity
.......................................338
pktDclose
............................................332
pktDgetErrors ......................................332
pktDinitBuffers ...................................333
pktDopen
............................................334
pktDreceive
.........................................336
pktDsend ............................................337
pktDsending ........................................338
pktDsetParity
......................................338
pktEclose
............................................332
pktEgetErrors ......................................332
pktEinitBuffers
....................................333
pktEopen ............................................334
pktEreceive
.........................................336
pktEsend .............................................337
pktEsending ........................................338
pktEsetParity
.......................................338
pktFclose ............................................332
pktFgetErrors
......................................332
pktFinitBuffers
....................................333
pktFopen .............................................334
pktFreceive
.........................................336
pktFsend .............................................337
pktFsending ........................................338
pktFsetParity
.......................................338
Servo Control (Rabbit 3000, 4000)
servo_alloc_table .................................430
servo_closedloop .................................430
servo_disable_0 ...................................431
servo_disable_1 ...................................432
servo_enable_0 ...................................433
servo_enable_1 ...................................434
servo_gear ..........................................435
Dynamic C Functions
servo_graph ........................................437
servo_init ............................................438
servo_millirpm2vcmd ..........................438
servo_move_to ....................................439
servo_openloop
...................................440
servo_qd_zero_0 .................................441
servo_qd_zero_1 .................................441
servo_read_table .................................442
servo_set_coeffs ..................................443
servo_set_pos
......................................444
servo_set_vel ......................................445
servo_stats_reset .................................445
servo_torque
.......................................446
SPI
SPIinit ................................................491
SPIRead ..............................................492
SPIWrite
.............................................493
SPIWrRd
............................................494
Stdio
getchar ................................................175
gets .....................................................177
kbhit ...................................................212
outchrs ................................................317
outstr ..................................................318
printf ..................................................361
putchar
...............................................367
puts
....................................................367
snprintf
...............................................490
sprintf
.................................................495
String Manipulation
memchr
..............................................237
memcmp
.............................................238
memcpy ..............................................239
memmove ...........................................240
memset
...............................................241
strcat ..................................................497
strchr ..................................................498
rabbit.com
xxvii
strcmp
.................................................499
strcmpi ...............................................500
strcpy ..................................................501
strcspn
................................................502
strlen
..................................................503
strncat
.................................................504
strncmp ...............................................505
strncmpi
..............................................506
strncpy
................................................507
strpbrk
................................................508
strrchr .................................................509
strspn ..................................................510
strstr
...................................................511
strtok
..................................................514
tolower ...............................................523
toupper ...............................................523
String-to-Number Conversion
atof
.......................................................13
atoi
.......................................................14
atol
.......................................................15
strtod
..................................................512
strtol
...................................................515
System
_GetSysMacroIndex ............................178
_GetSysMacroValue ............................179
_sysIsSoftReset ...................................517
chkHardReset ........................................25
chkSoftReset
.........................................25
chkWDTO ............................................26
clockDoublerOff
...................................27
clockDoublerOn
....................................27
defineErrorHandler ................................42
exit
.......................................................76
forceSoftReset
.....................................150
get_cpu_frequency ..............................176
getdivider19200 ..................................177
GetVectExtern2000
.............................180
xxviii
GetVectExtern3000 .............................181
GetVectIntern
.....................................182
ipres
...................................................196
ipset
....................................................197
premain
..............................................358
set_cpu_power_mode ..........................469
set32kHzDivider .................................467
setClockModulation .............................468
SetSerialTATxRValues ........................472
sysResetChain
.....................................517
TAT1R_SetValue ................................520
updateTimers ......................................524
use32kHzOsc ......................................524
useClockDivider ..................................525
useClockDivider3000 ..........................526
useMainOsc
........................................527
U
User Block
readUserBlock ....................................393
readUserBlockArray
............................394
writeUserBlock
...................................535
writeUserBlockArray ...........................537
V
VBAT RAM (Rabbit 4000, 5000)
root2vram ...........................................412
vram2root ...........................................528
W
Watchdogs
Disable_HW_WDT ...............................45
Enable_HW_WDT
................................69
hitwd ..................................................194
VdGetFreeWd
.....................................529
VdHitWd ............................................530
VdInit
.................................................530
VdReleaseWd
.....................................531
rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
1. Function Descriptions
This chapter includes detailed descriptions for Dynamic C API functions. Not all API functions are included. For example, board-specific functions are described in the board’s user manual.
New releases of Dynamic C often contain new API functions. You can check if your version of Dynamic C contains a particular function by checking the Function Lookup feature in the Help menu. If you see functions described in this manual that you want but do not have, please consider updating your version of
Dynamic C. To update Dynamic C, go to: www.rabbit.com/products/dc/ or call 1.530.757.8400.
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
1
abs
int abs( int x );
DESCRIPTION
Computes the absolute value of an integer argument.
PARAMETERS x Integer argument
RETURN VALUE
Absolute value of the argument.
LIBRARY
MATH.LIB
SEE ALSO
acos
float acos ( float x );
DESCRIPTION
Computes the arccosine of real float value x.
Note: The Dynamic C functions deg() and
rad() convert radians and degrees.
PARAMETERS x Assumed to be between -1 and 1.
RETURN VALUE
Arccosine of the argument in radians.
If x is out of bounds, the function returns 0 and signals a domain error.
LIBRARY
MATH.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
2 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
acot
float acot( float x );
DESCRIPTION
Computes the arcotangent of real float value x.
Note: The Dynamic C functions deg() and
rad() convert radians and degrees.
PARAMETERS x Assumed to be between -INF and +INF.
RETURN VALUE
Arccotangent of the argument in radians.
LIBRARY
MATH.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
acsc
float acsc( float x );
DESCRIPTION
Computes the arccosecant of real float value x.
Note: The Dynamic C functions deg() and
rad() convert radians and degrees.
PARAMETERS x Assumed to be between -INF and +INF.
RETURN VALUE
The arccosecant of the argument in radians.
LIBRARY
MATH.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
3
AESdecrypt4x4
void AESdecrypt4x4( char far * expandedkey, char far * crypt, char far * plain );
DESCRIPTION
Decrypts a block of data using an implementation of the Rijndael AES cipher with a 128-bit key and block size.
The encrypted block of data may be overwritten by the decrypted block of data.
PARAMETERS expandedkey A set of round keys (generated by AESexpandKey4()) from a 16-byte
(128 bit) key.
Total of 176 bytes (44 longwords)
Note: when using an AESstreamState structure (e.g. “state”) then call this function using:
AESdecrypt4x4(state->expanded_key, plain, crypt); crypt plain
A block of 16 bytes of ciphertext to be decrypted; “crypt” and “plain” may point to the same place.
A block of 16 bytes of resulting plaintext data; “crypt” and “plain” may point to the same place.
LIBRARY
AES_CORE.LIB
4 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
AESdecryptStream4x4_CBC
int AESdecryptStream4x4_CBC( AESstreamState * state, long message, long output, unsigned int count);
DESCRIPTION
Perform an AES-CBC decryption operation.
See Samples\Crypt\AES_STREAMTEST.C for a sample program and a detailed explanation of the encryption/decryption process.
PARAMETERS state message output count
The AESstreamState structure, initialized via
AESinitStream4x4() .
This memory must be allocated in the program code before calling
AESdecrptyStream4x4_CBC() : static AESstreamState decrypt_state;
Cipher-text message (an xmem buffer)
Output buffer, for return of decrypted text (in xmem). Must be as large as the cipher-text buffer. May be the same as the cipher-text buffer.
Length of the message. Must a multiple of _AES_CBC_BLK_SZ_ (16).
RETURN VALUE
0 on success, non-zero on failure
LIBRARY
AES_CORE.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
5
AESencrypt4x4
void AESencrypt4x4( char far * expandedkey, char far * plain, char far * crypt );
DESCRIPTION
Encrypts a block of data using an implementation of the Rijndael AES cipher with 128-bit key and block size. The block of data may be overwritten by the encrypted block of data.
PARAMETERS expandedkey A set of round keys (generated by AESexpandKey4()) from a 16-byte
(128 bit) key.
Total of 176 bytes (44 longwords)
Note: when using an AESstreamState structure (e.g., “state”) then call this function using:
AESencrypt4x4(state->expanded_key, plain, crypt); plain crypt
A block of 16 bytes of data to be encrypted; “crypt” and “plain” may point to the same place.
A block of 16 bytes of resulting encrypted data; “crypt” and “plain” may point to the same place.
RETURN VALUE
None.
LIBRARY
AES_CORE.LIB
6 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
AESencryptStream4x4_CBC
int AESencryptStream4x4_CBC( AESstreamState * state, long message, long output, unsigned int count);
DESCRIPTION
Perform an AES-CBC encryption operation on XMEM data. Encryption is not “in-place.”
See Samples\Crypt\AES_STREAMTEST.C for a sample program and a detailed explanation of the encryption/decryption process.
PARAMETERS state message output count
An AES stream state structure, initialized via AESinitStream4x4().
This memory must be allocated in the program code before calling
AESencrptyStream() : static AESstreamState encrypt_state;
The message in plaintext (an xmem buffer)
The output buffer, for return of encrypted text (in xmem), must be as large as the plaintext buffer, and may be the same as the plaintext buffer.
The length of the message. Must be a multiple of _AES_CBC_BLK_SZ_
(16).
RETURN VALUE
0 on success, non-zero on failure (count was not multiple of 16)
LIBRARY
AES_CORE.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
7
AESexpandKey4
void AESexpandKey4( char far * expanded, char far * key );
DESCRIPTION
Prepares a key for use by expanding it into a set of round keys. A key is a “password” to decipher encoded data.
This function is specific to AES with 128-bit key. See AESexpandKey() for a more general function (available with Rabbit Embedded Security Pack).
PARAMETERS expanded key
A buffer for storing the expanded key. The size of the expanded key, for a
128-bit key, is 176 bytes. Other key sizes are not supported by this function.
Note: when using an AESstreamState structure (e.g., “state”) then call this function using:
AESexpandKey4(state->expanded_key, key);
The cipher key, 16 bytes
RETURN VALUE
None.
LIBRARY
AES_CORE.LIB
8 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
AESinitStream4x4
void AESinitStream4x4( AESstreamState far * state, char far * key, char far * init_vector);
DESCRIPTION
Sets up a stream state structure to begin encrypting or decrypting a stream using AES with a
128-bit key and block size.. A particular stream state can only be used for one direction.
See Samples\Crypt\AES_STREAMTEST.C for a sample program and a detailed explanation of the encryption/decryption process.
PARAMETERS state key
An AESstreamState structure to be initialized. This memory must be allocated in the program code before calling AESinitStream4x4().
The 16-byte cipher key, using a null pointer, will prevent an existing key from being recalculated.
init_vector A 16-byte array representing the initial state of the feedback registers. Both ends of the stream must begin with the same initialization vector and key.
For security, it is very important never to use the same initialization vector twice with the same key.
RETURN VALUE
None.
LIBRARY
AES_CORE.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
9
asec
float asec( float x );
DESCRIPTION
Computes the arcsecant of real float value x.
Note: The Dynamic C functions deg() and
rad() convert radians and degrees.
PARAMETERS x Assumed to be between -INF and +INF.
RETURN VALUE
The arcsecant of the argument in radians.
LIBRARY
MATH.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
asin
float asin( float x );
DESCRIPTION
Computes the arcsine of real float value x.
Note: The Dynamic C functions deg() and
rad() convert radians and degrees.
PARAMETERS x Assumed to be between -1 and +1.
RETURN VALUE
The arcsine of the argument in radians.
LIBRARY
MATH.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
10 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
atan
float atan( float x );
DESCRIPTION
Computes the arctangent of real float value x.
Note: The Dynamic C functions deg() and
rad() convert radians and degrees.
PARAMETERS x Assumed to be between -INF and +INF.
RETURN VALUE
The arctangent of the argument in radians.
LIBRARY
MATH.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
11
atan2
float atan2( float y, float x );
DESCRIPTION
Computes the arctangent of real float value y/x to find the angle in radians between the x-axis and the ray through (0,0) and (x,y).
Note: The Dynamic C functions deg() and
rad() convert radians and degrees.
PARAMETERS y x
The point corresponding to the y-axis
The point corresponding to the x-axis
RETURN VALUE
If both y and x are zero, the function returns 0 and signals a domain error. Otherwise the arctangent of y/x is returned as follows:
Returned Value
(in Radians) angle
Parameter Values x
0, y 0
PI/2
–PI/2
0
PI x = 0, y > 0 x = 0, y < x > 0, y = 0 x < 0, y = 0
LIBRARY
MATH.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
,
12 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
atof
NEAR SYNTAX: float _n_atof( char * sptr );
FAR SYNTAX: float _f_atof( char far * sptr );
Note: By default, atof() is defined to _n_atof().
DESCRIPTION
ANSI string to float conversion (UNIX compatible).
For Rabbit 4000+ users, this function supports FAR pointers. By default the near version of the function is called. The macro USE_FAR_STRING will change all calls to functions in this library to their far versions. The user may also explicitly call the far version with _f_strfunc where strfunc is the name of the string function.
Because FAR addresses are larger, the far versions of this function will run slightly slower than the near version. To explicitly call the near version when the USE_FAR_STRING macro is defined and all pointers are near pointers, append _n_ to the function name, e.g., _n_strfunc.
For more information about FAR pointers, see the Dynamic C User’s Manual or the samples in
Samples/Rabbit4000/FAR/ .
PARAMETERS sptr String to convert.
RETURN VALUE
The converted floating value.
If the conversion is invalid, _xtoxErr is set to 1. Otherwise _xtoxErr is set to 0.
LIBRARY
STRING.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
13
atoi
NEAR SYNTAX: int _n_atoi( char * sptr );
FAR SYNTAX: int _f_atoi( char far * sptr );
Note: By default, atoi() is defined to _n_atoi().
DESCRIPTION
ANSI string to integer conversion (UNIX compatible).
For Rabbit 4000+ users, this function supports FAR pointers. By default the near version of the function is called. The macro USE_FAR_STRING will change all calls to functions in this library to their far versions. The user may also explicitly call the far version with _f_strfunc where strfunc is the name of the string function.
Because FAR addresses are larger, the far versions of this function will run slightly slower than the near version. To explicitly call the near version when the USE_FAR_STRING macro is defined and all pointers are near pointers, append _n_ to the function name, e.g., _n_strfunc.
For more information about FAR pointers, see the Dynamic C User’s Manual or the samples in
Samples/Rabbit4000/FAR/ .
PARAMETERS sptr String to convert.
RETURN VALUE
The converted integer value.
LIBRARY
STRING.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
14 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
atol
NEAR SYNTAX: long _n_atol( char * sptr );
FAR SYNTAX: long _f_atol( char far * sptr );
By default, atol() is defined to _n_atol().
DESCRIPTION
ANSI string to long conversion (UNIX compatible).
For Rabbit 4000+ users, this function supports FAR pointers. By default the near version of the function is called. The macro USE_FAR_STRING will change all calls to functions in this library to their far versions. The user may also explicitly call the far version with _f_strfunc where strfunc is the name of the string function.
Because FAR addresses are larger, the far versions of this function will run slightly slower than the near version. To explicitly call the near version when the USE_FAR_STRING macro is defined and all pointers are near pointers, append _n_ to the function name, e.g., _n_strfunc.
For more information about FAR pointers, see the Dynamic C User’s Manual or the samples in
Samples/Rabbit4000/FAR/ .
PARAMETERS sptr String to convert.
RETURN VALUE
The converted long integer value.
LIBRARY
STRING.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
15
bit
unsigned int bit( void * address, unsigned int bit );
DESCRIPTION
Dynamic C may expand this call inline.
Reads specified bit at memory address. bit may be from 0 to 31. This is equivalent to the following expression, but more efficient:
(*(long *)address >> bit) & 1
PARAMETERS address bit
RETURN VALUE
1 : Specified bit is set.
0 : Bit is clear.
Address of byte containing bits 7-0
Bit location where 0 represents the least significant bit
LIBRARY
UTIL.LIB
SEE ALSO
16 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
BIT
unsigned int BIT( void * address, unsigned int bit );
DESCRIPTION
Dynamic C may expand this call inline.
Reads specified bit at memory address. bit may be from 0 to 31. This is equivalent to the following expression, but more efficient:
(*(long *)address>>bit) &1
PARAMETERS address bit
Address of byte containing bits 7-0
Bit location where 0 represents the least significant bit
RETURN VALUE
1 : bit is set
0 : bit is clear
LIBRARY
UTIL.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
17
BitRdPortE
root int BitRdPortE( unsigned int port, int bitnumber );
DESCRIPTION
Returns 1 or 0 matching the value of the bit read from the specified external I/O port.
PARAMETERS port bitnumber
Address of external parallel port data register.
Bit to read (0–7).
RETURN VALUE
0 or 1: The value of the bit read.
LIBRARY
SYSIO.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
,
,
18 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
BitRdPortI
int BitRdPortI( int port, int bitnumber );
DESCRIPTION
Returns 1 or 0 matching the value of the bit read from the specified internal I/O port.
PARAMETERS port bitnumber
Address of internal parallel port data register.
Bit to read (0–7).
RETURN VALUE
0 or 1: The value of the bit read.
LIBRARY
SYSIO.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
19
BitWrPortE
void BitWrPortE( unsigned int port, char * portshadow, int value, int bitcode );
DESCRIPTION
Updates shadow register at bitcode with value (0 or 1) and copies shadow to register.
WARNING! A shadow register is required for this function.
PARAMETERS port portshadow value bitcode
Address of external parallel port data register.
Reference pointer to a variable to shadow the current value of the register.
Value of 0 or 1 to be written to the bit position.
Bit position 0–7.
LIBRARY
SYSIO.LIB
SEE ALSO
20 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
BitWrPortI
void BitWrPortI( int port, char * portshadow, int value, int bitcode );
DESCRIPTION
Updates shadow register at position bitcode with value (0 or 1); copies shadow to register.
WARNING! A shadow register is required for this function.
PARAMETERS port portshadow value bitcode
Address of internal parallel port data register.
Reference pointer to a variable to shadow the current value of the register.
Value of 0 or 1 to be written to the bit position.
Bit position 0–7.
LIBRARY
SYSIO.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
21
CalculateECC256
long CalculateECC256( void * data );
DESCRIPTION
Calculates a 3 byte Error Correcting Checksum (ECC, 1 bit correction and 2 bit detection capability) value for a 256 byte (2048 bit) data buffer located in root memory.
PARAMETERS data Pointer to the 256 byte data buffer
RETURN VALUE
The calculated ECC in the 3 LSBs of the long (i.e., BCDE) result. Note that the MSB (i.e., B) of the long result is always zero.
LIBRARY
ECC.LIB (This function was introduced in Dynamic C 9.01)
22 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
ChkCorrectECC256
void ChkCorrectECC256( void * data, void * old_ecc, void * new_ecc);
DESCRIPTION
Checks the old versus new ECC values for a 256 byte (2048 bit) data buffer, and if necessary and possible (1 bit correction, 2 bit detection), corrects the data in the specified root memory buffer.
PARAMETERS data old_ecc new_ecc
Pointer to the 256 byte data buffer
Pointer to the old (original) 3 byte ECC's buffer
Pointer to the new (current) 3 byte ECC's buffer
RETURN VALUE
0 : Data and ECC are good (no correction is necessary)
1 : Data is corrected and ECC is good
2 : Data is good and ECC is corrected
3 : Data and/or ECC are bad and uncorrectable
LIBRARY
ECC.LIB (This function was introduced in Dynamic C 9.01)
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
23
ceil
float ceil( float x );
DESCRIPTION
Computes the smallest integer greater than or equal to the given number.
PARAMETERS x Number to round up.
RETURN VALUE
The rounded up number.
LIBRARY
MATH.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
24 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
chkHardReset
int chkHardReset( void );
DESCRIPTION
This function determines whether this restart of the board is due to a hardware reset. Asserting the RESET line or recycling power are both considered hardware resets. A watchdog timeout is not a hardware reset.
RETURN VALUE
1 : The processor was restarted due to a hardware reset.
0 : If it was not.
LIBRARY
SYS.LIB
SEE ALSO
chkSoftReset
int chkSoftReset( void );
DESCRIPTION
This function determines whether this restart of the board is due to a software reset from Dynamic C or a call to forceSoftReset().
RETURN VALUE
1 : The board was restarted due to a soft reset.
0 : If it was not.
LIBRARY
SYS.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
25
chkWDTO
int chkWDTO( void );
DESCRIPTION
This function determines whether this restart of the board is due to a watchdog timeout.
Note: A watchdog timeout cannot be detected on a BL2000 or SmartStar.
RETURN VALUE
1 : If the board was restarted due to a watchdog timeout.
0 : If it was not.
LIBRARY
SYS.LIB
SEE ALSO
26 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
clockDoublerOn
void clockDoublerOn( void );
DESCRIPTION
Enables the Rabbit clock doubler. If the doubler is already enabled, there will be no effect. Also attempts to adjust the communication rate between Dynamic C and the board to compensate for the frequency change. User serial port rates need to be adjusted accordingly. Also note that single-stepping through this routine will cause Dynamic C to lose communication with the target.
LIBRARY
SYS.LIB
SEE ALSO
clockDoublerOff
void clockDoublerOff( void );
DESCRIPTION
Disables the Rabbit clock doubler. If the doubler is already disabled, there will be no effect.
Also attempts to adjust the communication rate between Dynamic C and the board to compensate for the frequency change. User serial port rates need to be adjusted accordingly. Also note that single-stepping through this routine will cause Dynamic C to lose communication with the target.
LIBRARY
SYS.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
27
CloseInputCompressedFile
void CloseInputCompressedFile( ZFILE * ifp );
DESCRIPTION
Close an input compression file opened by OpenInputCompressionFile(). This file may be a compressed file that is being decompressed, or an uncompressed file that is being compressed. In either case, this function should be called for each open import ZFILE once it is done being used to free up the associated input buffer.
PARAMETERS ifp File descriptor of an input compression ZFILE.
RETURN VALUE
None
LIBRARY
LZSS.LIB
CloseOutputCompressedFile
void CloseOutputCompressedFile( ZFILE * ifp );
DESCRIPTION
Close an output compression file. This file is an FS2 ZFILE which was previously opened with
OpenOutputCompressionFile() . This function should always be called when done writing to a compression output ZFILE to free up the associated output buffer.
PARAMETERS ifp File descriptor of an output compression ZFILE.
RETURN VALUE
None
LIBRARY lzss.lib
28 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
CoBegin
void CoBegin( CoData * p );
DESCRIPTION
Initialize a costatement structure so the costatement will be executed next time it is encountered.
PARAMETERS p Address of costatement
LIBRARY
COSTATE.LIB
cof_pktXreceive
int cof_pktXreceive( void * buffer, int buffer_size ); /* X is A-F */
DESCRIPTION
Receives an incoming packet. This function returns after a complete packet has been read into the buffer.
The functions cof_pktEreceive() and cof_pktFreceive() are available when using the Rabbit 3000 or Rabbit 4000.
PARAMETERS buffer A buffer for the packet to be written into.
buffer_size Length of the buffer.
RETURN VALUE
>0 : The number of bytes in the received packet on success.
0 : No new packets have been received.
-1 : The packet is too large for the given buffer.
-2 : A needed test_packet function is not defined.
LIBRARY
PACKET.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
29
cof_pktXsend
void cof_pktXsend(void *send_buffer int buffer_length, char delay );
/* X is A-F */
DESCRIPTION
Initiates the sending of a packet of data. The function will exit when the packet is finished transmitting.
The functions cof_pktEsend() and cof_pktFsend() are available when using the
Rabbit 3000 or Rabbit 4000.
PARAMETERS send_buffer The data to be sent.
buffer_length Length of the data buffer to transmit.
delay The number of byte times (0-255) to delay before sending data. This is used to implement protocol-specific delays between packets.
LIBRARY
PACKET.LIB
30 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
cof_serXgetc
int cof_serXgetc( void ); /* where X is A-F */
DESCRIPTION
This single-user cofunction yields to other tasks until a character is read from port X. This function only returns when a character is successfully written. It is non-reentrant.
The functions cof_serEgetc() and cof_serFgetc() may be used with the Rabbit
3000 or Rabbit 4000.
Note: Alternatively you can use another form of this function that has been generalized for all serial ports. Instead of substituting for “X” in the function name, the prototype of the generalized function is: cof_serXgetc(int port), where “port” is one of the macros
SER_PORT_A through SER_PORT_F.
RETURN VALUE
An integer with the character read into the low byte.
LIBRARY
RS232.LIB
EXAMPLE
// echoes characters main() { int c; serXopen(19200); loopinit(); while (1) { loophead(); wfd c = cof_serAgetc(); wfd cof_serAputc(c);
} serAclose();
}
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
31
cof_serXgets
int cof_serXgets( char * s, int max, unsigned long tmout );
/* where X is A-F */
DESCRIPTION
This single-user cofunction reads characters from port X until a null terminator, linefeed, or carriage return character is read, max characters are read, or until tmout milliseconds transpires between characters read. A timeout will never occur if no characters have been received. This function is non-reentrant. It yields to other tasks for as long as the input buffer is locked or whenever the buffer becomes empty as characters are read. s will always be null terminated upon return. The functions cof_serEgets() and cof_serFgets() may be used with the Rabbit 3000 or Rabbit 4000.
Note: Alternatively you can use another form of this function that has been generalized for all serial ports. Instead of substituting for “X” in the function name, the prototype of the generalized function is: cof_serXgets(int port, ...), where “port” is one of the macros
SER_PORT_A through SER_PORT_F.
PARAMETERS s max tmout
Character array into which a null terminated string is read.
The maximum number of characters to read into s.
Millisecond wait period between characters before timing out.
RETURN VALUE
1 if CR or max bytes read into s.
0 if function times out before reading CR or max bytes.
LIBRARY
RS232.LIB
EXAMPLE main() { int getOk; char s[16]; serAopen(19200); loopinit(); while (1) { loophead();
// echoes null terminated character strings costate { wfd getOk = cof_serAgets (s, 15, 20); if (getOk) wfd cof_serAputs(s); else { // timed out: s null terminated, but incomplete
}
}
} serAclose();
}
32 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
cof_serXputc
void cof_serXputc ( int c ); /* where X is A-F */
DESCRIPTION
This single-user cofunction writes a character to serial port X, yielding to other tasks when the input buffer is locked. This function is non-reentrant.
The functions cof_serEputc() and cof_serFputc() may be used with the
Rabbit 3000 or Rabbit 4000.
Note: Alternatively you can use another form of this function that has been generalized for all serial ports. Instead of substituting for “X” in the function name, the prototype of the generalized function is: cof_serXputc(int port, ...), where “port” is one of the macros
SER_PORT_A through SER_PORT_F.
PARAMETERS c Character to write.
LIBRARY
RS232.LIB
EXAMPLE
// echoes characters main() { int c; serAopen(19200); loopinit(); while (1) { loophead(); wfd c = cof_serAgetc(); wfd cof_serAputc(c);
} serAclose();
}
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
33
cof_serXputs
void cof_serXputs( char * str ); /* where X is A-F */
DESCRIPTION
This single-user cofunction writes a null terminated string to port X. It yields to other tasks for as long as the input buffer may be locked or whenever the buffer may become full as characters are written. This function is non-reentrant.
The functions cof_serEputs() and cof_serFputs() may be used with the Rabbit
3000 or Rabbit 4000.
Note: Alternatively you can use another form of this function that has been generalized for all serial ports. Instead of substituting for “X” in the function name, the prototype of the generalized function is: cof_serXputs(port, ...), where “port” is one of the macros
SER_PORT_A through SER_PORT_F.
PARAMETERS str Null terminated character string to write.
LIBRARY
RS232.LIB
EXAMPLE
// writes a null terminated character string, repeatedly main() { const char s[] = "Hello Rabbit"; serAopen(19200); loopinit(); while (1) { loophead(); costate { wfd cof_serAputs(s);
}
} serAclose();
}
34 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
cof_serXread
int cof_serXread( void * data, int length, unsigned long tmout );
/* X is A-F */
DESCRIPTION
This single-user cofunction reads length characters from port X (where X is A, B, C, D, E or
F) or until tmout milliseconds transpires between characters read. It yields to other tasks for as long as the input buffer is locked or whenever the buffer becomes empty as characters are read. A timeout will never occur if no characters have been read. This function is non-reentrant.
The functions cof_serEread() and cof_serFread() may be used with the
Rabbit 3000 or Rabbit 4000.
Note: Alternatively you can use another form of this function that has been generalized for all serial ports. Instead of substituting for “X” in the function name, the prototype of the generalized function is: cof_serXread(int port, ...), where “port” is one of the macros
SER_PORT_A through SER_PORT_F.
PARAMETERS data length tmout
Data structure into which characters are read.
The number of characters to read into data.
Millisecond wait period to allow between characters before timing out.
RETURN VALUE
Number of characters read into data.
LIBRARY
RS232.LIB
EXAMPLE
// echoes a block of characters main() { int n; char s[16]; serAopen(19200); loopinit(); while (1) { loophead(); costate { wfd n = cof_serAread(s, 15, 20); wfd cof_serAwrite(s, n);
}
} serAclose();
}
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
35
cof_serXwrite
void cof_serXwrite( void * data, int length ); /* where X is A-F */
DESCRIPTION
This single-user cofunction writes length bytes to port X. It yields to other tasks for as long as the input buffer is locked or whenever the buffer becomes full as characters are written. This function is non-reentrant.
The functions cof_serEwrite() and cof_serFwrite() may be used with the
Rabbit 3000 or Rabbit 4000.
Note: Alternatively you can use another form of this function that has been generalized for all serial ports. Instead of substituting for “X” in the function name, the prototype of the generalized function is: cof_serXwrite(int port, ...), where “port” is one of the macros
SER_PORT_A through SER_PORT_F.
PARAMETERS data length
Data structure to write.
Number of bytes in data to write.
LIBRARY
RS232.LIB
EXAMPLE
// writes a block of characters, repeatedly main() { const char s[] = "Hello Rabbit"; serAopen(19200); loopinit(); while (1) { loophead(); costate { wfd cof_serAwrite(s, strlen(s));
}
} serAclose();
}
36 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
CompressFile
void CompressFile( ZFILE * input, ZFILE * output );
DESCRIPTION
This function compresses the input file (uncompressed ZFILE, opened with
OpenInputCompressFile() ) using the LZ compression algorithm. The result is put into a user-specified output file (an empty ZFILE, opened with
OpenOutputCompressedFile() ).
The macro OUTPUT_COMPRESSION_BUFFERS must be defined with a positive non-zero value to use CompressFile() or a compile-time error will occur. The default value of
OUTPUT_COMPRESSION_BUFFERS is zero.
PARAMETERS input output
Input bit file
Output bit file
RETURN VALUE
None
LIBRARY
LZSS.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
37
CoPause
void CoPause( CoData * p );
DESCRIPTION
Pause execution of a costatement so that it will not run the next time it is encountered unless and until CoResume(p) or CoBegin(p) are called.
PARAMETERS p Address of costatement
LIBRARY
COSTATE.LIB
CoReset
void CoReset( CoData * p );
DESCRIPTION
Initializes a costatement structure so the costatement will not be executed next time it is encountered.
PARAMETERS p Address of costatement
LIBRARY
COSTATE.LIB
38 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
CoResume
void CoResume( CoData * p );
DESCRIPTION
Resume execution of a costatement that has been paused.
PARAMETERS p Address of costatement
LIBRARY
COSTATE.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
39
cos
float cos( float x );
DESCRIPTION
Computes the cosine of real float value x.
Note: The Dynamic C functions deg() and
rad() convert radians and degrees.
PARAMETERS x Angle in radians.
RETURN VALUE
Cosine of the argument.
LIBRARY
MATH.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
cosh
float cosh( float x );
DESCRIPTION
Computes the hyperbolic cosine of real float value x. This functions takes a unitless number as a parameter and returns a unitless number.
PARAMETERS x Value to compute.
RETURN VALUE
Hyperbolic cosine.
If |x| > 89.8 (approx.), the function returns INF and signals a range error.
LIBRARY
MATH.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
,
40 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
DecompressFile
void DecompressFile( ZFILE * input, ZFILE * output );
DESCRIPTION
This is the expansion routine for the LZSS algorithm. It performs the opposite operation of
CompressFile() . The input file (a compressed ZFILE, opened with
OpenInputCompressedFile() ) is decompressed to the output file (an empty FS2
ZFILE , opened with OpenOutputCompressedFile()).
PARAMETERS input output
Input bit file
Output bit file
RETURN VALUE
None
LIBRARY
LZSS.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
41
defineErrorHandler
void defineErrorHandler( void * errfcn );
DESCRIPTION
Sets the BIOS function pointer for runtime errors to the function pointed to by errfcn. This user-defined function must be in root memory. Specify root at the start of the function definition to ensure this. When a runtime error occurs, the following information is passed to the error handler on the stack :
Stack Position
SP+0
SP+2
SP+4
SP+6
SP+8
Stack Contents
Return address for exceptionRet
Error code
0x0000 (can be used for additional information)
XPC when exception() was called (upper byte)
Address where exception() was called
PARAMETERS errfcn
LIBRARY
SYS.LIB
Pointer to user-defined run-time error handler.
42 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
float deg( float x );
DESCRIPTION
Changes float radians x to degrees
PARAMETERS x Angle in radians.
RETURN VALUE
Angle in degrees (a float).
LIBRARY
MATH.LIB
SEE ALSO
deg
DelayMs
int DelayMs( long delayms );
DESCRIPTION
Millisecond time mechanism for the costatement waitfor constructs. The initial call to this function starts the timing. The function returns zero and continues to return zero until the number of milliseconds specified has passed.
Note that milliseconds timing starts immediately, without waiting for the current millisecond to elapse. In the case that the current millisecond is just about to end, the perceived elapsed time may be as much as 1 millisecond shorter than the requested delay.
PARAMETERS delayms The number of milliseconds to wait.
RETURN VALUE
1 : The specified number of milliseconds have elapsed.
0 : The specified number of milliseconds have not elapsed.
LIBRARY
COSTATE.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
43
DelaySec
int DelaySec( long delaysec );
DESCRIPTION
Second time mechanism for the costatement waitfor constructs. The initial call to this function starts the timing. The function returns zero and continues to return zero until the number of seconds specified has passed.
Note that seconds timing starts immediately, without waiting for the current second to elapse.
In the case that the current second is just about to end, the perceived elapsed time may be as much as 1 second shorter than the requested delay. For more precise delays of up to 24 days duration, consider using DelayMs() instead of DelaySec().
PARAMETERS delaysec The number of seconds to wait.
RETURN VALUE
1 : The specified number of seconds have elapsed.
0 : The specified number of seconds have not elapsed.
LIBRARY
COSTATE.LIB
44 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
DelayTicks
int DelayTicks( unsigned ticks );
DESCRIPTION
Tick time mechanism for the costatement waitfor constructs. The initial call to this function starts the timing. The function returns zero and continues to return zero until the number of ticks specified has passed.
1 tick = 1/1024 second.
Note that tick timing starts immediately, without waiting for the current tick to elapse. In the case that the current tick is just about to end, the perceived elapsed time may be as much as 1 tick shorter than the requested delay.
PARAMETERS ticks The number of ticks to wait.
RETURN VALUE
1 : The specified tick delay has elapsed.
0 : The specified tick delay has not elapsed.
LIBRARY
COSTATE.LIB
Disable_HW_WDT
void Disable_HW_WDT( void );
DESCRIPTION
Disables the hardware watchdog timer on the Rabbit processor. Note that the watchdog will be enabled again just by hitting it. The watchdog is hit by the periodic interrupt, which is on by default. This function is useful for special situations such as low power “sleepy mode.”
LIBRARY
SYS.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
45
disableIObus
void disableIObus( void );
DESCRIPTION
This function disables external I/O bus and normal data bus operations resume on the Rabbit
3000 or Rabbit 4000.
The external I/O bus must be disabled during normal bus operations with other devices and must be enabled during any external I/O bus operation.
This function is non-reentrant.
Port A and B data shadow register values are NOT saved or restored in this function call.
Parallel port A is set to a byte-wide input and parallel port B data direction register (PBDDR) is set to an unknown state, which must be set by the user.
LIBRARY
ExternIO.LIB (was in R3000.LIB prior to DC 10)
SEE ALSO
46 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
DMAalloc
dma_chan_t DMAalloc( char channel_mask, int highest );
DESCRIPTION
This function returns a handle to an available channel. The handle contains the channel number and a validation byte to prevent use of an old handle after deallocation.
PARAMETERS channel_mask Mask of all the acceptable channels to choose from.
highest Bool indicating whether to search for an available channel from 8 or from 0.
RETURN VALUE
Returns a handle to a DMA channel if one is available. If none are available it returns
DMA_CHANNEL_NONE .
LIBRARY
DMA.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
47
DMAcompleted
int DMAcompleted( dma_chan_t handle, unsigned int * len );
DESCRIPTION
This function checks to see if a channel is finished with its DMA operation. If complete, the number of bytes transferred in the last operation is returned in *len (if len is not NULL), and
1 is returned.
PARAMETERS handle len
Handle for channel to check
Pointer to the value to be filled with the number of bytes last transferred
RETURN VALUE
1 : DMA operation is complete
0 : Allocated channel has never been used or is currently running
-EINVAL : Invalid handle
LIBRARY
DMA.LIB
SEE ALSO
48 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
DMAhandle2chan
int DMAhandle2chan( dma_chan_t handle );
DESCRIPTION
This function checks the validity of a handle and returns the channel number if it is valid.
PARAMETER handle Handle to convert to channel number
RETURN VALUE
0-7 : Valid channel number
DMA_CHANNEL_NONE : The channel is invalid
LIBRARY
DMA.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
49
DMAioe2mem
int DMAioe2mem( dma_chan_t handle, dma_addr_t dest, unsigned int src, unsigned int len, unsigned int flags );
DESCRIPTION
This function performs an immediate DMA operation from external I/O to memory.
PARAMETERS handle dest src len flags
Handle for channel to use in transfer
Memory destination address
External I/O location source address
Length to send (cannot equal zero)
Various flag options.
• DMA_F_REPEAT indicates that the transfer will be a cycle
• DMA_F_INTERRUPT indicates an interrupt will be triggered at the completion of the transfer. The interrupt vector and function must be set up in the user's code.
• DMA_F_LAST_SPECIAL (only for Ethernet or HDLC peripherals)
Internal Source: Status byte written to initial buffer descriptor before last data.
Internal Destination: Last byte written to offset address for frame termination.
All Others: no effect.
• DMA_F_SRC_DEC only for transfers with memory source. Indicates the source address should be decremented.
• DMA_F_DEST_DEC only for transfers with memory destination. Indicates the destination address should be incremented.
• DMA_F_STOP_MATCH indicates whether or not to stop the dma transfer when a character is reached. The match byte and mask should have previously been set by calling the DMAmatchSetup() function.
• DMA_F_TIMER indicates the DMA timer will be used. The divisor should have already been set by calling the DMAtimerSetup() function.
• DMA_F_TIMER_1BPR indicates that the timed transfers will send one byte per request instead of the entire descriptor
50 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
DMAioe2mem (cont’d)
Only one of the following flags (if any) should be set. They indicate that the DMA transfer is gated using the named pin:
• DMA_F_PD2, DMA_F_PE2, DMA_F_PE6, DMA_F_PD3,
DMA_F_PE3 , DMA_F_PE7
The following flags indicate the polarity of the gating signal:
• DMA_F_FALLING (default), DMA_F_RISING, DMA_F_LOW,
DMA_F_HIGH
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success
-EINVAL : Invalid handle
-EBUSY : Resources are busy
LIBRARY
DMA.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
51
DMAioi2mem
int DMAioi2mem( dma_chan_t handle, dma_addr_t dest, unsigned int src, unsigned int len, unsigned int flags );
DESCRIPTION
This function performs an immediate DMA operation from internal I/O to memory.
PARAMETERS handle dest src len flags
Handle for channel to use in transfer
Memory destination address
Internal I/O location source address
Length to send (cannot equal zero)
Various flag options. See
for a full list of flags and their descriptions.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success
-EINVAL : Invalid handle
-EBUSY : Resources are busy
LIBRARY
DMA.LIB
SEE ALSO
52 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
DMAloadBufDesc
void DMAloadBufDesc( int dmaChannel, dma_addr_t * bufPtr );
DESCRIPTION
This function loads the appropriate DMA Initial Address Registers for the requested DMA channel with the address provided.
PARAMETERS dmaChannel bufPtr
DMA channel number to load
Pointer to variable containing physical address of DMA buffer
LIBRARY
DMA.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
53
DMAmatchSetup
int DMAmatchSetup( dma_chan_t handle, int mask, int byte );
DESCRIPTION
This function sets up the mask and match registers for the DMA. These registers are only used when the DMA_F_STOP_MATCH flag is passed to the transfer function.
PARAMETERS handle mask byte
Handle for the DMA channel.
Mask for termination byte (parameter 3). A value of all zeros disables the termination byte match feature. A value of all ones uses the full termination byte for comparison.
Byte that, if matched, will terminate the buffer.
LIBRARY
DMA.LIB
SEE ALSO
54 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
DMAmem2ioe
int DMAmem2ioe( dma_chan_t handle, unsigned int dest, dma_addr_t src, unsigned int len, unsigned int flags );
DESCRIPTION
This function performs an immediate DMA operation from memory to external I/O.
PARAMETERS handle dest src len flags
Handle for channel to use in transfer
External I/O destination address
Memory location source
Length to send (cannot equal zero)
Various flag options. See
for a full list of flags and their descriptions.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success
-EINVAL : Invalid handle
-EBUSY : Resources are busy
LIBRARY
DMA.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
55
DMAmem2ioi
int DMAmem2ioi( dma_chan_t handle, unsigned int dest, dma_addr_t src, unsigned int len, unsigned int flags );
DESCRIPTION
This function performs an immediate DMA operation from memory to internal I/O.
PARAMETERS handle dest src len flags
Handle for channel to use in transfer
Internal I/O destination address
Memory location source
Length to send (cannot equal zero)
Various flag options. See
for a full list of flags and their descriptions.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success
-EINVAL : Invalid handle
-EBUSY : Resources are busy
LIBRARY
DMA.LIB
SEE ALSO
56 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
DMAmem2mem
int DMAmem2mem( dma_chan_t handle, dma_addr_t dest, dma_addr_t src, unsigned int len, unsigned int flags );
DESCRIPTION
This function performs an immediate DMA operation from memory to memory.
PARAMETERS handle dest src len flags
Handle for channel to use in transfer
Memory destination address
Memory location source address
Length to send (cannot equal zero)
Various flag options. See
for a full list of flags and their descriptions.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success
-EINVAL : Invalid handle
-EBUSY : Resources are busy
LIBRARY
DMA.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
57
DMApoll
word DMApoll( int dmaChannel, word * bufCount );
DESCRIPTION
This is a low-level DMA function for determining how much data has been transferred by the specified DMA channel. Since DMA is asynchronous to the CPU, this returns a lower bound on the actually completed transfer.
IMPORTANT: Owing to the way the DMA channels are designed, this function will not give a valid result for the first buffer in a linked list or chain, or if there is only one buffer defined (with no link or array sequencing). To get around this limitation, define the first buffer as a dummy transfer of one byte from memory to the same memory, and link this initial dummy buffer to the desired list or array of buffer descriptors. Take the dummy buffer into account when interpreting the bufCount value returned. If you service an interrupt from the dummy buffer completion, you will know when it is valid to poll.
This function is mainly intended for endless DMA loops (e.g., receiving into a circular buffer from a serial port) thus the above restriction should not be too onerous in practice.
PARAMETERS dmaChannel bufCount
DMA channel number to poll (0-7).
Pointer to variable in which the completed buffer count will be written. The return value contains the number of bytes remaining (not yet transferred) in this buffer. The buffer count wraps around modulo 256.
RETURN VALUE
The number of bytes remaining in the buffer indicated by *bufCount. This ranges from 0, if completed, up to the total size of the buffer, if not yet started. If the size of any single transfer was 65536 bytes, then the return value is ambiguous as to whether it means “0” or “65536.”
LIBRARY
DMA.LIB
SEE ALSO
58 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
DMAprintBufDesc
void DMAprintBufDesc( void * dr, long dp );
DESCRIPTION
This is a debugging function only. It formats and prints the contents of the buffer descriptor at
*dr or *dp, using bit 6 of the chanControl field to determine whether to assume a short or long format. If dr is not NULL, then the buffer descriptor is in root memory and *dr is used.
Otherwise, dp is assumed to be the physical address of the buffer descriptor in xmem.
PARAMETERS dr dp
Pointer to buffer descriptor in root memory.
Address of buffer descriptor in physical memory.
LIBRARY
DMA.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
59
DMAprintRegs
void DMAprintRegs( int chan, int masters );
DESCRIPTION
This is a debugging function only. This prints the values of the hardware registers for the specified channel. If masters is true, then it also prints the values of the master DMA control registers.
Note that the Source and Destination Address registers are write only and read as zero.
PARAMETERS chan masters
Channel number to print
A bool to determine whether or not to print out the master registers shared between all channels
LIBRARY
DMA.LIB
SEE ALSO
60 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
DMAsetBufDesc
int DMAsetBufDesc( char chanControl, unsigned int bufLength, dma_addr_t srcAddress, dma_addr_t destAddress, dma_addr_t linkAddress, dma_addr_t bufPtr, int bufSize );
DESCRIPTION
This function loads a DMA buffer descriptor in memory with the values provided. The buffer needs to be described as either 12 or 16 bytes in size.
PARAMETERS chanControl DMA channel control value bufLength srcAddress
DMA buffer length
DMA source address destAddress DMA destination address linkAddress DMA link address (of next buffer descriptor) bufPtr bufSize
Physical address of buffer descriptor to fill
Size of buffer descriptor in bytes (12 or 16 only)
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success
-EINVAL : Error
LIBRARY
DMA.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
61
DMAsetDirect
void DMAsetDirect( int channel, char chanControl, unsigned int bufLength, dma_addr_t srcAddress, dma_addr_t destAddress, dma_addr_t linkAddress );
DESCRIPTION
This function sets up a DMA channel with the values provided.
PARAMETERS channel DMA channel to set chanControl DMA channel control value bufLength srcAddress
DMA buffer length
DMA source address destAddress DMA destination address linkAddress DMA link address (of next buffer descriptor)
LIBRARY
DMA.LIB
SEE ALSO
62 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
DMAsetParameters
int DMAsetParameters( unsigned int transfer_pri, unsigned int interrupt_pri, unsigned int inter_dma_pri, unsigned int chunkiness, unsigned int min_cpu_pct );
DESCRIPTION
This function sets up DMA parameters. The chunkiness parameter determines the amount of CPU time needed to transfer data according to this chart: chunkiness
CPU_cycles
1
11
2
15
3
19
4
23
8
39
16
71
32
135
64
263
The min_cpu_pct parameter determines the minimum time between bursts and is calculated with this formula: cpu free time =
100 – min_cpu_pct
This is then rounded up to the nearest value out of 12, 16, 24, 32, 64, 128, 256, or 512.
PARAMETERS transfer_pri DMA transfer priority (0, 1, 2 or 3), transfers can occur when the CPU interrupt priority is less than or equal to this value.
interrupt_pri DMA interrupt priority (0, 1, 2, or 3); a value of 0 will disable the
DMA interrupts.
inter_dma_pri Relative prioritization amongst the DMA channels. It is one of the following constants:
• DMA_IDP_FIXED - fixed priorities, with higher channel numbers taking precedence;
• DMA_IDP_ROTATE_FINE - priorities are rotated after every byte transferred;
• DMA_IDP_ROTATE_COARSE - priorities rotated after every transfer request, the size of which is determined by the “chunkiness” parameter.
chunkiness Maximum transfer burst size. Allowed values are 1, 2, 3, 4, 8, 16, 32, or 64. Other numbers will be rounded down to the nearest allowed value.
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
63
DMAsetParameters (cont’d)
min_cpu_pct
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success
-EINVA L: for an error
LIBRARY
DMA.LIB
A number between 0 and 100 describing the minimum (worst-case) relative amount of time that the CPU will control the bus versus the
DMA time. Internally, this function uses this figure to determine the
'minimum clocks between bursts' hardware setting. The figure will be rounded in favor of the CPU, up to the maximum possible hardware setting.
DMAstartAuto
void DMAstartAuto( int channel );
DESCRIPTION
This function is defined to the following:
WrPortI(DMALR, NULL, 1 << channel);
Start (using auto-load) the corresponding DMA channel, using the buffer descriptor in memory addressed by the Initial Address Register. This command should only be used after the Initial
Address has been loaded.
PARAMETER channel DMA channel (obtainable through DMAhandle2chan())
LIBRARY
DMA.LIB
SEE ALSO
64 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
DMAstartDirect
void DMAstartDirect( int channel );
DESCRIPTION
This function is defined to the following:
WrPortI(DMCSR, NULL, 1 << channel);
Start (or restart) the corresponding DMA channel using the contents of the DMA channel registers. This command should only be used after all the DMA channel registers have been loaded.
PARAMETER channel DMA channel (obtainable through DMAhandle2chan())
LIBRARY
DMA.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
65
DMAstop
int DMAstop( dma_chan_t handle );
DESCRIPTION
Stop a DMA operation started with one of the DMAmem2ioe series functions.
DMAcompleted() will return TRUE after for an operation stopped with this function, but with less data length than the original request. It is OK to stop an operation that has currently completed; this has no effect. DMAcompleted() may be called to determine the actual amount of data transferred.
PARAMETER
Handle for channel to stop.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success
-EINVAL : Invalid handle
LIBRARY
DMA.LIB
SEE ALSO
66 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
DMAstopDirect
void DMAstopDirect( int channel );
DESCRIPTION
This function is defined to the following:
WrPortI(DMHR, NULL, 1 << channel);
Halt the corresponding DMA channel. The DMA registers obtain the current state and the DMA can be restarted using the DMCSR.
PARAMETER channel DMA channel (obtainable through DMAhandle2chan())
LIBRARY
DMA.LIB
SEE ALSO
DMAtimerSetup
void DMAtimerSetup( unsigned int divisor );
DESCRIPTION
This function sets up the DMA 16-bit divisor. To use the divisor, the DMA_F_TIMER flag must be passed to the transfer function.
PARAMETER divisor 16-bit divisor for the DMA timer
LIBRARY
DMA.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
67
DMAunalloc
int DMAunalloc( dma_chan_t handle );
DESCRIPTION
This function deallocates a handle, effectively closing the DMA channel to which it was associated.
PARAMETER handle Handle for DMA channel; returned by DMAalloc().
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success
-EINVAL : Error
LIBRARY
DMA.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
68 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
Enable_HW_WDT
void Enable_HW_WDT( void );
DESCRIPTION
Enables the hardware watchdog timer on the Rabbit processor. The watchdog is hit by the periodic interrupt, which is on by default.
LIBRARY
SYS.LIB
enableIObus
void enableIObus( void );
DESCRIPTION
This function enables external I/O bus operation on the Rabbit 3000 or Rabbit 4000. The external I/O bus must be enabled during any external I/O bus operation and disabled during normal bus operations with other devices.
Parallel port A becomes the I/O data bus and parallel port B bits 7:2 becomes the I/O address bus.
This function is non-reentrant.
Port A and B data shadow register values are NOT saved or restored in this function call.
If the macro PORTA_AUX_IO has been previously defined, this function should not be called.
LIBRARY
ExternIO.LIB (was in R3000.LIB prior to DC 10)
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
69
errlogGetHeaderInfo
root char* errlogGetHeaderInfo( void );
DESCRIPTION
Reads the error log header and formats the output.
When running stand alone (not talking to Dynamic C), this function reads the header directly from the log buffer. When in debug mode, this function reads the header from the copy in flash.
When a Dynamic C cold boot takes place, the header in RAM is zeroed out to initialize it, but first its contents are copied to an address in the BIOS code before the BIOS in RAM is copied to flash. This means that on the second cold boot, the data structure in flash will be zeroed out.
The configuration of the log buffer may still be read, and the log buffer entries are not affected.
Because the exception mechanism resets the processor by causing a watchdog time-out, the number of watchdog time-outs reported by this functions is the number of actual WDTOs plus the number of exceptions.
RETURN VALUE
A null terminated string containing the header information:
Status Byte: 0
#Exceptions: 5
Index last exception: 5
#SW Resets: 2
#HW Resets: 2
#WD Timeouts: 5
The string will contain “Header checksum invalid” if a checksum error occurs. The meaning of the status byte is as follows: bit 0 - An error has occurred since deployment bit 1 - The count of SW resets has rolled over.
bit 2 - The count of HW resets has rolled over.
bit 3 - The count of WDTOs has rolled over.
bit 4 - The count of exceptions has rolled over.
bit 5-7 - Not used
The index of the last exception is the index from the start of the error log entries. If this index does not equal the total exception count minus one, the error log entries have wrapped around the log buffer.
LIBRARY
ERRORS.LIB
70 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
errlogGetNthEntry
root int errlogGetNthEntry( int N );
DESCRIPTION
Loads errLogEntry structure with Nth entry of the error buffer. This must be called before the functions below that format the output.
PARAMETERS
N Index of entry to load into errLogEntry
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success, entry checksum okay.
-1 : Failure, entry checksum not okay.
LIBRARY
ERRORS.LIB
errlogFormatEntry
root char* errlogFormatEntry( void );
DESCRIPTION
Returns a null terminated string containing the basic information contained in errLogEntry:
Error type=240
Address = 00:16aa
Time: 06/11/2001 20:49:29
RETURN VALUE
The null terminated string described above.
LIBRARY
ERRORS.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
71
errlogFormatRegDump
root char* errlogFormatRegDump( void );
DESCRIPTION
Returns a null terminated string containing a register dump using the data in errLogEntry:
AF=0000,AF'=0000
HL=00f0,HL'=15e3
BC=16ce,BC'=1600
DE=0000,DE'=1731
IX=d3f1,IY =0560
SP=d3eb,XPC=0000
RETURN VALUE
The null terminated string described above.
LIBRARY
ERRORS.LIB
errlogFormatStackDump
root char * errlogFormatStackDump( void );
DESCRIPTION
Returns a null terminated string containing a stack dump using the data in errLogEntry.
Stack Dump:
0024,04f1, d378,c146, c400,a108,
2404,0000,
RETURN VALUE
The null terminated string describe above.
LIBRARY
ERRORS.LIB
72 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
errlogGetMessage
root char * errlogGetMessage( void );
DESCRIPTION
Returns a null terminated string containing the 8 byte message in errLogEntry.
RETURN VALUE
A null terminated string.
LIBRARY
ERRORS.LIB
errlogReadHeader
root int errlogReadHeader( void );
DESCRIPTION
Reads error log header into the structure errlogInfo.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success, entry checksum OK.
-1 : Failure, entry checksum not OK.
LIBRARY
ERRORS.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
73
error_message
unsigned long error_message( int message_index );
DESCRIPTION
Returns a physical pointer to a descriptive string for an error code listed in errno.lib. The sample program Samples\ErrorHandling\error_message_test.c illustrates the use of error_message(). The error message strings are defined in errors.lib.
PARAMETER message_index Positive or negative value of error return code.
RETURN VALUE
Physical address of string, or zero if error code is not listed.
LIBRARY
ERRORS.LIB
74 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
exception
int exception( int errCode );
DESCRIPTION
This function is called by Rabbit libraries when a runtime error occurs. It puts information relevant to the runtime error on the stack and calls the default runtime error handler pointed to by the ERROR_EXIT macro. To define your own error handler, see the defineErrorHandler() function.
When the error handler is called, the following information will be on the stack:
Location on Stack
SP+0
SP+2
SP+4
SP+6
SP+8
Description
Return address for error handler call
Runtime error code
(can be used for additional information)
XPC when exception() was called (upper byte)
Address where exception() was called from
RETURN VALUE
Runtime error code passed to it.
LIBRARY
ERRORS.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
75
exit
void exit( int exitcode );
DESCRIPTION
Stops the program and returns exitcode to Dynamic C. Dynamic C uses values above 128 for run-time errors. When not debugging, exit will run an infinite loop, causing a watchdog timeout if the watchdog is enabled.
PARAMETERS exitcode Error code passed by Dynamic C.
LIBRARY
SYS.LIB
exp
float exp( float x );
DESCRIPTION
Computes the exponential of real float value x.
PARAMETERS x Value to compute
RETURN VALUE
Returns the value of e x
.
If x > 89.8 (approx.), the function returns INF and signals a range error. If x < –89.8 (approx.), the function returns 0 and signals a range error.
LIBRARY
MATH.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
,
,
76 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
fabs
float fabs( float x );
DESCRIPTION
Computes the float absolute value of float x.
PARAMETERS x Value to compute.
RETURN VALUE x , if x >= 0, else -x.
LIBRARY
MATH.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
77
fat_AutoMount
int fat_AutoMount( word flags );
DESCRIPTION
Initializes the drivers in the default drivers configuration list in fat_config.lib and enumerates the devices in the default devices configuration list, then mounts partitions on enumerated devices according to the device's default configuration flags, unless overridden by the specified run time configuration flags. Despite its lengthy description, this function makes initializing multiple devices using the FAT library as easy as possible. The first driver in the configuration list becomes the primary driver in the system, if one is not already set up.
After this routine successfully returns, the application can start calling directory and file functions for the devices' mounted partitions.
If devices and/or partitions are not already formatted, this function can optionally format them according to the device's configuration or run time override flags.
This function may be called multiple times, but will not attempt to remount device partitions that it has already mounted. Once a device partition has been mounted by this function, unmounts and remounts must be handled by the application.
Even though this function may be called multiple times, it is not meant to be used as a polling or status function. For example, if you are using removable media such as an SD card, you
should call sdspi_debounce() to determine when the card is fully inserted into the socket.
There are two arrays of data structures that are populated by calling fat_AutoMount(). The array named fat_part_mounted[] is an array of pointers to fat_part structures. A fat_part structure holds information about a specific FAT partition. The other array,
_fat_device_table[] , is composed of pointers to mbr_dev structures. An mbr_dev structure holds information about a specific device. Partition and device structures are needed in many FAT function calls to specify the device and partition to be used.
An example of using fat_part_mounted[] was shown in the sample program fat_create.c
. FAT applications will need to scan fat_part_mounted[] to locate valid FAT partitions. A valid FAT partition must be identified before any file and directory operations can be performed. These pointers to FAT partitions may be used directly by indexing into the array or stored in a local pointer. The fat_shell.c sample uses an index into the array, whereas most other sample programs make a copy of the pointer.
An example of using _fat_device_table[] is in the sample program fat_shell.c.
This array is used in FAT operations of a lower level than fat_part_mounted[]. Specifically, when the device is being partitioned, formatted and/or enumerated. Calling fat_AutoMount() relieves most applications of the need to directly use fat_device_table[] .
78 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
PARAMETERS flags
fat_AutoMount (cont’d)
Run-time device configuration flags to allow overriding the default device configuration flags. If not overriding the default configuration flags, specify FDDF_USE_DEFAULT. To override the default flags, specify the
ORed combination of one or more of the following:
• FDDF_MOUNT_PART_0: Mount specified partition
• FDDF_MOUNT_PART_1:
• FDDF_MOUNT_PART_2:
• FDDF_MOUNT_PART_3:
• FDDF_MOUNT_PART_ALL: Mount all partitions
• FDDF_MOUNT_DEV_0: Apply to specified device
• FDDF_MOUNT_DEV_1:
• FDDF_MOUNT_DEV_2:
• FDDF_MOUNT_DEV_3:
• FDDF_MOUNT_DEV_ALL: Apply to all available devices
• FDDF_NO_RECOVERY: Use norecovery if fails first time
• FDDF_COND_DEV_FORMAT: Format device if unformatted
• FDDF_COND_PART_FORMAT: Format partition if unformatted
• FDDF_UNCOND_DEV_FORMAT: Format device unconditionally
• FDDF_UNCOND_PART_FORMAT: Format partition unconditionally
Note: The FDDF_MOUNT_PART_* flags apply equally to all
FDDF_MOUNT_DEV_* devices which are specified. If this is a problem, call this function multiple times with a single DEV flag bit each time.
Note: Formatting the device creates a single FAT partition covering the entire device. It is recommended that you always set the
*_PART_FORMAT flag bit if you set the corresponding
*_DEV_FORMAT flag bit.
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
79
fat_AutoMount (cont’d)
RETURN VALUE
0 : success
-EBADPART : partition is not a valid FAT partition
-EIO : Device I/O error
-EINVAL : invalid prtTable
-EUNFORMAT : device is not formatted
-ENOPART : no partitions exist on the device
-EBUSY : For non-blocking mode only, the device is busy. Call this function again to complete the close.
Any other negative value means that an I/O error occurred when updating the directory entry.
In this case, the file is forced to close, but its recorded length might not be valid.
LIBRARY
FAT.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
80 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
fat_Close
int fat_Close( FATfile *file );
DESCRIPTION
Closes a currently open file. You should check the return code since an I/O needs to be performed when closing a file to update the file's EOF offset (length), last access date, attributes and last write date (if modified) in the directory entry. This is particularly critical when using non-blocking mode.
PARAMETERS file Pointer to the open file to close.
RETURN VALUE
0 : success.
-EINVAL : invalid file handle.
-EBUSY : For non-blocking mode only, the device is busy. Call this function again to complete the close.
Any other negative value means that an I/O error occurred when updating the directory entry.
In this case, the file is forced to close, but its recorded length might not be valid.
LIBRARY
FAT.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
81
fat_CreateDir
int fat_CreateDir( fat_part *part, char *dirname );
DESCRIPTION
Creates a directory if it does not already exist. The parent directory must already exist.
In non-blocking mode, only one file or directory can be created at any one time, since a single static FATfile is used for temporary storage. Each time you call this function, pass the same dirname pointer (not just the same string contents).
PARAMETERS part dirname
Handle for the partition being used.
Pointer to the full path name of the directory to be created.
RETURN VALUE
0 : success.
-EINVAL : invalid argument. Trying to create volume label.
-ENOENT : parent directory does not exist.
-EPERM : the directory already exists or is write-protected.
-EBUSY : the device is busy (only if non-blocking).
-EFSTATE : if non-blocking, but a previous sequence of calls to this function (or fat_CreateFile() ) has not completed and you are trying to create a different file or directory. You must complete the sequence of calls for each file or directory i.e., keep calling until something other than -EBUSY is returned.
Other negative values are possible from fat_Open()/fat_Close() calls.
LIBRARY
FAT.LIB
SEE ALSO
82 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
fat_CreateFile
int fat_CreateFile( fat_part * part, char * filename, long alloc_size, FATfile * file );
DESCRIPTION
Creates a file if it does not already exist. The parent directory must already exist.
In non-blocking mode, if file is NULL, only one file or directory can be created at any one time, since a single static FATfile is used for temporary storage. Each time you call this function, pass the same dirname pointer (not just the same string contents).
Valid filenames are limited to an 8 character filename and 3 character extension separated by a period; this is commonly known as the “8.3” format. Examples include but are not limited to
“12345678.123”, “filename.txt”, and “webpage1.htm”.
PARAMETERS part filename alloc_size file
Pointer to the partition being used.
Pointer to the full pathname of the file to be created.
Initial number of bytes to pre-allocate. Note that at least one cluster will be allocated. If there is not enough space beyond the first cluster for the requested allocation amount, the file will be allocated with whatever space is available on the partition, but no error code will be returned. If not even the first cluster is allocated, the -ENOSPC error code will return. This initial allocation amount is rounded up to the next whole number of clusters.
If not NULL, the created file is opened and accessible using this handle.
If NULL, the file is closed after it is created.
RETURN VALUE
0 : success.
-EINVAL : part, filename, alloc_size, or file contain invalid values.
-ENOENT : the parent directory does not exist.
-ENOSPC : no allocatable sectors were found.
-EPERM : write-protected, trying to create a file on a read-only partition.
-EBUSY : the device is busy (non-blocking mode only).
-EFSTATE : if non-blocking, but a previous sequence of calls to this function (of fat_CreateFile) has not completed but you are trying to create a different file or directory. You must complete the sequence of calls for each file or directory i.e. keep calling until something other than -EBUSY is returned. This code is only returned if you pass a NULL file pointer, or if the file pointer is not NULL and the referenced file is already open.
-EPATHSTR : Bad file/directory path string. Valid filenames are limited to the 8.3 format.
Other negative values indicate I/O error, etc.
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
83
fat_CreateFile (cont’d)
LIBRARY
FAT.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
fat_CreateTime
int fat_CreateTime( fat_dirent *entry, struct tm *t );
DESCRIPTION
This function puts the creation date and time of the entry into the system time structure t. The function does not fill in the tm_wday field in the system time structure.
PARAMETERS entry t
Pointer to a directory entry
Pointer to a system time structure
RETURN VALUE
0: success.
-EINVAL: invalid directory entry or time pointer
LIBRARY
FAT.LIB
SEE ALSO
84 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
fat_Delete
int fat_Delete( fat_part *part, int type, char *name );
DESCRIPTION
Deletes the specified file or directory. The type must match or the deletion will not occur. This routine inserts a deletion code into the directory entry and marks the sectors as available in the
FAT table, but does not actually destroy the data contained in the sectors. This allows an undelete function to be implemented, but such a routine is not part of this library. A directory must be empty to be deleted.
PARAMETERS part type name
Handle for the partition being used.
Must be a FAT file (FAT_FILE) or a FAT directory (FAT_DIR), depending on what is to be deleted.
Pointer to the full path name of the file/directory to be deleted.
RETURN VALUE
0: success.
-EIO : device I/O error.
-EINVAL : part, type, or name contain invalid values.
-EPATHSTR : name is not a valid path/name string.
-EPERM : the file is open, write-protected, hidden, or system.
-ENOTEMPTY : the directory is not empty.
-ENOENT : the file/directory does not exist.
-EBUSY : the device is busy. (Only if non-blocking.)
-EPSTATE : if the partition is busy; i.e., there is an allocation in progress. (Only if non-blocking.)
LIBRARY
FAT.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
85
fat_EnumDevice
int fat_EnumDevice( mbr_drvr *driver, mbr_dev *dev, int devnum, char *sig, int norecovery );
DESCRIPTION
This routine is called to learn about the devices present on the driver passed in. The device will be added to the linked list of enumerated devices. Partition pointers will be set to NULL, indicating they have not been enumerated yet. Partition entries must be enumerated separately.
The signature string is an identifier given to the write-back cache, and must remain consistent between resets so that the device can be associated properly with any battery-backed cache entries remaining in memory.
This function is called by fat_AutoMount() and fat_Init().
PARAMETERS driver dev devnum sig norecovery
Pointer to an initialized driver structure set up during the initialization of the storage device driver.
Pointer to the device structure to be filled in.
Physical device number of the device.
Pointer to a unique signature string. Note that this value must remain the same between resets.
Boolean flag - set to True to ignore power-recovery data. True is any value except zero.
RETURN VALUE
0 : success.
-EIO : error trying to read the device or structure.
-EINVAL : devnum invalid or does not exist.
-ENOMEM : memory for page buffer/RJ is not available.
-EUNFORMAT : the device is accessible, but not formatted. You may use it provided it is formatted/partitioned by either this library or by another system.
-EBADPART : the partition table on the device is invalid.
-ENOPART : the device does not have any FAT partitions. This code is superseded by any other error detected.
-EEXIST : the device has already been enumerated.
-EBUSY : the device is busy (nonblocking mode only).
LIBRARY
FAT.LIB
SEE ALSO
86 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
fat_EnumPartition
int fat_EnumPartition( mbr_dev *dev, int pnum, fat_part *part );
DESCRIPTION
This routine is called to enumerate a partition on the given device. The partition information will be put into the FAT partition structure pointed to by part. The partition pointer will be linked to the device structure, registered with the write-back cache, and will then be active. The partition must be of a valid FAT type.
This function is called by fat_AutoMount() and fat_Init().
PARAMETERS dev pnum part
Pointer to an MBR device structure.
Partition number to link and enumerate.
Pointer to an FAT partition structure to be filled in.
RETURN VALUE
0 : success.
-EIO : error trying to read the device or structure.
-EINVAL : partition number is invalid.
-EUNFORMAT : the device is accessible, but not formatted.
-EBADPART : the partition is not a FAT partition.
-EEXIST : the partition has already been enumerated.
-EUNFLUSHABLE : there are no flushable sectors in the write-back cache.
-EBUSY : the device is busy (Only if non-blocking.).
LIBRARY
FAT.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
87
fat_FileSize
int fat_FileSize( FATfile *file, unsigned long *length );
DESCRIPTION
Puts the current size of the file in bytes into length.
PARAMETERS file length
Handle for an open file.
Pointer to the variable where the file length (in bytes) is to be placed.
RETURN VALUE
0 : success.
-EINVAL : file is invalid.
LIBRARY
FAT.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
88 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
fat_FormatDevice
int fat_FormatDevice( mbr_dev *dev, int mode );
DESCRIPTION
Formats a device. The device will have a DOS master boot record (MBR) written to it. Existing partitions are left alone if the device was previously formatted. The formatted device will be registered with the write-back cache for use with the FAT library. The one partition mode will instruct the routine to create a partition table, with one partition using the entire device. This mode only works if the device is currently unformatted or has no partitions.
If needed (i.e., there is no MBR on the device), this function is called by fat_AutoMount() if its flags parameter allows it.
PARAMETERS dev mode
Pointer to the data structure for the device to format.
Mode:
0 = normal (use the partition table in the device structure)
1 = one partition using the entire device (errors occur if there are already partitions in the device structure)
3 = force one partition for the entire device (overwrites values already in the device structure)
RETURN
0 : success .
-EIO : error trying to read the device or structure.
-EINVAL : device structure is invalid or does not exist.
-ENOMEM : memory for page buffer/RJ is not available.
-EEXIST : the device is already formatted.
-EPERM : the device already has mounted partition(s).
-EBUSY : the device is busy. (Only if non-blocking.)
LIBRARY
FAT.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
89
fat_FormatPartition
int fat_FormatPartition( mbr_dev *dev, fat_part *part, int pnum, int type, char *label, int (*usr)() );
DESCRIPTION
Formats partition number pnum according to partition type. The partition table information in the device must be valid. This will always be the case if the device was enumerated. The partition type must be a valid FAT type. Also note that the partition is not mounted after the partition is formatted. If -EBUSY is returned, the partition structure must not be disturbed until a subsequent call returns something other than -EBUSY.
If needed (i.e., fat_MountPartition() returned error code -EBADPART), this function is called by fat_AutoMount().
PARAMETERS dev part pnum type label usr
Pointer to a device structure containing partitions.
Pointer to a FAT partition structure to be linked. Note that opstate must be set to zero before first call to this function if the library is being used in the nonblocking mode.
Partition number on the device (0–3).
Partition type.
Pointer to a partition label string.
Pointer to a user routine.
RETURN VALUE
0 : success.
-EIO : error in reading the device or structure.
-EINVAL : the partition number is invalid.
-EPERM : write access is not allowed.
-EUNFORMAT : the device is accessible, but is not formatted.
-EBADPART : the partition is not a valid FAT partition.
-EACCES : the partition is currently mounted.
-EBUSY : the device is busy (Only if non-blocking.).
LIBRARY
FAT.LIB
SEE ALSO
90 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
fat_Free
int fat_Free( fat_part *part );
DESCRIPTION
This function returns the number of free clusters on the partition.
PARAMETERS part Handle to the partition.
RETURN VALUE
Number of free clusters on success
0: partition handle is bad or partition is not mounted.
LIBRARY
FAT.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
91
fat_GetAttr
int fat_GetAttr( FATfile *file );
DESCRIPTION
This function gets the given attributes to the file. Use the defined attribute flags to check the value:
• FATATTR_READ_ONLY - The file can not be modified.
• FATATTR_HIDDEN - The file is not visible when doing normal operations.
• FATATTR_SYSTEM - This is a system file and should be left alone.
• FATATTR_VOLUME_ID - This is the name of a logical disk.
• FATATTR_DIRECTORY - This is a directory and not a file.
• FATATTR_ARCHIVE - This tells you when the file was last modified.
• FATATTR_LONG_NAME - This is a FAT32 or long file name. It is not supported.
PARAMETERS file Handle to the open file.
RETURN VALUE
Attributes on success
-EINVAL : invalid file handle.
LIBRARY
FAT.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
92 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
fat_GetName
int fat_GetName( fat_dirent *entry, char *buf, word flags );
DESCRIPTION
Translates the file or directory name in the fat_dirent structure into a printable name. FAT file names are stored in a strict fixed-field format in the fat_dirent structure (returned from fat_Status , for example). This format is not always suitable for printing, so this function should be used to convert the name to a printable null-terminated string.
PARAMETERS entry buf flags
Pointer to a directory entry obtained by fat_Status().
Pointer to a char array that will be filled in. This array must be at least 13 characters long.
May be one of the following:
• 0 - standard format, e.g., AUTOEXEC.BAT or XYZ.GIF
• FAT_LOWERCASE - standard format, but make lower case.
RETURN VALUE
0 : success.
-EINVAL : invalid (NULL) parameter(s).
LIBRARY
FAT.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
93
fat_GetPartition
int fat_GetPartition ( fat_part **part, char **file, char * fullpath);
DESCRIPTION
Split a full pathname (e.g., “a:/filename.txt”) into a paritition and filename.
Examples (with FAT_USE_FORWARDSLASH defined): a:/filename.txt > partition A, /filename.txt
/b/filename.txt > partition B, /filename.txt
C:filename.txt > partition C, /filename.txt
Examples (without FAT_USE_FORWARDSLASH defined): a:\filename.txt > partition A, \filename.txt
\b\filename.txt > partition B, \filename.txt
C:filename.txt > partition C, \filename.txt
PARAMETERS part file fullpath
Memory location to store a pointer to the fat partition (drive letter).
Memory location to store a pointer into fullpath (parameter 3) where the filename begins.
Pathname to parse.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success
-EINVAL : unable to parse <fullpath>
LIBRARY
FAT.LIB
94 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
fat_Init
int fat_Init( int pnum, mbr_drvr *driver, mbr_dev *dev, fat_part
*part, int norecovery );
DESCRIPTION
Initializes the default driver in MBR_DRIVER_INIT, enumerates device 0, then enumerates and mounts the specified partition. This function was replaced with the more powerful fat_AutoMount() . fat_Init() will only work with device 0 of the default driver. This driver becomes the primary driver in the system.
The application can start calling any directory or file functions after this routine returns successfully.
The desired partition must already be formatted. If the partition mount fails, you may call the function again using a different partition number (pnum). The device will not be initialized a second time.
PARAMETERS pnum driver dev part norecovery
Partition number to mount (0-3).
Pointer to the driver structure to fill in.
Pointer to the device structure to fill in.
Pointer to the partition structure to fill in.
Boolean flag - set to True to ignore power-recovery data. True is any value except zero.
RETURN VALUE
0 : success .
-EIO : device I/O error.
-EINVAL : pnum, driver, or device, or part is invalid.
-EUNFORMAT : the device is not formatted.
-EBADPART : the partition requested is not a valid FAT partition.
-ENOPART : no partitions exist on the device.
-EBUSY : the device is busy. (Only if non-blocking.)
LIBRARY
FAT.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
95
fat_InitUCOSMutex
void fat_InitUCOSMutex( int mutexPriority );
DESCRIPTION
This function was introduced in FAT version 2.10. Prior versions of the FATfile system are compatible with µC/OS-II only if FAT API calls are confined to one µC/OS-II task. The FAT API is not reentrant from multiple tasks without the changes made in FAT version 2.10. If you wish to use the FAT file system from multiple µC/COS tasks, you must do the following:
1. The statement #define FAT_USE_UCOS_MUTEX must come before the statement:
#use FAT.LIB
2. After calling OSInit() and before starting any tasks that use the FAT, call fat_InitUCOSMutex(mutexPriority) . The parameter mutexPriority is a
µC/OS-II task priority that must be higher than the priorities of all tasks that call FAT API functions.
3. You must not call low-level, non-API FAT or write-back cache functions. Only call FAT functions appended with “fat_” and with public function descriptions.
4. Run the FAT in blocking mode ( #define FAT_BLOCK ).
Mutex timeouts or other errors will cause a run-time error -ERR_FAT_MUTEX_ERROR.
µC/OS-II may raise the priority of tasks using mutexes to prevent priority inversion.
The default mutex time-out in seconds is given by FAT_MUTEX_TIMEOUT_SEC, which defaults to 5 seconds if not defined in the application before the statement #use FAT.LIB.
PARAMETERS mutexPriority A µC/OS-II task priority that MUST be higher than the priorities of all tasks that call FAT API functions.
RETURN VALUE
None: success.
-ERR_FAT_MUTEX_ERROR : A run-time error causes an exception and the application will exit with this error code.
LIBRARY
FAT.LIB
SEE ALSO
96 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
fat_IsClosed
int fat_IsClosed( FATfile far * file);
DESCRIPTION
Returns non-zero if the FATfile passed is not open and zero if open.
(Currently implemented as a macro, but may be modified to be an actual function in a future release.)
PARAMETER file Pointer to a FATfile structure to check.
RETURN VALUE
1: file is closed
0: file is open
LIBRARY fat.lib
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
97
fat_IsOpen
int fat_IsOpen( FATfile far * file);
DESCRIPTION
Returns TRUE if the FATfile passed is in an open state and FALSE otherwise.
(Currently implemented as a macro, but may be modified to be an actual function in a future release.)
PARAMETER file Pointer to a FATfile structure to check.
RETURN VALUE
!0 if file is open
0 if file is closed
LIBRARY fat.lib
SEE ALSO
98 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
fat_LastAccess
int fat_LastAccess( fat_dirent *entry, struct tm *t );
DESCRIPTION
Puts the last access date of the specified entry into the system time structure t. The time is always set to midnight. The function does not fill in the tm_wday field in the system time structure.
PARAMETERS entry t
Pointer to a directory entry
Pointer to a system time structure
RETURN VALUE
0 : success.
-EINVAL : invalid directory entry or time pointer
LIBRARY
FAT.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
99
fat_LastWrite
int fat_LastWrite( fat_dirent *entry, struct tm *t );
DESCRIPTION
Puts the date and time of the last write for the given entry into the system time structure t. The function does not fill in the tm_wday field in the system time structure.
PARAMETERS entry t
Pointer to a directory entry
Pointer to a system time structure
RETURN VALUE
0 : success.
-EINVAL : invalid directory entry or time pointer
LIBRARY
FAT.LIB
SEE ALSO
100 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
fat_MountPartition
int fat_MountPartition( fat_part *part );
DESCRIPTION
Marks the enumerated partition as mounted on both the FAT and MBR level. The partition
MUST be previously enumerated with fat_EnumPartition().
This function is called by fat_AutoMount() and fat_Init().
PARAMETER part Pointer to the FAT partition structure to mount.
RETURN VALUE
0 : success.
-EINVAL : device or partition structure or part is invalid.
-EBADPART : the partition is not a FAT partition.
-ENOPART : the partition does not exist on the device.
-EPERM : the partition has not been enumerated.
-EACCESS : the partition is already linked to another fat_part structure.
-EBUSY : the device is busy. (Only if non-blocking.)
LIBRARY
FAT.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
101
fat_Open
int fat_Open( fat_part *part, char *name, int type, int ff,
FATfile *file, long *prealloc );
DESCRIPTION
Opens a file or directory, optionally creating it if it does not already exist. If the function returns
-EBUSY , call it repeatedly with the same arguments until it returns something other than
-EBUSY .
PARAMETERS part name type ff file prealloc
Handle for the partition being used.
Pointer to the full path name of the file to be opened/created.
FAT_FILE or FAT_DIR, depending on what is to be opened/created.
File flags, must be one of:
• FAT_OPEN - Object must already exist. If it does not exist, -ENOENT will be returned.
• FAT_CREATE - Object is created only if it does not already exist
• FAT_MUST_CREATE - Object is created, and it must not already exist.
• FAT_READONLY - No write operations (this flag is mutually exclusive with any of the CREATE flags).
• FAT_SEQUENTIAL - Optimize for sequential reads and/or writes. This setting can be changed while the file is open by using the fat_fcntl() function.
Pointer to an empty FAT file structure that will act as a handle for the newly opened file. Note that you must memset this structure to zero when you are using the non-blocking mode before calling this function the first time.
Keep calling until something other than -EBUSY is returned, but do not change anything in any of the parameters while doing so.
An initial byte count if the object needs to be created. This number is rounded up to the nearest whole number of clusters greater than or equal to
1. This parameter is only used if one of the *_CREATE flag is set and the object does not already exist. On return, *prealloc is updated to the actual number of bytes allocated. May be NULL, in which case one cluster is allocated if the call is successful.
102 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
fat_Open (cont’d)
RETURN VALUE
0 : success.
-EINVAL : invalid arguments. Trying to create volume label, or conflicting flags.
-ENOENT : file/directory could not be found.
-EPATHSTR : Invalid path string for parent directory
-EEXIST : object existed when FAT_MUST_CREATE flag set.
-EPERM : trying to create a file/directory on a read-only partition.
-EMFILE - too many open files. If you get this code, increase the FAT_MAXMARKERS definition in the BIOS.
Other negative values indicate I/O error, etc.
Non-blocking mode only:
-EBUSY : the device is busy (nonblocking mode only).
-EFSTATE - file structure is not in a valid state. Usually means it was not zerod before calling this function for the first time (for that file) struct, when in non-blocking mode; can also occur if the same file struct is opened more than once.
LIBRARY
FAT.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
103
fat_OpenDir
int fat_OpenDir( fat_part *part, char *dirname, FATfile *dir );
DESCRIPTION
Opens a directory for use, filling in the FATfile handle.
PARAMETERS part dirname dir
Pointer to the partition structure being used.
Pointer to the full path name of the directory to be opened or created.
Pointer to directory requested.
RETURN VALUE
0 : success
-EINVA L: invalid argument.
-ENOENT : the directory cannot be found.
-EBUSY : the device is busy (Only if non-blocking).
Other negative values are possible from the fat_Open() call.
LIBRARY
FAT.LIB
SEE ALSO
104 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
fat_PartitionDevice
int fat_PartitionDevice( mbr_dev *dev, int pnum );
DESCRIPTION
This function partitions the device by modifying the master boot record (MBR), which could destroy access to information already on the device. The partition information contained in the specified mbr_dev structure must be meaningful, and the sizes and start positions must make sense (no overlapping, etc.). If this is not true, you will get an -EINVAL error code. The device being partitioned must already have been formatted and enumerated.
This function will only allow changes to one partition at a time, and this partition must either not exist or be of a FAT type.
The validity of the new partition will be verified before any changes are done to the device. All other partition information in the device structure (for those partitions that are not being modified) must match the values currently existing on the MBR. The type given for the new partition must either be zero (if you are deleting the partition) or a FAT type.
You may not use this function to create or modify a non-FAT partition.
PARAMETERS dev pnum
Pointer to the device structure of the device to be partitioned.
Partition number of the partition being modified.
RETURN VALUE
0 : success.
-EIO : device I/O error.
-EINVAL : pnum or device structure is invalid.
-EUNFORMAT : the device is not formatted.
-EBADPART : the partition is a non-FAT partition.
-EPERM : the partition is mounted.
-EBUSY : the device is busy (Only if non-blocking).
LIBRARY
FAT.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
105
fat_Read
int fat_Read( FATfile *file, char *buf, int len );
DESCRIPTION
Given file, buf, and len, this routine reads len characters from the specified file and places the characters into buf. The function returns the number of characters actually read on success. Characters are read beginning at the current position of the file and the position pointer will be left pointing to the next byte to be read. The file position can be changed by the fat_Seek() function. If the file contains fewer than len characters from the current position to the EOF, the transfer will stop at the EOF. If already at the EOF, 0 is returned. The len parameter must be positive, limiting reads to 32767 bytes per call.
PARAMETERS file buf len
Handle for the file being read.
Pointer to the buffer where data are to be placed.
Length of data to be read.
RETURN VALUE
Number of bytes read: success. May be less than the requested amount in non-blocking mode, or if EOF was encountered.
-EEOF : starting position for read was at (or beyond) end-of-file.
-EIO : device I/O error.
-EINVAL : file, buf, or len, contain invalid values.
-EPERM : the file is locked.
-ENOENT : the file/directory does not exist.
-EFSTATE : file is in inappropriate state (Only if non-blocking).
LIBRARY
FAT.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
106 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
fat_ReadDir
int fat_ReadDir( FATfile *dir, fat_dirent *entry, int mode );
DESCRIPTION
Reads the next entry of the desired type from the given directory, filling in the entry structure.
PARAMETERS dir entry mode
Pointer to the handle for the directory being read.
Pointer to the handle to the entry structure to fill in.
0 = next active file or directory entry including read only (no hidden, sys, label, deleted or empty)
A nonzero value sets the selection based on the following attributes:
• FATATTR_READ_ONLY - include read-only entries
• FATATTR_HIDDEN - include hidden entries
• FATATTR_SYSTEM - include system entries
• FATATTR_VOLUME_ID - include label entries
• FATATTR_DIRECTORY - include directory entries
• FATATTR_ARCHIVE - include modified entries
• FAT_FIL_RD_ONLY - filter on read-only attribute
• FAT_FIL_HIDDEN - filter on hidden attribute
• FAT_FIL_SYSTEM - filter on system attribute
• FAT_FIL_LABEL - filter on label attribute
• FAT_FIL_DIR - filter on directory attribute
• FAT_FIL_ARCHIVE - filter on modified attribute
The FAT_INC_* flags default to FAT_INC_ACTIVE if none set:
• FAT_INC_DELETED - include deleted entries
• FAT_INC_EMPTY - include empty entries
• FAT_INC_LNAME - include long name entries
• FAT_INC_ACTIVE - include active entries
The following predefined filters are available:
• FAT_INC_ALL - returns ALL entries of ANY type
• FAT_INC_DEF - default (files and directories including read-only and archive)
Note: Active files are included by default unless FAT_INC_DELETED,
FAT_INC_EMPTY , or FAT_INC_LNAME is set. Include flags become the desired filter value if the associated filter flags are set.
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
107
fat_ReadDir (cont’d)
EXAMPLES OF FILTER BEHAVIOR mode = FAT_INC_DEF | FATFIL_HIDDEN | FATATTR_HIDDEN would return the next hidden file or directory ( including read-only and archive) mode = FAT_INC_DEF|FAT_FIL_HIDDEN|FAT_FIL_DIR|FATATTR_HIDDEN would return next hidden directory (but would not return any hidden file) mode = FAT_INC_DEF|FAT_FIL_HIDDEN|FAT_FIL_DIR|
FATATTR_HIDDEN & ~FATATTR_DIRECTORY would return next hidden file (but would not return any hidden directory) mode = FAT_INC_ALL & ~FAT_INC_EMPTY would return the next non-empty entry of any type
RETURN VALUE
0: success.
-EINVAL : invalid argument.
-ENOENT : directory does not exist
-EEOF : no more entries in the directory
-EFAULT : directory chain has link error
-EBUSY : the device is busy (non-blocking mode only)
Other negative values from the fat_Open() call are also possible.
LIBRARY
FAT.LIB
SEE ALSO
108 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
fat_Seek
int fat_Seek( FATfile *file, long pos, int whence );
DESCRIPTION
Positions the internal file position pointer. fat_Seek() will allocate clusters to the file if necessary, but will not move the position pointer beyond the original end of file (EOF) unless doing a SEEK_RAW. In all other cases, extending the pointer past the original EOF will preallocate the space that would be needed to position the pointer as requested, but the pointer will be left at the original EOF and the file length will not be changed. If this occurs, an EOF error will be returned to indicate the space was allocated but the pointer was left at the EOF.
PARAMETERS file pos whence
Pointer to the file structure of the open file.
Position value in number of bytes (may be negative). This value is interpreted according to the third parameter, whence.
Must be one of the following:
• SEEK_SET - pos is the byte position to seek, where 0 is the first byte of the file. If pos is less than 0, the position pointer is set to 0 and no error code is returned. If pos is greater than the length of the file, the position pointer is set to EOF and error code -EEOF is returned.
• SEEK_CUR - seek pos bytes from the current position. If pos is less than 0 the seek is towards the start of the file. If this goes past the start of the file, the position pointer is set to 0 and no error code is returned.
If pos is greater than 0 the seek is towards EOF. If this goes past EOF the position pointer is set to EOF and error code -EEOF is returned.
• SEEK_END - seek to pos bytes from the end of the file. That is, for a file that is x bytes long, the statement: fat_Seek (&my_file, -1, SEEK_END); will cause the position pointer to be set at x-1 no matter its value prior to the seek call. If the value of pos would move the position pointer past the start of the file, the position pointer is set to 0 (the start of the file) and no error code is returned. If pos is greater than or equal to 0, the position pointer is set to EOF and error code -EEOF is returned..
• SEEK_RAW - is similar to SEEK_SET, but if pos goes beyond EOF, using SEEK_RAW will set the file length and the position pointer to pos .
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
109
fat_Seek (cont’d)
RETURN VALUE
0 : success.
-EIO : device I/O error.
-EINVAL : file, pos, or whence contain invalid values.
-EPERM : the file is locked or writes are not permitted.
-ENOENT : the file does not exist.
-EEOF : space is allocated, but the pointer is left at original EOF.
-ENOSPC : no space is left on the device to complete the seek.
-EBUSY : the device is busy (Only if non-blocking).
-EFSTATE : if file in inappropriate state (Only if non-blocking).
LIBRARY
FAT.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
,
110 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
fat_SetAttr
int fat_SetAttr( FATfile *file, int attr );
DESCRIPTION
This function sets the given attributes to the file. Use defined attribute flags to create the set values.
PARAMETERS file attr
Handle to the open file.
Attributes to set in file. For attribute description see fat_GetAttr() .
May be one or more of the following:
• FATATTR_READ_ONLY
• FATATTR_HIDDEN
• FATATTR_SYSTEM
• FATATTR_VOLUME_ID
• FATATTR_DIRECTORY
• FATATTR_ARCHIVE
• FATATTR_LONG_NAME
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success
-EIO : on device IO error
-EINVAL : invalid open file handle
-EPERM : if the file is locked or write not permitted
-EBUSY : if the device is busy. (Only if non-blocking)
LIBRARY
FAT.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
111
fat_Split
int fat_Split( FATfile *file, long where, char *newfile );
DESCRIPTION
Splits the original file at where and assigns any left over allocated clusters to newfile. As the name implies, newfile is a newly created file that must not already exist. Upon completion, the original file is closed and the file handle is returned pointing to the created and opened new file. The file handle given must point to a file of type FAT_FILE. There are internal static variables used in this function, so only one file split operation can be active. Additional requests will be held off with -EBUSY returns until the active split completes.
PARAMETERS file where newfile
Pointer to the open file to split.
May be one of the following:
•
0 - absolute byte to split the file. If the absolute byte is beyond the
EOF, file is split at EOF.
• FAT_BRK_END - split at EOF.
• FAT_BRK_POS - split at current file position.
Pointer to the absolute path and name of the new file created for the split.
RETURN VALUE
0: success.
-EIO : device I/O error.
-EINVAL : file has invalid references.
-EPATHSTR : newfile is not a valid path/name string.
-EEOF : no unused clusters are available for newfile. file will be unchanged and open, newfile is not created.
-EPERM : file is in use, write-protected, hidden, or system.
-ENOENT : file does not exist.
-ETYPE : file is not a FAT file type.
-EBUSY : the device is busy (Only non-blocking mode).
-EFSTATE : if file in inappropriate state (Only non-blocking mode).
LIBRARY
FAT.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
112 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
fat_Status
int fat_Status( fat_part *part, char *name, fat_dirent *entry );
DESCRIPTION
Scans for the specified entry and fills in the entry structure if found without opening the directory or entry.
PARAMETERS part name entry
Pointer to the partition structure being used.
Pointer to the full path name of the entry to be found.
Pointer to the directory entry structure to fill in.
RETURN VALUE
0 : success.
-EIO : device I/O error.
-EINVAL : part, filepath, or entry are invalid.
-ENOENT : the file/directory/label does not exist.
-EBUSY : the device is busy (Only non-blocking mode). If you get this error, call the function again without changing any parameters.
LIBRARY
FAT.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
113
fat_SyncFile
int fat_SyncFile( FATfile *file );
DESCRIPTION
Updates the directory entry for the given file, committing cached size, dates, and attribute fields to the actual directory. This function has the same effect as closing and re-opening the file.
PARAMETERS file Pointer to the open file.
RETURN VALUE
0 : success.
-EINVAL : file is invalid.
-EPERM - this operation is not permitted on the root directory.
-EBUSY : the device is busy (Only if non-blocking). Call function again to complete the update.
-EFSTATE - file not open or in an invalid state.
Any other negative value: I/O error when updating the directory entry.
LIBRARY
FAT.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
114 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
fat_SyncPartition
int fat_SyncPartition( fat_part *part );
DESCRIPTION
Flushes all cached writes to the specified partition to the actual device.
PARAMETER part Pointer to the partition to be synchronized.
RETURN VALUE
0 : success.
-EINVAL : part is invalid.
-EBUSY : the device is busy (Only if non-blocking). Call function again to complete the sync.
Any other negative value: I/O error when updating the device.
LIBRARY
FAT.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
115
fat_Tell
int fat_Tell( FATfile *file, unsigned long *pos );
DESCRIPTION
Puts the value of the position pointer (that is, the number of bytes from the beginning of the file) into pos . Zero indicates the position pointer is at the beginning of the file.
µC/OS-II USERS:
•
The FAT API is not reentrant. To use the FAT from multiple µC/OS-II tasks, put the following statement in your application:
#define FAT_USE_UCOS_MUTEX
•
Mutex timeouts or other mutex errors will cause the run-time error
ERR_FAT_MUTEX_ERROR . The default mutex timeout is 5 seconds and can be changed by #define'ing a different value for FAT_MUTEX_TIMEOUT_SEC.
•
You MUST call fat_InitUCOSMutex() after calling OSInit() and before calling any other FAT API functions.
•
You must run the FAT in blocking mode (#define FAT_BLOCK).
•
You must not call low-level, non-API FAT or write-back cache functions. Only call FAT functions appended with “fat_” and with public function descriptions.
PARAMETERS file pos
Pointer to the file structure of the open file
Pointer to the variable where the value of the file position pointer is to be placed.
RETURN VALUE
0 : success.
-EIO : position is beyond EOF.
-EINVAL : file is invalid.
LIBRARY
FAT.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
,
116 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
fat_tick
int fat_tick( void );
DESCRIPTION
Drive device I/O completion and periodic flushing. It is not generally necessary for the application to call this function; however, if it is called regularly (when the application has nothing else to do) then file system performance may be improved.
RETURN VALUE
Currently always 0.
LIBRARY
FATWTC.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
117
fat_Truncate
int fat_Truncate( FATfile *file, long where );
DESCRIPTION
Truncates the file at where and frees any left over allocated clusters. The file must be a
FAT_FILE type.
PARAMETERS file where
Pointer to the open file to truncate.
One of the following:
•
0 - absolute byte to truncate the file. The file is truncated at EOF if the absolute byte is beyond EOF.
• FAT_BRK_END - truncate at EOF.
• FAT_BRK_POS - truncate at current file position.
RETURN VALUE
0 : success.
-EIO : device I/O error.
-EINVAL : file is invalid.
-EPERM : file is in use, write-protected, hidden, or system.
-ENOENT : the file does not exist.
-ETYPE : file is not a FAT file type.
-EBUSY : the device is busy (Only if non-blocking).
-EFSTATE : if file in inappropriate state (Only if non-blocking)
LIBRARY
FAT.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
118 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
fat_UnmountDevice
int fat_UnmountDevice( mbr_dev * dev );
DESCRIPTION
Unmounts all FAT partitions on the given device and unregisters the device from the cache system. This commits all cache entries to the device and prepares the device for power down or removal. The device structure given must have been enumerated with fat_EnumDevice().
This function was introduced in FAT module version 2.06. Applications using prior versions of the FAT module would call fat_UnmountPartition() instead.
PARAMETER dev Pointer to a FAT device structure to unmount.
RETURN VALUE
0 : success.
-EINVAL : device structure (dev) is invalid.
-EBUSY : the device is busy (Only if non-blocking).
LIBRARY
FAT.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
119
fat_UnmountPartition
int fat_UnmountPartition( fat_part *part );
DESCRIPTION
Marks the enumerated partition as unmounted on both the FAT and the master boot record levels. The partition must have been already enumerated using fat_EnumPartition()
(which happens when you call fat_AutoMount()).
To unmount all FAT partitions on a device call fat_UnmountDevice(), a function introduced with FAT version 2.06. It not only commits all cache entries to the device, but also prepares the device for power down or removal.
Note: The partitions on a removable device must be unmounted in order to flush data before removal. Failure to unmount a partition that has been written could cause damage to the FAT file system.
PARAMETERS part Pointer to a FAT partition structure to unmount.
RETURN VALUE
0 : success.
-EINVAL : device or partition structure or pnum is invalid.
-EBADPART : the partition is not a FAT partition.
-ENOPART : the partition does not exist on the device.
-EPERM : the partition has not been enumerated.
-EBUSY : the device is busy (only if non-blocking ).
LIBRARY
FAT.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
120 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
fat_Write
int fat_Write( FATfile *file, char *buf, int len );
DESCRIPTION
Writes characters into the file specified by the file pointer beginning at the current position in the file. Characters will be copied from the string pointed to by buf. The len variable controls how many characters will be written. This can be more than one sector in length, and the write function will allocate additional sectors if needed. Data is written into the file starting at the current file position regardless of existing data. Overwriting at specific points in the file can be accomplished by calling the fat_Seek() function before calling fat_Write().
PARAMETERS file buf len
Handle for the open file being written.
Pointer to the buffer containing data to write.
Length of data to be written.
RETURN VALUE
Number of bytes written: success (may be less than len, or zero if non-blocking mode)
-EIO : device I/O error.
-EINVAL : file, buf, or len contain invalid values.
-ENOENT : file does not exist.
-ENOSPC : no space left on the device to complete the write.
-EFAULT : problem in file (broken cluster chain, etc.).
-EPERM : the file is locked or is write-protected.
-EBUSY : the device is busy (only if non-blocking).
-EFSTATE : file is in inappropriate state (only if non-blocking).
LIBRARY
FAT.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
121
fat_xRead
fat_xRead( FATfile * file, char far * buf, int len );
DESCRIPTION
Given file, buf and len, this routine reads len characters from the specified file and places the characters into string buf. Returns the number of characters actually read on success.
Characters will be read beginning at the current position of the file and the position pointer will be left pointing to the next byte to be read. The file position can be manually set with the fat_Seek() function. If the file contains less the “len” characters from the current position to the end of the file (EOF), then the transfer will stop at the EOF. If already at the EOF, -EEOF is returned. The len parameter must be positive, limiting reads to 32767 bytes per call.
µC/OS-II USERS:
•
The FAT API is not reentrant from multiple tasks. To use the FAT from multiple µC/OS-
II tasks, put the following statement in your application:
#define FAT_USE_UCOS_MUTEX
•
Mutex timeouts or other mutex errors cause a run-time error ERR_FAT_MUTEX_ERROR.
The default mutex timeout is 5 seconds and can be changed by #define'ing a different value for FAT_MUTEX_TIMEOUT_SEC.
•
You MUST call fat_InitUCOSMutex() after calling OSInit() and before calling any other FAT API functions.
•
You must run the FAT in blocking mode (#define FAT_BLOCK).
•
You must not call low-level, non-API FAT or write-back cache functions. Only call FAT functions appended with “fat_” and with public function descriptions.
PARAMETERS file buf len
Handle for the file being read
Pointer to buffer where data is to be placed. May be NULL in order to discard data
Length of data to be read. If this is zero, then the return code will be ‘1’ if not at EOF, or ‘0’ if at EOF.
122 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
fat_xRead (cont’d)
RETURN VALUE
Number of bytes read on Success. May be less than the requested amount in non-blocking mode, or if EOF was encountered.
-EEOF : stating position for read was at (or beyond) EOF.
-EIO : on device IO error
-EINVAL : if file, buf, or len contain invalid values
-EPERM : if the file is locked
-ENOENT : if file/directory does not exist
-EFSTATE : if file in inappropriate state (non-blocking)
SEE ALSO
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
123
fat_xWrite
int fat_xWrite( FATfile *file, long xbuf, int len );
DESCRIPTION
Writes characters into the file specified by the file pointer beginning at the current position in the file. Characters will be copied from the xmem string pointed to by xbuf. The len variable controls how many characters will be written. This can be more than one sector in length, and the write function will allocate additional sectors if needed. Data will be written into the file starting at the current file position regardless of existing data. Overwriting at specific points in the file can be accomplished by calling the fat_Seek() function before calling fat_xWrite().
PARAMETERS file xbuf len
Handle for the open file being written.
xmem address of the buffer to be written.
Length of data to write.
RETURN VALUE
Number of bytes written: success. (may be less than len, or zero if non-blocking mode)
-EIO : device I/O error.
-EINVAL : file, xbuf, or len contain invalid values.
-ENOENT : the file/directory does not exist.
-ENOSPC : there are no more sectors to allocate on the device.
-EFAULT : there is a problem in the file (broken cluster chain, etc.).
-EPERM : the file is locked or write-protected.
-EBUSY : the device is busy (only if non-blocking).
-EFSTATE : file is in inappropriate state (only if non-blocking).
LIBRARY
FAT.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
,
124 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
fclose
void fclose( File* f );
DESCRIPTION
Closes a file.
PARAMETERS f
LIBRARY
FILESYSTEM.LIB
The pointer to the file to close.
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
125
fcreate (FS1)
int fcreate( File* f, FileNumber fnum );
DESCRIPTION
Creates a file. Before calling this function, a variable of type File must be defined in the application program.
File file; fcreate (&file, 1);
PARAMETERS f fnum
The pointer to the created file.
This is a user-defined number in the range of 1 to127 inclusive. Each file in the flash file system is assigned a unique number in this range.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success.
1 : Failure.
LIBRARY
FILESYSTEM.LIB
126 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
fcreate (FS2)
int fcreate( File* f, FileNumber name );
DESCRIPTION
Create a new file with the given “file name” which is composed of two parts: the low byte is the actual file number (1 to 255 inclusive), and the high byte contains an extent number (1 to
_fs.num_lx
) on which to place the file metadata. The extent specified by fs_set_lx() is always used to determine the actual data extent. If the high byte contains 0, then the default metadata extent specified by fs_set_lx() is used. The file descriptor is filled in if successful. The file will be opened for writing, so a further call to fopen_wr() is not necessary.
The number of files which may be created is limited by the lower of FS_MAX_FILES and 255.
This limit applies to the entire filesystem (all logical extents). Once a file is created, its data and metadata extent numbers are fixed for the life of the file, i.e., until the file is deleted.
When created, no space is allocated in the file system until the first write occurs for the file.
Thus, if the system power is cycled after creation but before the first byte is written, the file will be effectively deleted. The first write to a file causes one sector to be allocated for the metadata.
Before calling this function, a variable of type File must be defined in the application program. (The sizeof() function will return the number of bytes used for the File data structure.)
File file; fcreate (&file, 1);
PARAMETERS f name
Pointer to the file descriptor to fill in.
File number including optional metadata extent number.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success.
!0
: Failure.
ERRNO VALUES
EINVAL - Zero file number requested, or invalid extent number.
EEXIST - File with given number already exists.
ENFILE - No space is available in the existing file table. If this error occurs, increase the definition of FS_MAX_FILES, a #define constant that should be declared before #use
"fs2.lib" .
LIBRARY fs2 .LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
127
fcreate_unused (FS1)
FileNumber fcreate_unused( File * f );
DESCRIPTION
Searches for the first unused file number in the range 1 through 127, and creates a file with that number.
PARAMETERS f The pointer to the created file.
RETURN VALUE
The FileNumber (1-127) of the new file if success.
LIBRARY
FILESYSTEM.LIB
SEE ALSO
128 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
fcreate_unused (FS2)
FileNumber fcreate_unused( File * f );
DESCRIPTION
Create a new file and return the “file name” which is a number between 1 and 255. The new file will be created on the current default extent(s) as specified by fs_set_lx(). Other behavior is the same as fcreate().
PARAMETERS f Pointer to file descriptor to fill in.
RETURN VALUE
>0 : Success, the FileNumber (1-255) of the new file.
0 : Failure.
ERRNO VALUE
ENFILE - No unused file number available.
LIBRARY fs2.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
129
fdelete (FS1)
int fdelete( FileNumber fnum );
DESCRIPTION
Deletes a file.
PARAMETERS fnum
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success.
1 : Failure.
LIBRARY
FILESYSTEM.LIB
A number in the range 1 to 127 inclusive that identifies the file in the flash file system.
130 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
fdelete (FS2)
int fdelete( FileNumber name );
DESCRIPTION
Delete the file with the given number. The specified file must not be open. The file number (i.e. name ) is composed of two parts: the low byte contains the actual file number, and the high byte
(if not zero) contains the metadata extent number of the file.
PARAMETERS name File number (1 to 255 inclusive).
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success.
!0
: Failure.
LIBRARY fs2 .LIB
ERRNO VALUES
ENOENT - File doesn’t exist, or metadata extent number doesn’t match an existing file.
EBUSY - File is open.
EIO - I/O error when releasing blocks occupied by this file.
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
131
fflush (FS2)
int fflush( File * f );
DESCRIPTION
Flush any buffers, associated with the given file, retained in RAM to the underlying hardware device. This ensures that the file is completely written to the filesystem. The file system does not currently perform any buffering, however future revisions of this library may introduce buffering to improve performance.
PARAMETERS f Pointer to open file descriptor.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success.
!0
: Failure.
ERRNO VALUES
EBADFD - file invalid or not open.
EIO - I/O error.
LIBRARY fs2.
LIB
SEE ALSO
132 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
fftcplx
void fftcplx( int * x, int N, int * blockexp );
DESCRIPTION
Computes the complex DFT of the N-point complex sequence contained in the array x and returns the complex result in x. N must be a power of 2 and lie between 4 and 1024. An invalid
N causes a RANGE exception. The N-point complex sequence in array x is replaced with its
N -point complex spectrum. The value of blockexp is increased by 1 each time array x has to be scaled, to avoid arithmetic overflow.
PARAMETERS x
N blockexp
Pointer to N-element array of complex fractions.
Number of complex elements in array x.
Pointer to integer block exponent.
LIBRARY
FFT.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
133
fftcplxinv
void fftcplxinv( int * x, int N, int * blockexp );
DESCRIPTION
Computes the inverse complex DFT of the N-point complex spectrum contained in the array x and returns the complex result in x. N must be a power of 2 and lie between 4 and 1024. An invalid N causes a RANGE exception. The value of blockexp is increased by 1 each time array x has to be scaled, to avoid arithmetic overflow. The value of blockexp is also de-
creased by log
2
N to include the 1/N factor in the definition of the inverse DFT
PARAMETERS x
N blockexp
Pointer to N-element array of complex fractions.
Number of complex elements in array x.
Pointer to integer block exponent.
LIBRARY
FFT.LIB
SEE ALSO
134 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
fftreal
void fftreal( int * x, int N, int * blockexp );
DESCRIPTION
Computes the N-point, positive-frequency complex spectrum of the 2N-point real sequence in array x. The 2N-point real sequence in array x is replaced with its N-point positive-frequency complex spectrum. The value of blockexp is increased by 1 each time array x has to be scaled, to avoid arithmetic overflow.
The imaginary part of the X[0] term (stored in x[1]) is set to the real part of the fmax term.
The 2N-point real sequence is stored in natural order. The zeroth element of the sequence is stored in x[0], the first element in x[1], and the kth element in x[k].
N must be a power of 2 and lie between 4 and 1024. An invalid N causes a RANGE exception.
PARAMETERS x
N blockexp
Pointer to 2N-point sequence of real fractions.
Number of complex elements in output spectrum
Pointer to integer block exponent.
LIBRARY
FFT.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
135
fftrealinv
void fftrealinv( int * x, int N, int * blockexp );
DESCRIPTION
Computes the 2N-point real sequence corresponding to the N-point, positive-frequency complex spectrum in array x. The N-point, positive-frequency spectrum contained in array x is replaced with its corresponding 2N-point real sequence. The value of blockexp is increased by 1 each time array x has to be scaled, to avoid arithmetic overflow. The value of blockexp is also
decreased by log
2
N to include the 1/N factor in the definition of the inverse DFT.
The function expects to find the real part of the fmax term in the imaginary part of the zero-frequency X[0] term (stored x[1]).
The 2N-point real sequence is stored in natural order. The zeroth element of the sequence is stored in x[0], the first element in x[1], and the kth element in x[k].
N must be a power of 2 and between 4 and 1024. An invalid N causes a RANGE exception.
PARAMETERS x
N blockexp
Pointer to N-element array of complex fractions.
Number of complex elements in array x.
Pointer to integer block exponent.
LIBRARY
FFT.LIB
SEE ALSO
136 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
flash_erasechip
void flash_erasechip( FlashDescriptor * fd );
DESCRIPTION
Erases an entire flash memory chip.
Note: fd must have already been initialized with flash_init before calling this function. See flash_init description for further restrictions.
PARAMETERS fd Pointer to flash descriptor of the chip to erase.
LIBRARY
FLASH.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
137
flash_erasesector
int flash_erasesector( FlashDescriptor * fd, word which );
DESCRIPTION
Erases a sector of a flash memory chip.
Note: fd must have already been initialized with flash_init before calling this function. See flash_init description for further restrictions.
PARAMETERS fd which
Pointer to flash descriptor of the chip to erase a sector of.
The sector to erase.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success.
LIBRARY
FLASH.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
,
138 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
flash_gettype
int flash_gettype( FlashDescriptor * fd );
DESCRIPTION
Returns the 16-bit flash memory type of the flash memory.
Note: fd must have already been initialized with flash_init before calling this function. See flash_init description for further restrictions.
PARAMETERS fd The FlashDescriptor of the memory to query.
RETURN VALUE
The integer representing the type of the flash memory.
LIBRARY
FLASH.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
139
flash_init
int flash_init( FlashDescriptor * fd, int mb3cr );
DESCRIPTION
Initializes an internal data structure of type FlashDescriptor with information about the flash memory chip. The Memory Interface Unit bank register (MB3CR) will be assigned the value of mb3cr whenever a function accesses the flash memory referenced by fd. See the Rab-
bit 2000 Users Manual for the correct chip select and wait state settings.
Note: Improper use of this function can cause your program to be overwritten or operate incorrectly. This and the other flash memory access functions should not be used on the same flash memory that your program resides on, nor should they be used on the same region of a second flash memory where a file system resides.
Use WriteFlash() to write to the primary flash memory.
PARAMETERS fd mb3cr
This is a pointer to an internal data structure that holds information about a flash memory chip.
This is the value to set MB3CR to whenever the flash memory is accessed.
0xc2 (i.e., CS2, /OE0, /WE0, 0 WS) is a typical setting for the second flash memory on the TCP/IP Dev Kit, the Intellicom, the Advanced Ethernet
Core, and the RabbitLink.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success.
1 : Invalid flash memory type.
-1 : Attempt made to initialize primary flash memory.
LIBRARY
FLASH.LIB
SEE ALSO
140 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
flash_read
int flash_read( FlashDescriptor * fd, word sector, word offset, unsigned long buffer, word length );
DESCRIPTION
Reads data from the flash memory and stores it in buffer.
Note: fd must have already been initialized with flash_init before calling this function. See the flash_init description for further restrictions.
PARAMETERS fd sector offset buffer length
The FlashDescriptor of the flash memory to read from.
The sector of the flash memory to read from.
The displacement, in bytes, from the beginning of the sector to start reading at.
The physical address of the destination buffer. TIP: A logical address can be changed to a physical with the function paddr.
The number of bytes to read.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success.
LIBRARY
FLASH.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
141
flash_readsector
int flash_readsector( FlashDescriptor * fd, word sector, unsigned long buffer );
DESCRIPTION
Reads the contents of an entire sector of flash memory into a buffer.
Note: fd must have already been initialized with flash_init before calling this function. See flash_init description for further restrictions.
PARAMETERS fd sector buffer
The FlashDescriptor of the flash memory to read from.
The source sector to read.
The physical address of the destination buffer. TIP: A logical address can be changed to a physical with the function paddr().
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success.
LIBRARY
FLASH.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
142 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
flash_sector2xwindow
void * flash_sector2xwindow( FlashDescriptor * fd, word sector );
DESCRIPTION
This function sets the MB3CR and XPC value so the requested sector falls within the XPC window. The MB3CR is the Memory Interface Unit bank register. XPC is one of four Memory
Management Unit registers. See flash_init description for restrictions.
PARAMETERS fd sector
The FlashDescriptor of the flash memory.
The sector to set the XPC window to.
RETURN VALUE
The logical offset of the sector.
LIBRARY
FLASH.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
143
flash_writesector
int flash_writesector( FlashDescriptor * fd, word sector, unsigned long buffer );
DESCRIPTION
Writes the contents of buffer to sector on the flash memory referenced by fd.
Note: fd must have already been initialized with flash_init before calling this function. See flash_init description for further restrictions.
PARAMETERS fd sector buffer
The FlashDescriptor of the flash memory to write to.
The destination sector.
The physical address of the source. TIP: A logical address can be changed to a physical address with the function paddr().
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success.
LIBRARY
FLASH.LIB
SEE ALSO
144 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
floor
float floor( float x );
DESCRIPTION
Computes the largest integer less than or equal to the given number.
PARAMETERS x Value to round down.
RETURN VALUE
Rounded down value.
LIBRARY
MATH.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
fmod
float fmod( float x, float y );
DESCRIPTION
Calculates modulo math.
PARAMETERS x y
Dividend
Divisor
RETURN VALUE
Returns the remainder of x/y. The remaining part of x after all multiples of y have been removed. For example, if x is 22.7 and y is 10.3, the integral division result is 2. Then the remainder is: 22.7 – 2 × 10.3 = 2.1.
LIBRARY
MATH.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
145
fopen_rd (FS1)
int fopen_rd( File * f, FileNumber fnum );
DESCRIPTION
Opens a file for reading.
PARAMETERS f fnum
A pointer to the file to read.
A number in the range 1 to 127 inclusive that identifies the file in the flash file system.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success.
1 : Failure.
LIBRARY
FILESYSTEM.LIB
146 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
fopen_rd (FS2)
int fopen_rd( File * f, FileNumber name );
DESCRIPTION
Open file for reading only. See fopen_wr() for a more detailed description.
PARAMETERS f name
Pointer to file descriptor (uninitialized).
File number (1 to 255 inclusive).
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success.
!0
: Failure.
ERRNO VALUES
ENOENT - File does not exist, or metadata extent number does not match an existing file.
LIBRARY fs2.lib
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
147
fopen_wr (FS1)
int fopen_wr( File * f, FileNumber fnum );
DESCRIPTION
Opens a file for writing.
PARAMETERS f fnum
A pointer to the file to write.
A number in the range 1 to 127 inclusive that identifies the file in the flash file system.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success.
1 : Failure.
LIBRARY
FILESYSTEM.LIB
148 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
fopen_wr (FS2)
int fopen_wr( File * f, FileNumber name );
DESCRIPTION
Open file for read or write. The given file number is composed of two parts: the low byte contains the file number (1 to 255 inclusive) and the high byte, if not zero, contains the metadata extent number. If the extent number is zero, it defaults to the correct metadata extent - this is for the purpose of validating an expected extent number. Most applications should just pass the file number with zero high byte.
A file may be opened multiple times, with a different file descriptor pointer for each call, which allows the file to be read or written at more than one position at a time. A reference count for the actual file is maintained, so that the file can only be deleted when all file descriptors referring to this file are closed.
fopen_wr() or fopen_rd() must be called before any other function from this library is called that requires a File pointer. The "current position" is set to zero i.e. the start of the file.
When a file is created, it is automatically opened for writing thus a subsequent call to fopen_wr() is redundant.
PARAMETERS f name
Pointer to file descriptor (uninitialized).
File number (1 to 255 inclusive).
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success.
!0
: Failure.
ERRNO VALUES
ENOENT - File does not exist, or metadata extent number does not match an existing file.
LIBRARY fs2.lib
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
149
forceSoftReset
void forceSoftReset( void );
DESCRIPTION
Forces the board into a software reset by jumping to the start of the BIOS.
LIBRARY
SYS.LIB
fread (FS1)
int fread( File * f, char * buf, int len );
DESCRIPTION
Reads len bytes from a file pointed to by f, starting at the current offset into the file, into buffer. Data is read into buffer pointed to by buf.
PARAMETERS f buf len
A pointer to the file to read from.
A pointer to the destination buffer.
Number of bytes to copy.
RETURN VALUE
Number of bytes read.
LIBRARY
FILESYSTEM.LIB
150 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
fread (FS2)
int fread( File * f, void * buf, int len );
DESCRIPTION
Read data from the “current position” of the given file. When the file is opened, the current position is 0, meaning the start of the file. Subsequent reads or writes advance the position by the number of bytes read or written. fseek() can also be used to position the read point.
If the application permits, it is much more efficient to read multiple data bytes rather than reading one-by-one.
PARAMETERS f buf len
Pointer to file descriptor (initialized by fopen_rd(), fopen_wr() or fcreate() ).
Data buffer located in root data memory or stack. This must be dimensioned with at least len bytes.
Length of data to read (0 to 32767 inclusive).
RETURN VALUE len : Success.
<len: Partial success. Returns amount successfully read. errno gives further details (probably 0 meaning that end-of-file was encountered).
0 : Failure, or len was zero.
LIBRARY
FS2.LIB
ERRNO VALUES
EBADFD - File descriptor not opened.
EINVAL - len less than zero.
0 - Success, but len was zero or EOF was reached prior to reading len bytes.
EIO - I/O error.
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
151
frexp
float frexp( float x, int * n );
DESCRIPTION
Splits x into a fraction and exponent, f * ( 2 n
).
PARAMETERS x n
Number to split
An integer
RETURN VALUE
The function returns the exponent in the integer *n and the fraction between 0.5, inclusive and
1.0.
LIBRARY
MATH.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
152 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
fs_format (FS1)
int fs_format( long reserveblocks, int num_blocks, unsigned long wearlevel );
DESCRIPTION
Initializes the internal data structures and file system. All blocks in the file system are erased.
PARAMETERS reserveblocks Starting address of the flash file system. When FS_FLASH is defined this value should be 0 or a multiple of the block size. When FS_RAM is defined this parameter is ignored.
num_blocks wearlevel
The number of blocks to allocate for the file system. With a default block size of 4096 bytes and a 256K flash memory, this value might be
64.
This value should be 1 on a new flash memory, and some higher value on an unformatted used flash memory. If you are reformatting a flash memory you can set wearlevel to 0 to keep the old wear leveling.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success.
1 : Failure.
LIBRARY
FILESYSTEM.LIB
EXAMPLE
This program can be found in samples/filesystem/format.c.
#define FS_FLASH
#use "filesystem.lib"
#define RESERVE 0
#define BLOCKS 64
#define WEAR 1 main() { if(fs_format(RESERVE,BLOCKS,WEAR)) { printf("error formatting flash\n");
} else { printf("flash successfully formatted\n");
}
}
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
153
fs_format (FS2)
int fs_format( long reserveblocks, int num_blocks, unsigned wearlevel
);
DESCRIPTION
Format all extents of the file system. This must be called after calling fs_init(). Only extents that are not defined as reserved are formatted. All files are deleted.
PARAMETERS reserveblocks Must be zero. Retained for backward compatibility.
num_blocks wearlevel
Ignored (backward compatibility).
Initial wearlevel value. This should be 1 if you have a new flash, and some larger number if the flash is used. If you are reformatting a flash, you can use 0 to use the old flash wear levels.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success.
!0
: Failure.
ERRNO VALUES
EINVAL - the reserveblocks parameter was non-zero.
EBUSY - one or more files were open.
EIO - I/O error during format. If this occurs, retry the format operation If it fails again, there is probably a hardware error.
SEE ALSO
154 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
fs_init (FS1)
int fs_init( long reserveblocks, int num_blocks );
DESCRIPTION
Initialize the internal data structures for an existing file system. Blocks that are used by a file are preserved and checked for data integrity.
PARAMETERS reserveblocks Starting address of the flash file system. When FS_FLASH is defined this value should be 0 or a multiple of the block size. When FS_RAM is defined this parameter is ignored.
num_blocks The number of blocks that the file system contains. By default the block size is 4096 bytes.
RETURN VALUE
0 :Success.
1 : Failure.
LIBRARY
FILESYSTEM.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
155
fs_init (FS2)
int fs_init( long reserveblocks, int num_blocks );
DESCRIPTION
Initialize the filesystem. The static structure _fs contains information that defines the number and parameters associated with each extent or “partition.” This function must be called before any of the other functions in this library, except for fs_setup(), fs_get_*_lx() and fs_get_lx_size() .
Pre-main initialization will create up to 3 devices:
• The second flash device (if available on the board)
• Battery-backed SRAM (if FS2_RAM_RESERVE defined)
• The first (program) flash (if both XMEM_RESERVE_SIZE and
FS2_USE_PROGRAM_FLASH defined)
The LX numbers of the default devices can be obtained using the fs_get_flash_lx(), fs_get_ram_lx() and fs_get_other_lx() calls. If none of these devices can be set up successfully, fs_init() will return ENOSPC when called.
This function performs complete consistency checks and, if necessary, fixups for each LX. It may take up to several seconds to run. It should only be called once at application initialization time.
Note: When using µC/OS-II, fs_init() must be called before OSInit().
PARAMETERS reserveblocks Must be zero. Retained for backward compatibility.
num_blocks Ignored (backward compatibility).
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success.
!0
: Failure.
ERRNO VALUES
EINVAL - the reserveblocks parameter was non-zero.
EIO - I/O error. This indicates a hardware problem.
ENOMEM - Insufficient memory for required buffers.
ENOSPC - No valid extents obtained e.g. there is no recognized flash or RAM memory device available.
LIBRARY fs2.lib
SEE ALSO
156 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
fs_reserve_blocks (FS1)
int fs_reserve_blocks( int blocks );
DESCRIPTION
Sets up a number of blocks that are guaranteed to be available for privileged files. A privileged file has an identifying number in the range 128 through 143. This function is not needed in most cases. If it is used, it should be called immediately after fs_init or fs_format.
PARAMETERS blocks Number of blocks to reserve.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success.
1 : Failure.
LIBRARY
FILESYSTEM.LIB
fsck (FS1)
int fsck( int flash );
DESCRIPTION
Check the filesystem for errors
PARAMETERS flash A bitmask indicating which checks to NOT perform. The following checks are available:
FSCK_HEADERS - Block headers.
FSCK_CHECKSUMS - Data checksums.
FSCK_VERSION - Block versions, from a failed write.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success.
!0
: Failure, this is a bitmask indicating which checks failed.
LIBRARY
FILESYSTEM.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
157
fseek (FS1)
int fseek( File * f, long to, char whence );
DESCRIPTION
Places the read pointer at a desired location in the file.
PARAMETERS f to whence
A pointer to the file to seek into.
The number of bytes to move the read pointer. This can be a positive or negative number.
The location in the file to offset from. This is one of the following constants.
SEEK_SET - Seek from the beginning of the file.
SEEK_CUR - Seek from the current read position in the file.
SEEK_END - Seek from the end of the file.
EXAMPLE
To seek to 10 bytes from the end of the file f, use fseek(f, -10, SEEK_END);
To rewind the file f by 5 bytes, use fseek(f, -5, SEEK_CUR);
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success.
1 : Failure.
LIBRARY
FILESYSTEM.LIB
158 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
fseek (FS2)
int fseek( File * f, long where, char whence );
DESCRIPTION
Set the current read/write position of the file. Bytes in a file are sequentially numbered starting at zero. If the current position is zero, then the first byte of the file will be read or written. If the position equals the file length, then no data can be read, but any write will append data to the file.
fseek() allows the position to be set relative to the start or end of the file, or relative to its current position.
In the special case of SEEK_RAW, an unspecified number of bytes beyond the known end-offile may be readable. The actual amount depends on the amount of space left in the last internal block of the file. This mode only applies to reading, and is provided for the purpose of data recovery in the case that the application knows more about the file structure than the filesystem.
PARAMETERS f where whence
Pointer to file descriptor (initialized by fopen_rd(), fopen_wr() or fcreate() ).
New position, or offset.
One of the following values:
SEEK_SET : 'where' (non-negative only) is relative to start of file.
SEEK_CUR : 'where' (positive or negative) is relative to the current position.
SEEK_END : 'where' (non-positive only) is relative to the end of the file.
SEEK_RAW : Similar to SEEK_END, except the file descriptor is set in a special mode which allows reading beyond the end of the file.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success.
!0
: The computed position was outside of the current file contents, and has been adjusted to the nearest valid position.
ERRNO VALUES
None.
LIBRARY
FS2.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
159
fs_get_flash_lx (FS2)
FSLXnum fs_get_flash_lx( void );
DESCRIPTION
Returns the logical extent number of the preferred flash device. This is the second flash if one is available on your hardware, otherwise it is the reserved area in your program flash. In order for the program flash to be available for use by the file system, you must define two constants: the first constant is XMEM_RESERVE_SIZE near the top of BIOS\RABBITBIOS.C. This value is set to the amount of program flash to reserve (in bytes). This is required by the BIOS.
The second constant is set in your code before #use "fs2.lib".
FS2_USE_PROGRAM_FLASH must be defined to the number of KB (1024 bytes) that will actually be used by the file system. If this is set to a larger value than the actual amount of reserved space, then only the actual amount will be used.
The sample program SAMPLES\FILESYSTEM\FS2INFO.C demonstrates use of this function.
This function may be called before calling fs_init().
RETURN VALUE
0 : There is no flash file system available.
!0
: Logical extent number of the preferred flash.
LIBRARY
FS2.lib
SEE ALSO
160 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
fs_get_lx (FS2)
FSLXnum fs_get_lx( int meta );
DESCRIPTION
Return the current extent (LX) number for file creation. Each file has two parts: the main bulk of data, and the metadata which is a relatively small, fixed, amount of data used to journal changes to the file. Both data and metadata can reside on the same extent, or they may be separated.
PARAMETERS meta 1 : return logical extent number for metadata.
0 : return logical extent number for data.
RETURN VALUE
Logical extent number.
LIBRARY
FS2.lib
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
161
fs_get_lx_size (FS2)
long fs_get_lx_size( FSLXnum lxn, int all, word ls_shift );
DESCRIPTION
Returns the size of the specified logical extent, in bytes. This information is useful when initially partitioning an LX, or when estimating the capacity of an LX for user data. all is a flag which indicates whether to return the total data capacity (as if all current files were deleted) or whether to return just the available data capacity. The return value accounts for the packing efficiency which will be less than 100% because of the bookkeeping overhead. It does not account for the free space required when any updates are performed; however this free space may be shared by all files on the LX. It also does not account for the space required for file metadata.
You can account for this by adding one logical sector for each file to be created on this LX. You can also specify that the metadata be stored on a different LX by use of fs_set_lx().
This function may be called either before or after fs_init(). If called before, then the ls_shift parameter must be set to the value to be used in fs_setup(), since the LS size is not known at this point. ls_shift can also be passed as zero, in which case the default size will be assumed. all must be non-zero if called before fs_init(), since the number of files in use is not yet known.
PARAMETERS lxn all ls_shift
Logical extent number to query.
Boolean: 0 for current free capacity only, 1 for total.
Must use 1 if calling before fs_init().
Logical sector shift i.e. log base 2 of LS size (6 to 13); may be zero to use default.
RETURN VALUE
0 : The specified LX does not exist.
!0
: Capacity of the LX in bytes.
LIBRARY
FS2.lib
162 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
fs_get_other_lx (FS2)
FSLXnum fs_get_other_lx( void );
DESCRIPTION
Returns the logical extent number of the non-preferred flash device. If it exists, this is usually the program flash. See the description under fs_get_flash_lx() for details about setting up the program flash for use by the filesystem.
The sample program Samples\FILESYSTEM\FS2INFO.C demonstrates use of this function.
This function may be called before calling fs_init().
RETURN VALUE
0 : There is no other flash filesystem available.
!0
: Logical extent number of the non-preferred flash.
LIBRARY
FS2.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
163
fs_get_ram_lx (FS2)
FSLXnum fs_get_ram_lx( void );
DESCRIPTION
Return the logical extent number of the RAM file system device. This is only available if you have defined FS2_RAM_RESERVE to a non-zero number of bytes in the BIOS.
A RAM filesystem is only really useful if you have battery-backed SRAM on the board. You can still use a RAM file system on volatile RAM, but of course files will not persist over power cycles and you should explicitly format the RAM filesystem at power-up.
The sample program Samples\FILESYSTEM\FS2INFO.C demonstrates use of this function.
This function may be called before calling fs_init().
RETURN VALUE
0 : There is no RAM filesystem available.
!0
: Logical extent number of the RAM device.
LIBRARY
FS2.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
164 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
fs_set_lx (FS2)
int fs_set_lx( FSLXnum meta, FSLXnum data );
DESCRIPTION
Sets the default logical extent (LX) numbers for file creation. Each file has two parts: the main bulk of data, and the metadata which is a relatively small, fixed amount of data used to journal changes to the file. Both data and metadata can reside on the same extent, or they may be separated. The metadata, no matter where it is located, consumes one sector.
The file creation functions allow the metadata extent to be explicitly specified (in the high byte of the file number), however it is usually easier to call fs_set_lx() to set appropriate defaults. Calling fs_set_lx() is the only way to specify the data extent.
If fs_set_lx() is never called, both data and metadata will default to the first non-reserved extent number.
PARAMETERS meta data
Extent number for metadata.
Extent number for data.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success.
!0
: Error, e.g. non-existent LX number.
ERRNO VALUES
ENODEV - no such extent number, or extent is reserved.
LIBRARY
FS2.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
165
fs_setup (FS2)
FSLXnum fs_setup( FSLXnum lxn, word ls_shift, int reserve_it, void * rfu, int partition_it, word part, word part_ls_shift, int part_reserve, void * part_rfu );
DESCRIPTION
To modify or add to the default extents, this function must be called before calling fs_init() . If called after fs_init(), the filesystem will be corrupted.
fs_setup() runs in one of two basic modes, determined by the partition_it parameter. If partition_it is non-zero, then the specified extent (lxn, which must exist), is split into two extents according to the given proportions. If partition_it is zero, then the specified extent must not exist; it is created. This use is beyond the scope of this note, since it involves filesystem internals. The paritioning usage is described here. partition_it may be FS_MODIFY_EXTENT in which case the base extent, lxn, is modified to use the specified ls_shift and reserve_it parameters (the other parameters are ignored).
partition_it may be set to FS_PARTITION_FRACTION (other values reserved). This causes extent number lxn to be split. The first half is still referred to as extent lxn, and the other half is assigned a new extent number, which is returned.
The base extent number may itself have been previously partitioned, or it should be 1 for the
2nd flash device, or possibly 2 for the NVRAM device.
PARAMETERS lxn ls_shift
Base extent number to partition or modify.
New logical sector size to assign to base partition, or zero to not alter it.
This is expressed as the log base 2 of the desired size, and must be a number between 6 and 13 inclusive.
reserve_it rfu
TRUE if base partition is to be marked reserved.
A pointer reserved for future use. Pass as null.
partition_it Must be set to FS_PARTITION_FRACTION or
FS_MODIFY_EXTENT . The following parameters are ignored if this parameter is not FS_PARTITION_FRACTION.
166 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
fs_setup (FS2) (cont’d)
part The fraction of the existing base extent to assign to the new extent. This number is expressed as a fixed-point binary number with the binary point to the left of the MSB e.g. 0x3000 assigns 3/16 of the base extent to the new partition, updating the base extent to 13/16 of its original size. The nearest whole number of physical sectors is used for each extent.
part_ls_shift Logical sector size to assign to the new extent, or zero to use the same
LS size as the base extent. Expressed in same units as parameter 2.
part_reserve part_rfu
TRUE if the new extent is to be reserved.
A pointer reserved for future use. Pass as null.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Failure, extent could not be partitioned.
!0
: Success, number of the new extent, or same as lxd for existing extent modification.
ERRNO VALUES
ENOSPC - one or other half would contain an unusably small number of logical sectors, or the extent table is full. In the latter case, #define FS_MAX_LX to a larger value.
EINVAL - partition_it set to an invalid value, or other parameter invalid.
ENODEV - specified base extent number not defined.
LIBRARY
FS2.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
167
fs_sync (FS2)
int fs_sync( void );
DESCRIPTION
Flush any buffers retained in RAM to the underlying hardware device. The file system does not currently perform any buffering, however future revisions of this library may introduce buffering to improve performance. This function is similar to fflush(), except that the entire file system is synchronized instead of the data for just one file. Use fs_sync() in preference to fflush() if there is only one extent in the filesystem.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success.
!0
: Failure.
ERRNO VALUES
EIO - I/O error.
LIBRARY
FS2.LIB
SEE ALSO
168 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
ftell (FS1)
long ftell( File * f );
DESCRIPTION
Gets the offset from the beginning of a file that the read pointer is currently at.
TIP: ftell() can be used with fseek() to find the length of a file. fseek(f, 0, SEEK_END); // seek to the end of the file
FileLength = ftell(f); // find the length of the file
PARAMETERS f A pointer to the file to query.
RETURN VALUE
The offset in bytes of the read pointer from the beginning of the file: Success.
-1 : Failure.
LIBRARY
FILESYSTEM.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
169
ftell (FS2)
long ftell( File * f );
DESCRIPTION
Return the current read/write position of the file. Bytes in a file are sequentially numbered starting at zero. If the current position is zero, then the first byte of the file will be read or written.
If the position equals the file length, then no data can be read, but any write will append data to the file.
Note that no checking is done to see if the file descriptor s valid. If the File is not actually open, the return value will be random.
PARAMETERS f Pointer to file descriptor (initialized by fopen_rd(), fopen_wr() or fcreate() ).
RETURN VALUE
Current read/write position (0 to length-of-file).
ERRNO VALUES
None
LIBRARY fs2.lib
SEE ALSO
170 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
fshift
int fshift( File * f, int len, void * buf );
DESCRIPTION
Delete data from the start of a file opened for writing. Optionally, the data that was removed can be read into a buffer. The “current position” of the file descriptor is adjusted to take account of the changed file offsets. If the current position is pointing into the data that is removed, then it is set to zero, i.e., the start of data immediately after the deleted section.
The specified file must not be opened with other file descriptors, otherwise an EBUSY error is returned. The exception to this is if FS2_SHIFT_DOESNT_UPDATE_FPOS is defined before
#use fs2.lib
. If defined, multiple file descriptors can be opened, but their current position will not be updated if fshift() is used. In this case, the application should explicitly use fseek() on all file descriptors open on this file (including the one used to perform the fshift() ). If this is not done, then their current position is effectively advanced by the number of characters shifted out by the fshift().
The purpose of this function is to make it easy to implement files which worm their way through the filesystem: adding at the head and removing at the tail, such that the total file size remains approximately constant.
Surprisingly, it is possible for an out-of-space error to occur, since the addition of the journaling
(meta-data) entry for the shift operation may cause an error before deleted blocks (if any) are made available.
PARAMETERS f len
*buf
Pointer to file descriptor (initialized by fopen_wr() or fcreate()).
Length of data to remove (0 to 32767 inclusive).
Data buffer located in root data memory or stack. This must be dimensioned with at least len bytes. This parameter may also be null if the deleted data is not needed.
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
171
fshift (cont’d)
RETURN VALUE len : Success.
<len : Partial success - returns amount successfully deleted. errno gives further details (probably ENOSPC)
0 : Error or len was zero.
ERRNO VALUES
EBADFD - File descriptor not opened, or is read-only.
EINVAL - len less than zero.
0 - Success, but len was zero.
EIO - I/O error.
ENOSPC - extent out of space.
EBUSY - file opened more than once. This is only possible if
FS2_SHIFT_DOESNT_UPDATE_FPOS is not defined, which is the default case.
LIBRARY
FS2.LIB
SEE ALSO
172 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
fwrite (FS1)
int fwrite( File * f, char * buf, int len );
DESCRIPTION
Appends len bytes from the source buffer to the end of the file.
PARAMETERS f buf len
A pointer to the file to write to.
A pointer to the source buffer.
The number of bytes to write.
RETURN VALUE
The number of bytes written: Success.
0 : Failure.
LIBRARY
FILESYSTEM.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
173
fwrite (FS2)
int fwrite( File * f, void * buf, int len );
DESCRIPTION
Write data to file opened for writing. The data is written starting at the current position. This is zero (start of file) when it is opened or created, but may be changed by fread(), fwrite(), fshift() or fseek() functions. After writing the data, the current position is advanced to the position just after the last byte written. Thus, sequential calls to fwrite() will add or append data contiguously.
Unlike the previous file system (FILESYSTEM.LIB), this library allows files to be overwritten not just appended. Internally, overwrite and append are different operations with differing performance, depending on the underlying hardware. Generally, appending is more efficient especially with byte-writable flash memory. If the application allows, it is preferable to use append/shift rather than overwrite. In order to ensure that data is appended, use fseek(f, 0,
SEEK_END) before calling fwrite().
The same current-position pointer is used for both read and write. If interspersing read and write, then fseek() should be used to ensure the correct position for each operation. Alternatively, the same file can be opened twice, with one descriptor used for read and the other for write. This precludes use of fshift(), since it does not tolerate shared files.
PARAMETERS f buf len
Pointer to file descriptor (initialized by fopen_wr() or fcreate()).
Data buffer located in root data memory or stack.
Length of data (0 to 32767 inclusive).
RETURN VALUE len : Success.
<len : Partial success. Returns amount successfully written. errno gives details.
0 : Failure, or len was zero.
ERRNO VALUES
EBADFD - File descriptor not opened, or is read-only.
EINVAL - len less than zero.
0 - Success, but len was zero.
EIO - I/O error.
ENOSPC - extent out of space.
LIBRARY fs2.LIB
SEE ALSO
174 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
ftoa
int ftoa( float f, char * buf );
DESCRIPTION
Converts a float number to a character string.
The character string only displays the mantissa up to 9 digits, no decimal points, and a minus sign if f is negative. The function returns the exponent (of 10) that should be used to compensate for the string: ftoa(1.0,buf) yields buf="100000000" and returns -8.
PARAMETERS f buf
Float number to convert.
Converted string. The string is no longer than 10 characters long.
RETURN VALUE
The exponent of the number.
LIBRARY
STDIO.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
getchar
char getchar( void );
DESCRIPTION
Busy waits for a character to be typed from the stdio window in Dynamic C. The user should make sure only one process calls this function at a time.
RETURN VALUE
A character typed in the Stdio window in Dynamic C.
LIBRARY
STDIO.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
175
get_cpu_frequency
unsigned long get_cpu_frequency();
DESCRIPTION
Returns the clock speed of the CPU as calculated by the BIOS, adjusted for the clock doubler if it is enabled. Due to the limited precision of the clock speed calculation, the calculated and actual clock speeds may differ slightly.
RETURN VALUE
The clock speed of the CPU in Hz.
LIBRARY sys.lib
getcrc
int getcrc( char * dataarray, char count, int accum );
DESCRIPTION
Computes the Cyclic Redundancy Check (CRC), or check sum, for count bytes (maximum
255) of data in buffer. Calls to getcrc can be “concatenated” using accum to compute the
CRC for a large buffer.
PARAMETERS dataarray count accum
Data buffer
Number of bytes. Maximum is 255.
Base CRC for the data array.
RETURN VALUE
CRC value.
LIBRARY
MATH.LIB
176 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
getdivider19200
char getdivider19200( void );
DESCRIPTION
This function returns a value that is used in baud rate calculations.
The correct value is returned regardless of the compile mode. In separate I&D space mode, the divider value is stored as a define byte in code space, so directly accessing the variable will result in an incorrect load (from constant data space). This function uses the ldp instruction, which circumvents the separate I&D default loading scheme so that the correct value is returned.
RETURN VALUE
The value used in baud rate calculation.
LIBRARY
SYS.LIB
gets
char * gets( char * s );
DESCRIPTION
Waits for a string terminated by <CR> at the stdio window. The string returned is null terminated without the return. The user should make sure only one process calls this function at a time.
PARAMETERS s The input string is put to the location pointed to by the argument s. The caller is responsible to make sure the location pointed to by s is big enough for the string.
RETURN VALUE
Same pointer passed in, but string is changed to be null terminated.
LIBRARY
STDIO.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
177
_GetSysMacroIndex
int _GetSysMacroIndex( int n, char * buf, uint32 * value );
DESCRIPTION
Skips to the nth macro entry and retrieves the macro name (as defined by the compiler), and the value of the macro as defined in the system macro table. The system macro table contains board specific configuration parameters that are defined by the compiler and can be retrieved at runtime through this interface. The flash driver must be initialized and the System ID block must be read before this function will return accurate results.
This function only applies to boards with Version 5 or later System ID blocks.
PARAMETERS n buf value
The index in the system macro table.
Character array to contain and return macro name (copied from system macro table). MUST BE AT LEAST SYS_MACRO_LENGTH bytes or function will overflow buffer and can crash system!
Pointer to macro value to return to caller.
RETURN VALUE
0 : if successful
-1 : invalid address or range (use to find end of table)
-2 : ID block or macro table invalid
LIBRARY
IDBLOCK.LIB
SEE ALSO
_GetSysMacroValue
178 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
_GetSysMacroValue
int _GetSysMacroValue( char * name, long * value );
DESCRIPTION
Finds the system table macro named by the first parameter (as defined by the compiler) and retrieves the value of the macro as defined in the system macro table. The system macro table contains board specific configuration parameters that are define by the compiler and can be retrieved at runtime through this interface. The flash driver must be initialized and the System
ID block must be read before this function will return accurate results.
See writeUserBlockArray for more details.
This function only applies to boards with Version 5 or later System ID blocks.
PARAMETERS name value
Name of System ID block macro (acts as lookup key).
Pointer to macro value to return to caller.
RETURN VALUE
0 : if successful
-1 : Macro name not found
-2 : No valid ID block found (block version 3 or later)
-3 : First parameter is a bad macro name
LIBRARY
IDBLOCK.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
179
GetVectExtern2000
unsigned GetVectExtern2000( void );
DESCRIPTION
Reads the address of external interrupt table entry. This function really just returns what is present in the table. The return value is meaningless if the address of the external interrupt has not been written.
This function should be used for Rabbit 2000 processors that are marked IQ2T in the 3rd line of text across the face of the chip. It will work for other versions of the Rabbit 2000 but should be deprecated in favor of GetVectExtern3000() which allows the use of two external interrupts. (Please see document TN301, “Rabbit 2000 Microprocessor Interrupt Issue,” on the
Rabbit Semiconductor website for more information.)
RETURN VALUE
Jump address in vector table.
LIBRARY
SYS.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
180 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
GetVectExtern3000
unsigned GetVectExtern3000( int interruptNum );
DESCRIPTION
Reads the address of an external interrupt table entry. This function may be used with all Rabbit
3000 processors and all Rabbit 2000 processors with the exception of the ones marked IQ2T in the 3rd line of text across the face of the chip. For those, use the function
GetVectExtern2000() instead.
GetVectExtern3000() returns the value at address:
(external vector table base) + (interruptNum * 8) + 1
PARAMETER interruptNum Interrupt number. Should be 0 or 1.
RETURN VALUE
Jump address in vector table.
LIBRARY
SYS.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
181
GetVectIntern
unsigned GetVectIntern( int vectNum );
DESCRIPTION
Reads the address of the internal interrupt table entry and returns whatever value is at the address:
(internal vector table base) + (vectNum*16) + 1
PARAMETER vectNum Interrupt number; should be 0–15.
RETURN VALUE
Jump address in vector table.
LIBRARY
SYS.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
gps_get_position
int gps_get_position( GPSPositon * newpos, char * sentence );
DESCRIPTION
Parses a sentence to extract position data. This function is able to parse any of the following
GPS sentence formats: GGA, GLL or RMC.
PARAMETERS newpos sentence
A GPSPosition structure to fill.
A string containing a line of GPS data in NMEA-0183 format.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success.
-1 : Parsing error.
-2 : Sentence marked invalid.
LIBRARY gps.lib
182 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
gps_get_utc
int gps_get_utc( struct tm * newtime, char * sentence );
DESCRIPTION
Parses an RMC sentence to extract time data.
PARAMETERS newtime sentence tm structure to fill with new UTC time.
A string containing a line of GPS data in NMEA-0183 format (RMC sentence).
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success.
-1 : Parsing error.
-2 : Sentence marked invalid.
LIBRARY
GPS.LIB
gps_ground_distance
float gps_ground_distance( GPSPosition * a, GPSPosition * b );
DESCRIPTION
Calculates ground distance (in km) between two geographical points. (Uses spherical earth model.)
PARAMETERS a b
First point.
Second point.
RETURN VALUE
Distance in kilometers.
LIBRARY
GPS.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
183
hanncplx
void hanncplx( int * x, int N, int * blockexp );
DESCRIPTION
Convolves an N-point complex spectrum with the three-point Hann kernel. The filtered spectrum replaces the original spectrum.
The function produces the same results as would be obtained by multiplying the corresponding time sequence by the Hann raised-cosine window.
The zero–crossing width of the main lobe produced by the Hann window is 4 DFT bins. The adjacent sidelobes are 32 db below the main lobe. Sidelobes decay at an asymptotic rate of 18 db per octave.
N must be a power of 2 and between 4 and 1024. An invalid N causes a RANGE exception.
PARAMETERS
x
N blockexp
Pointer to N-element array of complex fractions.
Number of complex elements in array x.
Pointer to integer block exponent.
LIBRARY
FFT.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
,
184 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
hannreal
void hannreal( int * x, int N, int * blockexp );
DESCRIPTION
Convolves an N-point positive-frequency complex spectrum with the three-point Hann kernel.
The function produces the same results as would be obtained by multiplying the corresponding time sequence by the Hann raised-cosine window.
The zero–crossing width of the main lobe produced by the Hann window is 4 DFT bins. The adjacent sidelobes are 32 db below the main lobe. Sidelobes decay at an asymptotic rate of 18 db per octave.
The imaginary part of the dc term (stored in x[1]) is considered to be the real part of the fmax term. The dc and fmax spectral components take part in the convolution along with the other spectral components. The real part of fmax component affects the real part of the X[N-1] component (and vice versa), and should not arbitrarily be set to zero unless these components are unimportant.
PARAMETERS x
N blockexp
Pointer to N-element array of complex fractions.
Number of complex elements in array x.
Pointer to integer block exponent.
RETURN VALUE
None. The filtered spectrum replaces the original spectrum.
LIBRARY
FFT.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
185
HDLCabortX
void HDLCabortX( void ); /* Where X is E or F */
DESCRIPTION
Immediately stops any transmission. An HDLC abort code will be sent if the driver was in the middle of sending a packet.
This function is intended for use with the Rabbit 3000 and Rabbit 4000.
LIBRARY
HDLC_PACKET.LIB
HDLCcloseX
void HDLCcloseX( void ); /* Where X is E or F */
DESCRIPTION
Disables the HDLC port (E or F). If it was used, the TAT1R resource (timer A1 cascade) is released. This function is non-reentrant.
This function is intended for use with the Rabbit 3000 and Rabbit 4000.
LIBRARY
HDLC_PACKET.LIB
SEE ALSO
186 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
HDLCdropX
int HDLCdropX( void ); /* Where X is E or F */
DESCRIPTION
Drops the next received packet, freeing up its buffer. This must be used if the packet has been examined with HDLCpeekX() and is no longer needed. A call to HDLCreveiceX() is the only other way to free up the buffer.
This function is intended for use with the Rabbit 3000 and Rabbit 4000.
RETURN VALUE
1 : Packet dropped.
0 : No received packets were available.
LIBRARY
HDLC_PACKET.LIB
HDLCerrorX
int HDLCerrorX( unsigned long * bufptr, int * lenptr );
/* Where X is E or F */
DESCRIPTION
This function returns a set of possible error flags as an integer. A received packet with errors is automatically dropped.
Masks are used to check which errors have occurred. The masks are:
• HDLC_NOBUFFER - driver ran out of buffers for received packets.
• HDLC_OVERRUN - a byte was overwritten and lost before the ISR could retreive it.
• HDLC_OVERFLOW - a received packet was too long for the buffers.
• HDLC_ABORTED - a received packet was aborted by the sender during tranmission.
• HDLC_BADCRC - a packet with an incorrect CRC was received.
This function is intended for use with the Rabbit 3000 and Rabbit 4000.
RETURN VALUE
Error flags (see above).
LIBRARY
HDLC_PACKET.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
187
HDLCextClockX
void HDLCextClockE( int ext_clock ) /* Where X is E or F */
DESCRIPTION
Configures HDLC to be either internally (default) or externally clocked. This should be called after HDLCopenX().
This function is intended for use with the Rabbit 3000 and Rabbit 4000.
PARAMETER ext_clock
LIBRARY
HDLC_PACKET.LIB
1 for externally clocked
0 for internally clocked
188 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
HDLCopenX
int HDLCopenX( long baud, char encoding, unsigned long buffers, int buffer_count, int buffer_size ); /* Where X is E or F */
DESCRIPTION
Opens serial port E or F in HDLC mode. Sets up buffers to hold received packets. This function is intended for use with the Rabbit 3000 and Rabbit 4000. Please see the chip manuals for more details on HDLC and the bit encoding modes to use.
PARAMETERS baud encoding buffers
The baud rate for the serial port. Due to imitations in the baud generator, non-standard baud rates will be approximated within 5% of the value requested.
The bit encoding mode to use. Macro labels for the available options are:
• HDLC_NRZ
• HDLC_NRZI
• HDLC_MANCHESTER
• HDLC_BIPHASE_SPACE
• HDLC_BIPHASE_MARK
A pointer to the start of the extended memory block containing the receive buffers. This block must be allocated beforehand by the user. The size of the block should be:
(# of buffers) * ((size of buffer) + 4) buffer_count The number of buffers in the block pointed to by buffer.
buffer_size The capacity of each buffer in the block pointed to by buffer.
RETURN VALUE
1 : Actual baud rate is within 5% of the requested baud rate,
0 : Otherwise.
LIBRARY
HDLC_PACKET.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
189
HDLCpeekX
int HDLCpeekX( unsigned long * bufptr, int * lenptr );
/* Where X is E or F */
DESCRIPTION
Reports the location and size of the next available received packet if one is available. This function can be used to efficiently inspect a received packet without actually copying it into a root memory buffer. Once inspected, the buffer can be received normally (see
HDLCreceiveX() ), or dropped (see HDLCdropX()).
This function is intended for use with the Rabbit 3000 and Rabbit 4000.
PARAMETERS bufptr lenptr
Pointer to location in xmem of the received packet.
Pointer to the size of the received packet.
RETURN VALUE
1 : The pointers bufptr and lenptr have been set for the received packet.
0 : No received packets available.
LIBRARY
HDLC_PACKET.LIB
190 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
HDLCreceiveX
int HDLCreceiveX(char *rx_buffer, int length); /* Where X is E or F */
DESCRIPTION
Copies a received packet into rx_buffer if there is one. Packets are received in the order they arrive, even if multiple packets are currently stored in buffers.
This function is intended for use with the Rabbit 3000 and Rabbit 4000.
PARAMETERS rx_buffer length
Pointer to the buffer to copy a received packet into.
Size of the buffer pointed to by rx_buffer.
RETURN VALUE
0: Size of received packet.
-1 : No packets are available to receive.
-2 : The buffer is not large enough for the received packet. In this case, the packet remains in the receive buffer)
LIBRARY
HDLC_PACKET.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
191
HDLCsendX
int HDLCsendX( char * tx_buffer, int length ); /* Where X is E or F */
DESCRIPTION
Transmits a packet out serial port E or F in HDLC mode. The tx_buffer is read directly while transmitting, therefore it cannot be altered until a subsequent call to HDLCsendingX() returns false, indicating that the driver is done with it.
This function is intended for use with the Rabbit 3000 and Rabbit 4000.
PARAMETERS tx_buffer length
A pointer to the packet to be sent. This buffer must not change while transmitting (see above.)
The size of the buffer (in bytes).
RETURN VALUE
1 : Sending packet.
0 : Cannot send, another packet is currently being transmitted.
LIBRARY
HDLC_PACKET.LIB
192 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
HDLCsendingX
int HDLCsendingX( void ); /* Where X is E or F */
DESCRIPTION
Returns true if a packet is currently being transmitted. This function is intended for use with the
Rabbit 3000 and Rabbit 4000.
RETURN VALUE
1 : Currently sending a packet.
0 : Transmitter is idle.
LIBRARY
HDLC_PACKET.LIB
hexstrtobyte
int hexstrtobyte (char far *p);
DESCRIPTION
Converts two hex characters (0-9A-Fa-f) to a byte.
RETURN VALUE
The byte (0-255) represented by the two hex characters or -1 on error (invalid character, string less than 2 bytes).
EXAMPLES hexstrtobyte("FF") returns 255 hexstrtobyte("0") returns -1 (error because < 2 characters) hexstrtobyte("ABCDEF") returns 0xAB (ignores additional chars)
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
193
hitwd
void hitwd( void );
DESCRIPTION
Hits the watchdog timer, postponing a hardware reset for 2 seconds. Unless the watchdog timer is disabled, a program must call this function periodically, or the controller will automatically reset itself. If the virtual driver is enabled (which it is by default), it will call hitwd in the background. The virtual driver also makes additional “virtual” watchdog timers available.
LIBRARY
VDRIVER.LIB
htoa
char * htoa( int value, char * buf );
DESCRIPTION
Converts integer value to hexadecimal number and puts result into buf.
PARAMETERS value buf
16-bit number to convert
Character string of converted number
RETURN VALUE
Pointer to end (null terminator) of string in buf.
LIBRARY
STDIO.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
194 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
IntervalMs
int IntervalMs( long ms );
DESCRIPTION
Similar to DelayMs but provides a periodic delay based on the time from the previous call.
Intended for use with waitfor.
PARAMETERS ms The number of milliseconds to wait.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Not finished.
1 : Delay has expired.
LIBRARY
COSTATE.LIB
IntervalSec
int IntervalSec( long sec );
DESCRIPTION
Similar to DelayMs but provides a periodic delay based on the time from the previous call.
Intended for use with waitfor.
PARAMETERS sec The number of seconds to delay.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Not finished.
1 : Delay has expired.
LIBRARY
COSTATE.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
195
IntervalTick
int IntervalTick( long tick );
DESCRIPTION
Provides a periodic delay based on the time from the previous call. Intended for use with waitfor . A tick is 1/1024 seconds.
PARAMETERS tick The number of ticks to delay
RETURN VALUE
0 : Not finished.
1 : Delay has expired.
LIBRARY
COSTATE.LIB
ipres
void ipres( void );
DESCRIPTION
Dynamic C expands this call inline. Restore previous interrupt priority by rotating the IP register.
LIBRARY
UTIL.LIB
SEE ALSO
196 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
ipset
void ipset( int priority );
DESCRIPTION
Dynamic C expands this call inline. Replaces current interrupt priority with another by rotating the new priority into the IP register.
PARAMETERS priority Interrupt priority range 0–3, lowest to highest priority.
LIBRARY
UTIL.LIB
SEE ALSO
isalnum
int isalnum( int c );
DESCRIPTION
Tests for an alphabetic or numeric character, (A to Z, a to z and 0 to 9).
PARAMETERS c Character to test.
RETURN VALUE
0 if not an alphabetic or numeric character.
!0
otherwise.
LIBRARY
STRING.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
197
isalpha
int isalpha( int c );
DESCRIPTION
Tests for an alphabetic character, (A to Z, or a to z).
PARAMETERS c Character to test.
RETURN VALUE
0 if not a alphabetic character.
!0
otherwise.
LIBRARY
STRING.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
iscntrl
int iscntrl( int c );
DESCRIPTION
Tests for a control character: 0 <= c <= 31 or c == 127.
PARAMETERS c Character to test.
RETURN VALUE
0 if not a control character.
!0
otherwise.
LIBRARY
STRING.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
,
198 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
isCoDone
int isCoDone( CoData * p );
DESCRIPTION
Determine if costatement is initialized and not running.
PARAMETERS p Address of costatement
RETURN VALUE
1 : Costatement is initialized and not running.
0 : Otherwise.
LIBRARY
COSTATE.LIB
isCoRunning
int isCoRunning( CoData * p );
DESCRIPTION
Determine if costatement is stopped or running.
PARAMETERS p Address of costatement.
RETURN VALUE
1 if costatement is running.
0 otherwise.
LIBRARY
COSTATE.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
199
int isdigit( int c );
DESCRIPTION
Tests for a decimal digit: 0 - 9
PARAMETERS c Character to test.
RETURN VALUE
0 if not a decimal digit.
!0
otherwise.
LIBRARY
STRING.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
isdigit
200 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
isgraph
int isgraph( int c );
DESCRIPTION
Tests for a printing character other than a space: 33 <= c <= 126
PARAMETERS c Character to test.
RETURN VALUE
0 : c is not a printing character.
!0
: c is a printing character.
LIBRARY
STRING.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
,
,
int islower( int c );
DESCRIPTION
Tests for lower case character.
PARAMETERS c Character to test.
RETURN VALUE
0 if not a lower case character.
!0
otherwise.
LIBRARY
STRING.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
islower
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
201
isspace
int isspace( int c );
DESCRIPTION
Tests for a white space, character, tab, return, newline, vertical tab, form feed, and space:
9 <= c <= 13 and c == 32.
PARAMETERS c Character to test.
RETURN VALUE
0 if not, !0 otherwise.
LIBRARY
STRING.LIB
SEE ALSO
isprint
int isprint( int c );
DESCRIPTION
Tests for printing character, including space: 32 <= c <= 126
PARAMETERS c Character to test.
RETURN VALUE
0 if not a printing character, !0 otherwise.
LIBRARY
STRING.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
,
,
,
,
202 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
int ispunct( int c );
DESCRIPTION
Tests for a punctuation character.
Character
space
! " # $ % & ' ( ) * + , - . /
: ; < = > ? @
[\] ^ _ `
{|} ~
PARAMETERS c
RETURN VALUE
0 : Not a character.
!0
: Is a character.
Character to test.
LIBRARY
STRING.LIB
SEE ALSO
ispunct
Decimal Code
32
33 <= c <= 47
58 <= c <= 64
91 <= c <= 96
123 <= c <= 126
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
203
int isupper( int c );
DESCRIPTION
Tests for upper case character.
PARAMETERS c Character to test.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Is not an uppercase character.
!0
: Is an uppercase character.
LIBRARY
STRING.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
isupper isxdigit
int isxdigit( int c );
DESCRIPTION
Tests for a hexadecimal digit: 0 - 9, A - F, a - f
PARAMETERS c Character to test.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Not a hexadecimal digit.
!0
: Is a hexadecimal digit.
LIBRARY
STRING.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
204 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
itoa
char * itoa( int value, char * buf );
DESCRIPTION
Places up to a 5-digit character string, with a minus sign in the leftmost digit when appropriate, at *buf. The string represents value, a signed number.
Leading zeros are suppressed in the character string, except for one zero digit when value =
0. The longest possible string is “-32768.”
PARAMETERS value buf
16-bit signed number to convert
Character string of converted number in base 10
RETURN VALUE
Pointer to the end (null terminator) of the string in buf.
LIBRARY
STDIO.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
205
i2c_check_ack
int i2c_check_ack( void );
DESCRIPTION
Checks if slave pulls data low for ACK on clock pulse. Allows for clocks stretching on SCL going high.
RETURN VALUE
0 : ACK sent from slave.
1 : NAK sent from slave.
-1 : Timeout occurred.
LIBRARY
I2C.LIB
SEE ALSO
Technical Note 215, Using the I2C Bus with a Rabbit Microprocessor.
206 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
i2c_init
void i2c_init( void );
DESCRIPTION
Sets up the SCL and SDA port pins for open-drain output.
LIBRARY
I2C.LIB
SEE ALSO
Technical Note 215, Using the I2C Bus with a Rabbit Microprocessor.
i2c_read_char
int i2c_read_char( char * ch );
DESCRIPTION
Reads 8 bits from the slave. Allows for clocks stretching on all SCL going high. This is not in the protocol for I
2
C, but allows I
2
C slaves to be implemented on slower devices.
PARAMETERS ch A one character return buffer.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success.
-1 : Clock stretching timeout.
LIBRARY
I2C.LIB
SEE ALSO
Technical Note 215, Using the I2C Bus with a Rabbit Microprocessor.
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
207
i2c_send_ack
int i2c_send_ack( void );
DESCRIPTION
Sends ACK sequence to slave. ACK is usually sent after a successful transfer, where more bytes are going to be read.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success.
-1 : Clock stretching timeout.
LIBRARY
I2C.LIB
SEE ALSO
Technical Note 215, Using the I2C Bus with a Rabbit Microprocessor.
i2c_send_nak
int i2c_send_nak( void );
DESCRIPTION
Sends NAK sequence to slave. NAK is often sent when the transfer is finished.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success.
-1 : Clock stretching timeout.
LIBRARY
I2C.LIB
SEE ALSO
Technical Note 215, Using the I2C Bus with a Rabbit Microprocessor.
208 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
i2c_start_tx
int i2c_start_tx( void );
DESCRIPTION
Initiates I
2
C transmission by sending the start sequence, which is defined as a high to low transition on SDA while SCL is high. The point being that SDA is supposed to remain stable while
SCL is high. If it does not, then that indicates a start (S) or stop (P) condition. This function first waits for possible clock stretching, which is when a bus peripheral holds SCK low.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success.
-1 : Clock stretching timeout.
LIBRARY
I2C.LIB
SEE ALSO
Technical Note 215, Using the I2C Bus with a Rabbit Microprocessor.
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
209
i2c_startw_tx
int i2c_startw_tx( void );
DESCRIPTION
Initiates I
2
C transmission by sending the start sequence, which is defined as a high to low transition on SDA while SCL is high. The point being that SDA is supposed to remain stable while
SCL is high. If it does not, then that indicates a start (S) or stop (P) condition. This function first waits for possible clock stretching, which is when a bus peripheral holds SCK low.
This function is essentially the same as i2c_start_tx() with the addition of a clock stretch delay, which is 2000 “counts,” inserted after the start sequence. (A count is an iteration through a loop.)
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success.
-1 : Clock stretching timeout.
LIBRARY
I2C.LIB
SEE ALSO
Technical Note 215, Using the I2C Bus with a Rabbit Microprocessor.
210 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
i2c_stop_tx
void i2c_stop_tx( void );
DESCRIPTION
Sends the stop sequence to the slave, which is defined as bringing SDA high while SCL is high, i.e., the clock goes high, then data goes high.
LIBRARY
I2C.LIB
SEE ALSO
Technical Note 215, Using the I2C Bus with a Rabbit Microprocessor.
i2c_write_char
int i2c_write_char( char d );
DESCRIPTION
Sends 8 bits to slave. Checks if slave pulls data low for ACK on clock pulse. Allows for clocks stretching on SCL going high.
PARAMETERS d Character to send
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success.
-1 : Clock stretching timeout.
1 : NAK sent from slave.
LIBRARY
I2C.LIB
SEE ALSO
Technical Note 215, Using the I2C Bus with a Rabbit Microprocessor.
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
211
kbhit
int kbhit( void );
DESCRIPTION
Detects keystrokes in the Dynamic C Stdio window.
RETURN VALUE
!0
if a key has been pressed, 0 otherwise.
LIBRARY
UTIL.LIB
labs
long labs( long x );
DESCRIPTION
Computes the long integer absolute value of long integer x.
PARAMETERS x Number to compute.
RETURN VALUE x , if x
0.
-x , otherwise.
LIBRARY
MATH.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
212 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
ldexp
float ldexp( float x, int n );
DESCRIPTION
Computes x*( 2 n
) .
PARAMETERS x n
The value between 0.5 inclusive, and 1.0
An integer
RETURN VALUE
The result of x*(2 n
) .
LIBRARY
MATH.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
log
float log( float x );
DESCRIPTION
Computes the logarithm, base e, of real float value x.
PARAMETERS x Float value
RETURN VALUE
The function returns –INF and signals a domain error when x
0.
LIBRARY
MATH.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
213
log_clean
int log_clean( LogDest ld );
DESCRIPTION
Reset only the specified destination class and stream (encoded as a LogDest value). This is only applicable to filesystem or XMEM destinations since they are locally persistent storage.
XMEM is automatically cleaned at start-up time, since it is not assumed to be non-volatile.
If this operation is not applicable, 0 is returned with no further action.
Note: Please see the comments at the top of log.lib for a description of the message logging subsystem.
PARAMETER
ld Destination class and stream. Use one of the constants LOG_DEST_FS2 or LOG_DEST_XMEM, then OR in the stream number (0-63).
RETURN VALUE
0: success
-2: The stream is out-of-range for the class.
LIBRARY log.lib
214 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
log_close
int log_close( LogDestClass ldc );
DESCRIPTION
Close the specified class, enumerating all streams. If the destination class is already closed, returns success.
Note: Please see the comments at the top of log.lib for a description of the message logging subsystem.
PARAMETER ldc Destination class. Use one of the constants LOG_DEST_FS2,
LOG_DEST_XMEM , LOG_DEST_UDP or LOG_DEST_ALL. The latter case closes all open destinations.
RETURN VALUE
0: success
LIBRARY log.lib
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
215
log_condition
int log_condition( LogDest ldst );
DESCRIPTION
Return the state of the specified log destination. Destination classes or streams that are not configured cause a -2 return code.
Note: Please see the comments at the top of log.lib for a description of the message logging subsystem.
PARAMETER ldst Destination class and stream. Use one of the constants LOG_DEST_FS2 or LOG_DEST_XMEM, then OR in the stream number (0-63).
RETURN VALUE
0: Destination not open
1: destination OK
2: destination reached limit of its space quota
-1: error in destination.
-2: destination not configured
LIBRARY log.lib
216 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
log_format
char * log_format( LogEntry *le, char *buffer, int length, int pfx );
DESCRIPTION
Given the log entry returned by log_next() or log_prev(), format the entry as an ASCII string.
The string is constructed in Unix "syslog" format:
<%d>%.15s %.8s[%d]: %s where the substitutions are:
%d: facility/priority as decimal number (0-255)
%.15s: date/time as "Mon dd hh:mm:ss"
%s: process name - taken from LOG_UDP_PNAME(0) if defined, else "" (empty).
%d: process ID, but the entry serial number is used instead.
%s: the log entry data.
A null terminator is always added at buffer[length-1], or at the end of the string if it fits in the buffer. If pfx is zero, then the above syslog prefix is not generated.
Note: Please see the comments at the top of log.lib for a description of the message logging subsystem.
PARAMETERS le buffer length pfx
Log entry result from log_next/log_prev().
Storage for result. Must be dimensioned at least 'length'.
Length of buffer. For the maximum sized log entry, the buffer should be
158 bytes. The minimum length must be greater than or equal to 43 (if pfx true) else 1. If a bad length is passed, the function returns without writing to buffer.
0: message text only; do not generate syslog prefix.
1: prefix plus message text.
2: prefix only (up to ']', then null terminator).
RETURN VALUE buffer address, or NULL if bad length passed.
LIBRARY log.lib
SEE ALSO log_next, log_prev
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
217
log_map
uint32 log_map( LogFacPri lfp );
DESCRIPTION
Return the log destination class and stream, for a given facility/priority code. The result is up to four destinations packed into a longword. This function merely invokes the macro
LOG_MAP() , which may be overridden by the application, but defaults to just the filesystem.
Note: Please see the comments at the top of log.lib for a description of the message logging subsystem.
PARAMETER lfp Facility/priority code. This is a single-byte code specified whenever any log message is added. Facility is coded in the 5 MSBs, and priority in the
3 LSBs.
RETURN VALUE
Up to four destinations for a message of the specified facility and priority. Each byte in the resulting long word represents a destination/stream. A zero byte indicates no destination. If the result is all zeros, then a message of this type would be discarded.
LIBRARY log.lib
218 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
log_next
int log_next( LogDest ldst, LogEntry * le );
DESCRIPTION
Retrieve next log entry. You must call log_seek() before calling this function the first time.
Retrieval of stored log messages proceeds, for example, as follows: log_seek(ldst, 0); log_next(ldst, &L); log_next(ldst, &L); log_prev(ldst, &L); log_prev(ldst, &L); log_prev(ldst, &L);
// seek to start
// get 1st entry
// get 2nd entry
// get 2nd entry again
// get 1st entry
// returns -1
Note: Please see the comments at the top of log.lib for a description of the message logging subsystem.
PARAMETERS ldst le
Destination class and stream. Use one of the constants LOG_DEST_FS2 or LOG_DEST_XMEM, then OR in the stream number (0-63).
Storage for result.
RETURN VALUE non-negative: length of log entry data
-1: End of log or not open
-2: Not a readable log destination class
LIBRARY log.lib
SEE ALSO log_seek, log_prev
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
219
log_open
int log_open( LogDestClass ldc, int clean );
DESCRIPTION
Open the specified logging destination class. If necessary, this enumerates all possible streams within the class, opening them all (necessary only for FS2 class, since each file needs to be opened). Class LOG_DEST_ALL opens all configured classes.
If clean is true, then the dest is set to empty log, if that makes sense for the class.
Note: Please see the comments at the top of log.lib for a description of the message logging subsystem.
PARAMETERS ldc clean
Destination class: LOG_DEST_FS2, LOG_DEST_UDP,
LOG_DEST_XMEM or LOG_DEST_ALL.
Boolean, should the destination be erased before using?
RETURN VALUE
0: success
-1: unknown LogDestClass value
LIBRARY log.lib
220 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
log_prev
int log_prev( LogDest ldst, LogEntry * le );
DESCRIPTION
Retrieve previous log entry. You must call log_seek() before calling this function the first time. Retrieval of stored log messages proceeds, for example, as follows: log_seek(ldst, 1); log_prev(ldst, &L); log_prev(ldst, &L); log_next(ldst, &L); log_next(ldst, &L); log_next(ldst, &L);
// seek to end
// get last entry
// get 2nd last entry
// get 2nd last entry again
// get last entry
// returns -1
Note: Please see the comments at the top of log.lib for a description of the message logging subsystem.
PARAMETERS ldst le
Destination class and stream. Use one of the constants LOG_DEST_FS2 or LOG_DEST_XMEM, then OR in the stream number (0-63).
Storage for result.
RETURN VALUE non-negative = length of log entry data
-1 = Start of log or not open
-2 = Not a readable log destination class
LIBRARY log.lib
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
221
log_put
int log_put( LogFacPri ifp, uint8 fmt, const char *data, int length );
DESCRIPTION
Add a log entry. The specified facility/priority is mapped to the appropriate destination(s), as configured by the macros. If the destination exists, then the log entry is added; otherwise, the entry is quietly ignored. If a destination is unable to fit the log entry, and the destination is configured as “circular,” then the first few entries may be deleted to make room. If this cannot be done, or an unrecoverable error occurs, then -2 is returned. For non-circular destinations, -2 is returned when it becomes full.
Since multiple log destinations can result from the given facility/priority, it can be difficult to determine which actual destination caused an error. You can use the log_map() function to determine the destinations, then check each destination's state using log_condition().
Note: Please see the comments at the top of log.lib for a description of the message logging subsystem.
PARAMETERS ifp fmt data length
Facility/priority code. Facility in 5 MSBs, priority in 3 LSBs.
Format code. 0 for ascii string, others user-defined.
Pointer to first byte of data to store.
Length of data. Must be between 0 and 115 (LOG_MAX_MESSAGE) inclusive.
RETURN VALUE
0 = success
-1 = Message too long (over 115).
-2 = Unrecoverable error in destination. This return code usually means that the destination is unusable and further entries for that destination will probably meet the same fate. This can also mean that the destination has not been opened.
LIBRARY log.lib
222 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
log_seek
int log_seek( LogDest ldst, int );
DESCRIPTION
Position log for readback. The next call to log_next() will return the first entry in the log
(if whence=0), or log_prev() will return the last entry (if whence=1).
Note: Please see the comments at the top of log.lib for a description of the message logging subsystem.
PARAMETERS ldst whence
Destination class and stream. Use one of the constants LOG_DEST_FS2 or LOG_DEST_XMEM, then OR in the stream number (0-63).
0: first entry.
1: last entry. other values reserved.
RETURN VALUE
0 = success.
-1 = Log empty.
-2 = Unrecoverable error or not open.
-3 = Not a seekable or configured log destination class.
-4 = invalid whence parameter.
LIBRARY log.lib
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
223
log10
float log10( float x );
DESCRIPTION
Computes the base 10 logarithm of real float value x.
PARAMETERS x Value to compute
RETURN VALUE
The log base 10 of x.
The function returns –INF and signals a domain error when x
0.
LIBRARY
MATH.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
longjmp
void longjmp( jmp_buf env, int val );
DESCRIPTION
Restores the stack environment saved in array env[ ]. See the description of setjmp() for
details of use.
Note: you cannot use longjmp() to move out of slice statements, costatements, or cofunctions.
PARAMETERS env val
Environment previously saved with setjmp().
Integer result of setjmp().
LIBRARY
SYS.LIB
SEE ALSO
224 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
loophead
void loophead( void );
DESCRIPTION
This function should be called within the main loop in a program. It is necessary for proper single-user cofunction abandonment handling.
When two costatements are requesting access to a single-user cofunction, the first request is honored and the second request is held. When loophead() notices that the first caller is not being called each time around the loop, it cancels the request, calls the abandonment code and allows the second caller in.
See Samples\Cofunc\Cofaband.c for sample code showing abandonment handling.
LIBRARY
COFUNC.LIB
loopinit
void loopinit( void );
DESCRIPTION
This function should be called in the beginning of a program that uses single-user cofunctions.
It initializes internal data structures that are used by loophead().
LIBRARY
COFUNC.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
225
lsqrt
unsigned int lsqrt( unsigned long x );
DESCRIPTION
Computes the square root of x. Note that the return value is an unsigned int. The fractional portion of the result is truncated.
PARAMETERS x long int input for square root computation
RETURN VALUE
Square root of x (fractional portion truncated).
LIBRARY
MATH.LIB
ltoa
char * ltoa( long num, char * ibuf )
DESCRIPTION
This function outputs a signed long number to the character array.
PARAMETERS num ibuf
Signed long number.
Pointer to character array.
RETURN VALUE
Pointer to the same array passed in to hold the result.
LIBRARY
STDIO.LIB
SEE ALSO
226 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
ltoan
int ltoan( long num );
DESCRIPTION
This function returns the number of characters required to display a signed long number.
PARAMETERS num 32-bit signed number.
RETURN VALUE
The number of characters to display signed long number.
LIBRARY
STDIO.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
227
lx_format
int lx_format( FSLXnum lxn, long wearlevel );
DESCRIPTION
Format a specified file system extent. This must not be called before calling fs_init(). All files which have either or both metadata and data on this extent are deleted. Formatting can be quite slow (depending on hardware) so it is best performed after power-up, if at all.
PARAMETERS lxn wearlevel
Logical extent number (1.._fs.num_lx inclusive).
Initial wearlevel value. This should be 1 if you have a new flash, and some larger number if the flash is used. If you are reformatting a flash, you can use 0 to use the old flash wear levels.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success.
!0
: Failure.
ERRNO VALUES
ENODEV - no such extent number, or extent is reserved.
EBUSY - one or more files were open on this extent.
EIO - I/O error during format. If this occurs, retry the format operation. If it fails again, there is probably a hardware error.
LIBRARY
FS2 .LIB
SEE ALSO fs_init, fs_format
228 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
mbr_CreatePartition
int mbr_CreatePartition( mbr_drive *drive, int pnum, char type );
DESCRIPTION
Creates or modifies the partition specified. The partition being modified must not be mounted, and should be released by filesystem use (that is, its fs_part pointer must be null). The new partition values should be placed in the appropriate partition structure within the drive structure.
For example, drive.part[partnum].bootflag = 0; drive.part[partnum].starthead = 0xfe; drive.part[partnum].startseccyl = 0; drive.part[partnum].parttype = 0xda; drive.part[partnum].endhead = 0xfe; drive.part[partnum].endseccyl = 0; drive.part[partnum].startsector = start; drive.part[partnum].partsecsize = ((PART_SZ) / 512) + 1; mbr_CreatePartition(&drive, partnum, 0xda);
For more information on the partition structure (mbr_part) look in part_defs.lib.
The type parameter should match the type as it currently exists on the drive, unless this is unused. Some values for the type parameter are already in use. A list of known partition types is at: www.win.tue.nl/~aeb/partitions/partition_types-1.html
Note: Starting with Dynamic C 9.01, this function BLOCKS!
PARAMETERS drive pnum type
Pointer to a MBR drive structure
Partition number to be created or modified
Type that exists on the physical drive partition now
RETURN VALUE
0 for success
-EIO for Error trying to read drive/device or structures.
-EINVAL if drive structure, pnum or type is invalid.
-EPERM if the partition has not been enumerated or is currently mounted.
-EUNFORMAT if the drive is accessible, but not formatted.
-EBUSY if the device is busy. (Valid prior to Dynamic C 9.01)
LIBRARY
PART.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
229
mbr_EnumDevice
mbr_EnumDevice( mbr_drvr *driver, mbr_dev *dev, int devnum, int
(*checktype)() );
DESCRIPTION
This routine is called to learn about devices present on the driver passed in. The device will be added to the linked list of enumerated devices. Partition information will be filled in from the master boot record (MBR). Pointers to file system level partition information structures will be set to NULL.
PARAMETERS driver dev devnum checktype
Pointer to a DOS contoller structure (setup during init of storage device devicer.)
Pointer to a drive structure to be filled in.
Physical device number of device on the driver.
Routine that takes an unsigned char partition type and returns 1 if of sought type and zero if not. Pass NULL for this parameter to bypass this check.
RETURN VALUE
0 for success
-EIO for Error trying to read the device or structure.
-EINVAL if devnum invalid or does not exist.
-ENOMEM if memory for page buffer is not available.
-EUNFORMAT if the device is accessible, but not formatted. You can use it provided it is formatted/partitioned by either this library or another system.
-EBADPART if the partition table on the device is invalid
-ENOPART if the device does not have any sought partitions, If checktype parameter is NULL, this test is bypassed. This code is superseded by any other error detected.
-EXIST if the device has already been enumerated.
-EBUSY if the device is busy.
LIBRARY
PART.LIB
230 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
mbr_FormatDevice
int mbr_FormatDevice( mbr_dev * dev );
DESCRIPTION
Creates or rewrites the Master Boot Record on the device given. The routine will only rewrite the Boot Loader code if an MBR already exists on the device. The existing partition table will be preserved. To modify an existing partition table use mbr_CreatePartion.
Note: This routine is NOT PROTECTED from power loss and can make existing partitions inaccessible if interrupted.
Note: This function is BLOCKING.
PARAMETERS dev Pointer to MBR device structure
RETURN VALUE
0 for success.
-EEXIST if the MBR exists, writing Boot Loader only
-EIO for Error trying to read the device or structure
-EINVAL if the Device structure is not valid
-ENOMEM if memory for page buffer is not available
-EPERM if drive has mounted or FS enumerated partition(s)
LIBRARY
PART.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
231
mbr_MountPartition
int mbr_MountPartition( mbr_drive * drive, int pnum );
DESCRIPTION
Marks the partition as mounted. It is the higher level codes responsibility to verify that the fs_part pointer for a partition is not in use (null) as this would indicate that another system is in the process of mounting this device.
PARAMETERS drive pnum
Pointer to a drive structure
Partition number to be mounted
RETURN VALUE
0 for success
-EINVAL if Drive or Partition structure or pnum is invalid.
-ENOPART if Partition does not exist on the device.
LIBRARY
PART.LIB
232 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
mbr_UnmountPartition
int mbr_UnmountPartition( mbr_drive * drive, int pnum );
DESCRIPTION
Marks the partition as unmounted. The partition must not have any user partition data attached
(through mounting at a higher level). If the fs_part pointer for the partition being unmounted is not null, an EPERM error is returned.
PARAMETERS drive pnum
Pointer to a drive structure containing the partition
Partition number to be unmounted
RETURN VALUE
0 for success
-EINVAL if the Drive structure or pnum is invalid.
-ENOPART if the partition is enumerated at a higher level.
LIBRARY
PART.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
233
mbr_ValidatePartitions
int mbr_ValidatePartitions( mbr_drive * drive );
DESCRIPTION
This routine will validate the partition table contained in the drive structure passed. It will verify that all partitions fit within the bounds of the drive and that no partitions overlap.
PARAMETERS drive Pointer to a drive structure
RETURN VALUE
0 for success
-EINVAL if the partition table in the drive structure is invalid.
LIBRARY
PART.LIB
234 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
md5_append
void md5_append( md5_state_t * pms, char * data, int nbytes );
DESCRIPTION
This function will take a buffer and compute the MD5 hash of its contents, combined with all previous data passed to it. This function can be called several times to generate the hash of a large amount of data.
PARAMETERS md5_append data nbytes
Pointer to the md5_state_t structure that was initialized by md5_init .
Pointer to the data to be hashed.
Length of the data to be hashed.
LIBRARY
MD5.LIB
md5_init
void md5_init( md5_state_t * pms );
DESCRIPTION
Initialize the MD5 hash process. Initial values are generated for the structure, and this structure will identify a particular transaction in all subsequent calls to the md5 library.
PARAMETER pms Pointer to the md5_state_t structure.
LIBRARY
MD5.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
235
md5_finish
void md5_finish( md5_state_t * pms, char digest[16] );
DESCRIPTION
Completes the hash of all the received data and generates the final hash value.
PARAMETERS pms digest
Pointer to the md5_state_t structure that was initialized by md5_init .
The 16-byte array that the hash value will be written into.
LIBRARY
MD5.LIB
236 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
memchr
NEAR SYNTAX: void * _n_memchr( void * src, int ch, unsigned int n );
FAR SYNTAX: void far * _f_memchr( void far * src, int ch, size_t n );
Note: By default, memchr() is defined to _n_memchr().
DESCRIPTION
Searches up to n characters at memory pointed to by src for character ch.
For Rabbit 4000+ users, this function supports FAR pointers. By default the near version of the function is called. The macro USE_FAR_STRING will change all calls to functions in this library to their far versions. The user may also explicitly call the far version with _f_strfunc where strfunc is the name of the string function.
Because FAR addresses are larger, the far versions of this function will run slightly slower than the near version. To explicitly call the near version when the USE_FAR_STRING macro is defined and all pointers are near pointers, append _n_ to the function name, e.g., _n_strfunc.
For more information about FAR pointers, see the Dynamic C User’s Manual or the samples in
Samples/Rabbit4000/FAR/ .
PARAMETERS src ch n
Pointer to memory source.
Character to search for.
Number of bytes to search.
RETURN VALUE
Pointer to first occurrence of ch if found within n characters. Otherwise returns null.
LIBRARY
STRING.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
237
memcmp
NEAR SYNTAX: int _n_memcmp( void *s1, void *s2, size_t n );
FAR SYNTAX: int _f_memcmp( void far *s1, void far *s2, size_t n );
Note: By default, memcmp() is defined to _n_memcmp().
DESCRIPTION
Performs unsigned character by character comparison of two memory blocks of length n.
For Rabbit 4000+ users, this function supports FAR pointers. By default the near version of the function is called. The macro USE_FAR_STRING will change all calls to functions in this library to their far versions. The user may also explicitly call the far version with _f_strfunc where strfunc is the name of the string function.
Because FAR addresses are larger, the far versions of this function will run slightly slower than the near version. To explicitly call the near version when the USE_FAR_STRING macro is defined and all pointers are near pointers, append _n_ to the function name, e.g., _n_strfunc.
For more information about FAR pointers, see the Dynamic C User’s Manual or the samples in
Samples/Rabbit4000/FAR/ .
PARAMETERS s1 s2 n
Pointer to block 1.
Pointer to block 2.
Maximum number of bytes to compare.
RETURN VALUE
<0 : A character in str1 is less than the corresponding character in str2.
0 : str1 is identical to str2.
>0 : A character in str1 is greater than the corresponding character in str2.
LIBRARY
STRING.LIB
SEE ALSO
238 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
memcpy
NEAR SYNTAX: void *_n_memcpy( void *dst, void *src, unsigned int n );
FAR SYNTAX: void far *_f_memcpy( void far *dst, void far *src, size_t n );
Note: By default, memcpy() is defined to _n_memcpy().
DESCRIPTION
Copies a block of bytes from one destination to another. Overlap is handled correctly.
For Rabbit 4000+ users, this function supports FAR pointers. By default the near version of the function is called. The macro USE_FAR_STRING will change all calls to functions in this library to their far versions. The user may also explicitly call the far version with _f_strfunc where strfunc is the name of the string function.
Because FAR addresses are larger, the far versions of this function will run slightly slower than the near version. To explicitly call the near version when the USE_FAR_STRING macro is defined and all pointers are near pointers, append _n_ to the function name, e.g., _n_strfunc.
For more information about FAR pointers, see the Dynamic C User’s Manual or the samples in
Samples/Rabbit4000/FAR/ .
PARAMETERS dst src n
RETURN VALUE
Pointer to destination.
Pointer to memory destination
Pointer to memory source
Number of characters to copy
LIBRARY
STRING.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
239
memmove
NEAR SYNTAX: void *_n_memmove( void *dst, void *src, unsigned int n );
FAR SYNTAX: _f_memmove( void far * dst, void far * src, size_t n);
Note: By default memmove() is defined to _n_memmove().
DESCRIPTION
Copies a block of bytes from one destination to another. Overlap is handled correctly.
For Rabbit 4000+ users, this function supports FAR pointers. By default the near version of the function is called. The macro USE_FAR_STRING will change all calls to functions in this library to their far versions. The user may also explicitly call the far version with _f_strfunc where strfunc is the name of the string function.
Because FAR addresses are larger, the far versions of this function will run slightly slower than the near version. To explicitly call the near version when the USE_FAR_STRING macro is defined and all pointers are near pointers, append _n_ to the function name, e.g., _n_strfunc.
For more information about FAR pointers, see the Dynamic C User’s Manual or the samples in
Samples/Rabbit4000/FAR/ .
PARAMETERS dst src n
RETURN VALUE
Pointer to destination.
Pointer to memory destination
Pointer to memory source
Number of characters to copy
LIBRARY
STRING.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
240 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
memset
NEAR SYNTAX: void * _n_memset( void * dst, int chr, unsigned int n );
FAR SYNTAX: void far * _f_memset( void far * dst, int chr, size_t n );
Note: By default, memset() is defined to _n_memset().
DESCRIPTION
Sets the first n bytes of a block of memory pointed to by dst to the character chr.
For Rabbit 4000+ users, this function supports FAR pointers. By default the near version of the function is called. The macro USE_FAR_STRING will change all calls to functions in this library to their far versions. The user may also explicitly call the far version with _f_strfunc where strfunc is the name of the string function.
Because FAR addresses are larger, the far versions of this function will run slightly slower than the near version. To explicitly call the near version when the USE_FAR_STRING macro is defined and all pointers are near pointers, append _n_ to the function name, e.g., _n_strfunc.
For more information about FAR pointers, see the Dynamic C User’s Manual or the samples in
Samples/Rabbit4000/FAR/ .
PARAMETERS dst chr n
Block of memory to set
Character that will be written to memory
Amount of bytes to set
RETURN VALUE dst : Pointer to block of memory.
LIBRARY
STRING.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
241
mktime
unsigned long mktime( struct tm * timeptr );
DESCRIPTION
Converts the contents of structure pointed to by timeptr into seconds.
struct tm { char tm_sec; char tm_min; char tm_hour; char tm_mday; char tm_mon; char tm_year; char tm_wday;
};
// seconds 0-59
// 0-59
// 0-23
// 1-31
// 1-12
// 80-147 (1980-2047)
// 0-6 0==sunday
PARAMETERS timeptr Pointer to tm structure
RETURN VALUE
Time in seconds since January 1, 1980.
LIBRARY
RTCLOCK.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
242 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
mktm
unsigned int mktm( struct tm * timeptr, unsigned long time );
DESCRIPTION
Converts the seconds (time) to date and time and fills in the fields of the tm structure with the result.
struct tm { char tm_sec; char tm_min; char tm_hour; char tm_mday; char tm_mon; char tm_year; char tm_wday;
};
// seconds 0-59
// 0-59
// 0-23
// 1-31
// 1-12
// 80-147 (1980-2047)
// 0-6 0==sunday
PARAMETERS timeptr time
Address to store date and time into structure:
Seconds since January 1, 1980.
RETURN VALUE
0
LIBRARY
RTCLOCK.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
243
modf
float modf( float x, int * n );
DESCRIPTION
Splits x into a fraction and integer, f + n.
PARAMETERS x n
Floating-point integer
An integer
RETURN VALUE
The integer part in *n and the fractional part satisfies |f| < 1.0
LIBRARY
MATH.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
244 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
nf_eraseBlock
int nf_eraseBlock( nf_device * dev, long page );
DESCRIPTION
Erases the block that contains the specified page on the specified NAND flash device. Check for completion of the erase operation using either nf_isBusyRBHW() or nf_isBusyStatus() .
Normally, this function will not allow a bad block to be erased. However, when
NFLASH_CANERASEBADBLOCKS is defined by the application, the bad block check is not performed, and the application is allowed to erase any block, regardless of whether it is marked good or bad.
PARAMETERS dev page
Pointer to an initialized nf_device structure
Page specifies the zero-based number of a NAND flash page in the block to be erased, relative to the first “good” page.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success, or the first error result encountered
-1 : NAND flash device is busy
-2 : Block check time out error
-3 : Page is in a bad block
LIBRARY
NFLASH.LIB (This function was introduced in Dynamic C 9.01)
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
245
nf_getPageCount
long nf_getPageCount( nf_device * dev );
DESCRIPTION
Returns the number of program pages on the particular NAND flash device.
PARAMETERS dev Pointer to an nf_device structure for an initialized NAND flash device.
RETURN VALUE
The number of program pages on the NAND flash device.
LIBRARY
NFLASH.LIB (This function was introduced in Dynamic C 9.01)
SEE ALSO
,
246 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
nf_getPageSize
long nf_getPageSize( nf_device * dev );
DESCRIPTION
Returns the size in bytes (excluding “spare” bytes) of each program page on the particular
NAND flash device.
PARAMETERS dev Pointer to an nf_device structure for an initialized NAND flash device.
RETURN VALUE
The number of data bytes in the NAND flash's program page, excluding the “spare” bytes used for ECC storage, etc.
LIBRARY
NFLASH.LIB (This function was introduced in Dynamic C 9.01)
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
247
nf_initDevice
int nf_initDevice( nf_device * dev, int which );
DESCRIPTION
Initializes a particular NAND flash device. This function must be called before the particular
NAND flash device can be used. See nf_devtable[] in NFLASH.LIB for the user-updatable list of supported NAND flash devices. Note that xalloc is called to allocate buffer(s) memory for each NAND flash device; a run time error will occur if the available xmem RAM is insufficient.
There are two modes of operation for NAND flash devices: FAT and direct. If you are using the
FAT file system in the default configuration, i.e., the NAND flash has one FAT partition that takes up the entire device, you do not need to call nf_initDevice(). You only need to call nf_InitDriver() , which is the default device driver for the FAT file system on a NAND flash device.
Configurations other than the default one require more work. For example, having two partitions on the device, one a FAT partition and the other a non-FAT partition, require you to know how to fit more than one partition on a device. A good example of how to do this is in the remote application upload utility. The function dlm_initserialflash() in
/LIB/RCM3300/downloadmanager.lib is where to look for code details.The upload utility is specifically for the RCM3300; however, even without the RCM3300, the utility is still useful in detailing what is necessary to manage multiple partitions.
The second mode of operation for NAND flash devices is direct access. An application that directly accesses the NAND flash (using calls such as nf_readPage() and nf_writePage() ) may define NFLASH_USEERASEBLOCKSIZE to be either 0 (zero) or
1 (one) before NFLASH.LIB is #used, in order to set the NAND flash driver's main data program unit size to either the devices' program page size of 512 bytes or to its erase block size of
16 KB.
If not defined by the application, NFLASH_USEERASEBLOCKSIZE is set to the value 1 in
NFLASH.LIB
; this mode should maximize the NAND flash devices' life.
NFLASH_USEERASEBLOCKSIZE value 1 sets the driver up to program an erase block size at a time. This mode may be best for applications with only a few files open in write mode with larger blocks of data being written, and may be especially good at append operations. The trade off is reduced flash erasures at the expense of chunkier overhead due to the necessity of performing all 32 pages' ECC calculations for each programming unit written.
NFLASH_USEERASEBLOCKSIZE value 0 sets the driver up to program a program page size at a time. This mode may be best for applications with more than a few files open in write mode with smaller blocks of data being written, and may be especially good at interleaved file writes and/or random access write operations. The trade off is increased flash erasures with the benefit of spread out overhead due to the necessity of performing only 1 page's ECC calculations per programming unit written.
248 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
nf_initDevice (cont’d)
PARAMETERS dev which
Pointer to an nf_device structure that will be filled in. An initialized nf_device struct acts as a handle for the NAND flash device.
Number of the NAND flash device to initialize. Currently supported device numbers are 0 for the soldered-on device or 1 for the socketed NAND flash device.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success
-1 : Unknown index or bad internal I/O port information
-2 : Error communicating with flash chip
-3 : Unknown flash chip type
LIBRARY
NFLASH.LIB (This function was introduced in Dynamic C 9.01)
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
249
nf_InitDriver
int nf_InitDriver( mbr_drvr * driver, void * device_list );
DESCRIPTION
Initializes the NAND flash controller.
PARAMETERS driver Empty mbr_drvr structure. It must be initialized with this function before it can be used with the FAT file system. More information on this structure can be found in the Dynamic C Module document titled, “FAT
File System User’s Manual,” available on the Rabbit Semiconductor website.
device_list If not null, this is a pointer to the head of a linked list of nf_device structures for NAND flash devices that have each already been initialized by calling nf_initDevice().
If device_list is null, then this function attempts to initialize all
NAND flash devices and provide a default linked list of nf_device structures in order from device number 0 on up. If the initialization of a
NAND flash device is unsuccessful, then its nf_device structure is not entered into the linked list.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success
<0 : Negative value of a FAT file system error code
LIBRARY
NFLASH_FAT.LIB (This function was introduced in Dynamic C 9.01)
250 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
nf_isBusyRBHW
int nf_isBusyRBHW( nf_device * dev );
DESCRIPTION
Returns 1 if the specified NAND flash device is busy. Uses the hardware Ready/Busy check method, and can be used to determine the device's busy status even at the start of a read page command. Note that this function briefly enforces the Ready/Busy input port bit, reads the pin status, and then restores the port bit to its previous input/output state. There should be little or no visible disturbance of the LED output which shares the NAND flash's Ready/Busy status line.
PARAMETERS dev Pointer to an initialized nf_device structure for the particular NAND flash chip.
RETURN VALUE
1 : Busy
0 : Ready, (not currently transferring a page to be read, or erasing or writing a page)
-1 : Error (unsupported Ready/Busy input port)
LIBRARY
NFLASH.LIB (This function was introduced in Dynamic C 9.01)
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
251
nf_isBusyStatus
int nf_isBusyStatus( nf_device * dev );
DESCRIPTION
Returns 1 if the specified NAND flash device is busy erasing or writing to a page. Uses the software status check method, which can not (must not) be used to determine the device's busy status at the start of a read page command.
PARAMETERS dev Pointer to an initialized nf_device structure for the particular NAND flash chip
RETURN VALUE
1: Busy
0 : Ready (not currently erasing or writing a page)
LIBRARY
NFLASH.LIB (This function was introduced in Dynamic C 9.01)
SEE ALSO
252 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
nf_readPage
int nf_readPage( nf_device * dev, long buffer, long page );
DESCRIPTION
Reads data from the specified NAND flash device and page to the specified buffer in xmem.
Note that in the case of most error results at least some of the NAND flash page's content has been read into the specified buffer. Although the buffer content must be considered unreliable, it can sometimes be useful for inspecting page content in “bad” blocks.
PARAMETERS dev buffer page
Pointer to an initialized nf_device structure
Physical address of the xmem buffer to read data into
Specifies the zero-based number of a NAND flash page to be read, relative to the first “good” page’s number.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success, or the first error result encountered
-1 : NAND flash device is busy
-2 : Block check time out error
-3 : Page is in a bad block
-4 : Page read time out error
-5 : Uncorrectable data or ECC error
LIBRARY
NFLASH.LIB (This function was introduced in Dynamic C 9.01)
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
253
nf_writePage
int nf_writePage( nf_device * dev, long buffer, long page );
DESCRIPTION
Writes data to the specified NAND flash device and page from the specified buffer in xmem.
Check for completion of the write operation using nf_isBusyRBHW() or nf_isBusyStatus() .
PARAMETERS dev buffer page
Pointer to an initialized nf_device structure
Physical address of the xmem data to be written
Specifies the zero-based number of a NAND flash page to be written, relative to the first “good” page.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success, or the first error result encountered
-1 : NAND flash device is busy
-2 : Block check time out error
-3 : Page is in a bad block
-4 : XMEM/root memory transfer error
-5 : Erase block or program page operation error.
LIBRARY
NFLASH.LIB (This function was introduced in Dynamic C 9.01)
SEE ALSO
,
254 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
nf_XD_Detect
long nf_XD_Detect( int debounceMode );
DESCRIPTION
This function attempts to read the xD card ID and searches the internal device table for that ID in detect mode 1. In detect mode 0 it just uses the xD card detect.
Assumes only one XD card present.
WARNING! - This should not be called to determine if it is safe to do write operations if there is a chance a removable device might be pulled between calling it and the write. It is best used to determine if a device is present to proceed with an automount after a device has been unmounted in SW and removed.
PARAMETERS debounceMode 0 - no debouncing
1 - busy wait for debouncing interval
2 - for use if function to be called until debouncing interval is done, e.g., waitfor(rc = nf_XD_Detect(1) != -EAGAIN);
-EAGAIN will be returned until done.
RETURN VALUE
>0 : The ID that was found on the device and in the table
-EBUSY : NAND flash device is busy
-ENODEV : No device found
-EAGAIN : if debounceMode equals 2, then not done debouncing, try again
LIBRARY
NFLASH_FAT.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
255
OpenInputCompressedFile
int OpenInputCompressedFile( ZFILE * ifp, long fn );
DESCRIPTION
Opens a file for input. This function sets up the LZ compression algorithm window associated with the ZFILE file. The second parameter is the file handle (FS2) or address (#zimport) of the input file to be opened. If the file is already compressed, after calling this function the file can be decompressed by calling ReadCompressedFile(). If the file handle points to an uncompressed FS2 file, after calling this function the resulting ZFILE file can be compressed by calling CompressFile().
The INPUT_COMPRESSION_BUFFERS macro controls the memory allocated by this function. It defaults to 1.
PARAMETERS ifp fn
ZFILE file descriptor
Address or handle of input file
RETURN VALUE
0 : Failure
1 : Success
LIBRARY
LZSS.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
256 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
OpenOutputCompressedFile
int OpenOutputCompressedFile( ZFILE * ofp, int fn );
DESCRIPTION
Open an FS2 file for compressed output. This function sets up the LZ compression algorithm window and tree associated with the ZFILE file. The second parameter is the file handle (FS2) of the output file to be written to. Note that this MUST be an FS2 file handle, or the open will fail.
The OUTPUT_COMPRESSION_BUFFERS macro must be defined as a positive non-zero number if compression is being used.
PARAMETERS ofp fn
ZFILE file descriptor
FS2 handle of output file
RETURN VALUE
0 : Failure
1 : Success
LIBRARY
LZSS.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
257
OS_ENTER_CRITICAL
void OS_ENTER_CRITICAL( void );
DESCRIPTION
Enter a critical section. Interrupts will be disabled until OS_EXIT_CRITICAL() is called.
Task switching is disabled. This function must be used with great care, since misuse can greatly increase the latency of your application. Note that nesting OS_ENTER_CRITICAL() calls will work correctly.
LIBRARY
UCOS2.LIB
OS_EXIT_CRITICAL
void OS_EXIT_CRITICAL( void );
DESCRIPTION
Exit a critical section. If the corresponding previous OS_ENTER_CRITICAL() call disabled interrupts (that is, interrupts were not already disabled), then interrupts will be enabled. Otherwise, interrupts will remain disabled. Hence, nesting calls to OS_ENTER_CRITICAL() will work correctly.
LIBRARY
UCOS2.LIB
258 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
OSFlagAccept
OS_FLAGS OSFlagAccept( OS_FLAG_GRP * pgrp, OS_FLAGS flags, INT8U wait_type, INT8U * err );
DESCRIPTION
This function is called to check the status of a combination of bits to be set or cleared in an event flag group. Your application can check for ANY bit to be set/cleared or ALL bits to be set/cleared.
This call does not block if the desired flags are not present.
PARAMETERS pgrp flags wait_type
Pointer to the desired event flag group.
Bit pattern indicating which bit(s) (i.e. flags) you wish to check. E.g., if your application wants to wait for bits 0 and 1 then flags should be 0x03.
Specifies whether you are checking for ALL bits to be set/cleared or ANY of the bits to be set/cleared. You can specify the following argument:
• OS_FLAG_WAIT_CLR_ALL - You will check ALL bits in flags to be clear (0)
• OS_FLAG_WAIT_CLR_ANY - You will check ANY bit in flags to be clear (0)
• OS_FLAG_WAIT_SET_ALL - You will check ALL bits in flags to be set (1)
• OS_FLAG_WAIT_SET_ANY - You will check ANY bit in flags to be set (1)
Note: Add OS_FLAG_CONSUME if you want the event flag to be consumed by the call. Example, to wait for any flag in a group AND then clear the flags that are present, set the wait_type parameter to:
OS_FLAG_WAIT_SET_ANY + OS_FLAG_CONSUME
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
259
OSFlagAccept (cont’d)
err Pointer to an error code. Possible values are:
• OS_NO_ERR - No error
• OS_ERR_EVENT_TYPE - Not pointing to an event flag group
• OS_FLAG_ERR_WAIT_TYPE - Proper wait_type argument not specified.
• OS_FLAG_INVALID_PGRP - null pointer passed instead of the event flag group handle.
• OS_FLAG_ERR_NOT_RDY - Flags not available.
RETURN VALUE
The state of the flags in the event flag group.
LIBRARY
OS_FLAG.C (Prior to DC 8:UCOS2.LIB)
260 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
OSFlagCreate
OS_FLAG_GRP * OSFlagCreate( OS_FLAGS flags, INT8U * err );
DESCRIPTION
This function is called to create an event flag group.
PARAMETERS flags err
Contains the initial value to store in the event flag group.
Pointer to an error code that will be returned to your application:
• OS_NO_ERR - The call was successful.
• OS_ERR_CREATE_ISR - Attempt made to create an Event Flag from an ISR.
• OS_FLAG_GRP_DEPLETED - There are no more event flag groups
RETURN VALUE
A pointer to an event flag group or a null pointer if no more groups are available.
LIBRARY
OS_FLAG.C (Prior to DC 8:UCOS2.LIB)
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
261
OSFlagDel
OS_FLAG_GRP * OSFlagDel( OS_FLAG_GRP * pgrp, INT8U opt, INT8U * err);
DESCRIPTION
This function deletes an event flag group and readies all tasks pending on the event flag group.
Note that:
• This function must be used with care. Tasks that would normally expect the presence of the event flag group must check the return code of OSFlagAccept() and OSFlagPend().
• This call can potentially disable interrupts for a long time. The interrupt disable time is directly proportional to the number of tasks waiting on the event flag group.
PARAMETERS pgrp opt err
Pointer to the desired event flag group.
May be one of the following delete options:
• OS_DEL_NO_PEND - Deletes the event flag group only if no task pending
• OS_DEL_ALWAYS - Deletes the event flag group even if tasks are waiting. In this case, all the tasks pending will be readied..
Pointer to an error code. May be one of the following values:
• OS_NO_ERR - Success, the event flag group was deleted
• OS_ERR_DEL_ISR - If you attempted to delete the event flag group from an ISR
• OS_FLAG_INVALID_PGRP - If pgrp is a null pointer.
• OS_ERR_EVENT_TYPE - You are not pointing to an event flag group
• OS_ERR_EVENT_TYPE - If you didn't pass a pointer to an event flag group
• OS_ERR_INVALID_OPT - Invalid option was specified
• OS_ERR_TASK_WAITING - One or more tasks were waiting on the event flag group.
RETURN VALUE pevent
(OS_EVENT *)0
Error.
Semaphore was successfully deleted.
LIBRARY
OS_FLAG.C (Prior to DC 8:UCOS2.LIB)
262 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
OSFlagPend
OS_FLAGS OSFlagPend( OS_FLAG_GRP * pgrp, OS_FLAGS flags, INT8U wait_type, INT16U timeout, INT8U * err );
DESCRIPTION
This function is called to wait for a combination of bits to be set in an event flag group. Your application can wait for ANY bit to be set or ALL bits to be set.
PARAMETERS pgrp flags wait_type timeout
Pointer to the desired event flag group.
Bit pattern indicating which bit(s) (i.e. flags) you wish to wait for. E.g. if your application wants to wait for bits 0 and 1 then flags should be 0x03.
Specifies whether you want ALL bits to be set or ANY of the bits to be set.
You can specify the following argument:
• OS_FLAG_WAIT_CLR_ALL - You will wait for ALL bits in mask to be clear (0)
• OS_FLAG_WAIT_SET_ALL - You will wait for ALL bits in mask to be set (1)
• OS_FLAG_WAIT_CLR_ANY - You will wait for ANY bit in mask to be clear (0)
• OS_FLAG_WAIT_SET_ANY - You will wait for ANY bit in mask to be set (1)
Note: Add OS_FLAG_CONSUME if you want the event flag to be consumed by the call. E.g., to wait for any flag in a group AND then clear the flags that are present, set the wait_type parameter to:
OS_FLAG_WAIT_SET_ANY + OS_FLAG_CONSUME
An optional timeout (in clock ticks) that your task will wait for the desired bit combination. If you specify 0, however, your task will wait forever at the specified event flag group or, until a message arrives.
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
263
OSFlagPend (cont’d)
err Pointer to an error code. Possible values are:
OS_NO_ERR - The desired bits have been set within the specified timeout.
OS_ERR_PEND_ISR - If you tried to PEND from an ISR.
OS_FLAG_INVALID_PGRP - If pgrp is a null pointer.
OS_ERR_EVENT_TYPE - You are not pointing to an event flag group
OS_TIMEOUT - The bit(s) have not been set in the specified time-out.
OS_FLAG_ERR_WAIT_TYPE - You didn't specify a proper wait_type argument.
RETURN VALUE
The new state of the flags in the event flag group when the task is resumed or, 0 if a timeout or an error occurred.
LIBRARY
OS_FLAG.C (Prior to DC 8:UCOS2.LIB)
264 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
OSFlagPost
OS_FLAGS OSFlagPost( OS_FLAG_GRP * pgrp, OS_FLAGS flags, INT8U opt,
INT8U * err );
DESCRIPTION
This function is called to set or clear some bits in an event flag group. The bits to set or clear are specified by a bitmask. Warnings:
• The execution time of this function depends on the number of tasks waiting on the event flag group.
• The amount of time interrupts are DISABLED depends on the number of tasks waiting on the event flag group.
PARAMETERS pgrp flags opt err
Pointer to the desired event flag group.
If opt (see below) is OS_FLAG_SET, each bit that is set in flags will set the corresponding bit in the event flag group. E.g., to set bits 0, 4 and 5 you would set flags to:
0x31 ( note, bit 0 is least significant bit)
If opt (see below) is OS_FLAG_CLR, each bit that is set in flags will
CLEAR the corresponding bit in the event flag group. E.g., to clear bits 0,
4 and 5 you would specify flags as:
0x31 ( note, bit 0 is least significant bit)
Indicates whether the flags will be: set (OS_FLAG_SET), or cleared (OS_FLAG_CLR)
Pointer to an error code. Valid values are:
• OS_NO_ERR - The call was successful.
• OS_FLAG_INVALID_PGRP - null pointer passed.
• OS_ERR_EVENT_TYPE - Not pointing to an event flag group
• OS_FLAG_INVALID_OPT - Invalid option specified.
RETURN VALUE
The new value of the event flags bits that are still set.
LIBRARY
OS_FLAG.C (Prior to DC 8:UCOS2.LIB)
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
265
OSFlagQuery
OS_FLAGS OSFlagQuery( OS_FLAG_GRP * pgrp, INT8U * err );
DESCRIPTION
This function is used to check the value of the event flag group.
PARAMETERS pgrp err
Pointer to the desired event flag group.
Pointer to an error code returned to the called:
• OS_NO_ERR - The call was successful
• OS_FLAG_INVALID_PGRP - null pointer passed.
• OS_ERR_EVENT_TYPE - Not pointing to an event flag group
RETURN VALUE
The current value of the event flag group.
LIBRARY
OS_FLAG.C (Prior to DC 8:UCOS2.LIB)
266 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
OSInit
void OSInit( void );
DESCRIPTION
Initializes µC/OS-II data; must be called before any other µC/OS-II functions are called.
LIBRARY
UCOS2.LIB
SEE ALSO
OSMboxAccept
void * OSMboxAccept( OS_EVENT * pevent );
DESCRIPTION
Checks the mailbox to see if a message is available. Unlike OSMboxPend(),
OSMboxAccept() does not suspend the calling task if a message is not available.
PARAMETERS pevent Pointer to the mailbox’s event control block.
RETURN VALUE
!= (void *)0
== (void *)0
This is the message in the mailbox if one is available. The mailbox is cleared so the next time OSMboxAccept() is called, the mailbox will be empty.
The mailbox is empty, or pevent is a null pointer, or you didn't pass the proper event pointer.
LIBRARY
OS_MBOX.C (Prior to DC 8:UCOS2.LIB)
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
267
OSMboxCreate
OS_EVENT * OSMboxCreate( void * msg );
DESCRIPTION
Creates a message mailbox if event control blocks are available.
PARAMETERS msg Pointer to a message to put in the mailbox. If this value is set to the null pointer (i.e., (void *)0) then the mailbox will be considered empty.
RETURN VALUE
!= (void *)0
== (void *)0
A pointer to the event control clock (OS_EVENT) associated with the created mailbox.
No event control blocks were available.
LIBRARY
OS_MBOX.C (Prior to DC 8:UCOS2.LIB)
SEE ALSO
268 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
OSMboxDel
OS_EVENT * OSMboxDel( OS_EVENT * pevent, INT8U opt, INT8U * err );
DESCRIPTION
This function deletes a mailbox and readies all tasks pending on the mailbox. Note that:
• This function must be used with care. Tasks that would normally expect the presence of the mailbox MUST check the return code of OSMboxPend().
• OSMboxAccept() callers will not know that the intended mailbox has been deleted unless they check pevent to see that it's a null pointer.
• This call can potentially disable interrupts for a long time. The interrupt disable time is directly proportional to the number of tasks waiting on the mailbox.
• Because ALL tasks pending on the mailbox will be readied, you MUST be careful in applications where the mailbox is used for mutual exclusion because the resource(s) will no longer be guarded by the mailbox.
PARAMETERS pevent opt err
Pointer to the event control block associated with the desired mailbox.
May be one of the following delete options:
• OS_DEL_NO_PEND - Delete mailbox only if no task pending
• OS_DEL_ALWAYS - Deletes the mailbox even if tasks are waiting. In this case, all the tasks pending will be readied.
Pointer to an error code that can contain one of the following values:
• OS_NO_ERR - Call was successful; mailbox was deleted
• OS_ERR_DEL_ISR - Attempt to delete mailbox from ISR
• OS_ERR_INVALID_OPT - Invalid option was specified
• OS_ERR_TASK_WAITING - One or more tasks were waiting on the mailbox
• OS_ERR_EVENT_TYPE - No pointer passed to a mailbox
• OS_ERR_PEVENT_NULL - If pevent is a null pointer.
RETURN VALUE
!= (void *)0
== (void *)0
Is a pointer to the event control clock (OS_EVENT) associated with the created mailbox
If no event control blocks were available
LIBRARY
OS_MBOX.C
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
269
OSMboxPend
void *OSMboxPend( OS_EVENT *pevent, INT16U timeout, INT8U *err );
DESCRIPTION
Waits for a message to be sent to a mailbox.
PARAMETERS pevent timeout err
Pointer to mailbox’s event control block.
Allows task to resume execution if a message was not received by the number of clock ticks specified. Specifying 0 means the task is willing to wait forever.
Pointer to a variable for holding an error code. Possible error messages are:
• OS_NO_ERR: The call was successful and the task received a message.
• OS_TIMEOUT: A message was not received within the specified timeout
• OS_ERR_EVENT_TYPE: Invalid event type
• OS_ERR_PEND_ISR If this function was called from an ISR and the result would lead to a suspension.
• OS_ERR_PEVENT_NULL: If pevent is a null pointer
RETURN VALUE
!= (void *)0
== (void *)0
A pointer to the message received
No message was received, or pevent is a null pointer, or the proper pointer to the event control block was not passed.
LIBRARY
OS_MBOX.C (Prior to DC 8:UCOS2.LIB)
SEE ALSO
270 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
OSMboxPost
INT8U OSMboxPost( OS_EVENT * pevent, void * msg );
DESCRIPTION
Sends a message to the specified mailbox.
PARAMETERS pevent msg
Pointer to mailbox’s event control block.
Pointer to message to be posted. A null pointer must not be sent.
RETURN VALUE
OS_NO_ERR
OS_MBOX_FULL
OS_ERR_EVENT_TYPE
OS_ERR_PEVENT_NULL
OS_ERR_POST_NULL_PTR
The call was successful and the message was sent.
The mailbox already contains a message. Only one message at a time can be sent and thus, the message MUST be consumed before another can be sent.
Attempting to post to a non-mailbox.
If pevent is a null pointer
If you are attempting to post a null pointer
LIBRARY
OS_MBOX.C (Prior to DC 8:UCOS2.LIB)
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
271
OSMboxPostOpt
INT8U OSMboxPostOpt( OS_EVENT * pevent, void * msg, INT8U opt );
DESCRIPTION
This function sends a message to a mailbox.
Note: Interrupts can be disabled for a long time if you do a “broadcast.” The interrupt disable time is proportional to the number of tasks waiting on the mailbox.
PARAMETERS pevent msg opt
Pointer to mailbox’s event control block.
Pointer to the message to send. A null pointer must not be sent.
Determines the type of POST performed:
• OS_POST_OPT_NONE - POST to a single waiting task (Identical to
OS_MboxPost() )
• OS_POST_OPT_BROADCAST - POST to ALL tasks that are waiting on the mailbox
RETURN VALUE
OS_NO_ERR
OS_MBOX_FULL
OS_ERR_EVENT_TYPE
OS_ERR_PEVENT_NULL
OS_ERR_POST_NULL_PTR
The call was successful and the message was sent.
The mailbox already contains a message. Only one message at a time can be sent and thus, the message MUST be consumed before another can be sent.
Attempting to post to a non-mailbox.
If pevent is a null pointer
If you are attempting to post a null pointer
LIBRARY
OS_MBOX.C (Prior to DC 8:UCOS2.LIB)
272 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
OSMboxQuery
INT8U OSMboxQuery( OS_EVENT * pevent, OS_MBOX_DATA * pdata );
DESCRIPTION
Obtains information about a message mailbox.
PARAMETERS pevent pdata
Pointer to message mailbox’s event control block.
Pointer to a data structure for information about the message mailbox
RETURN VALUE
OS_NO_ERR
OS_ERR_EVENT_TYPE
The call was successful and the message was sent.
Attempting to obtain data from a non mailbox.
LIBRARY
UCOS2.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
273
OSMemCreate
OS_MEM * OSMemCreate( void * addr, INT32U nblks, INT32U blksize,
INT8U * err );
DESCRIPTION
Creates a fixed-sized memory partition that will be managed by µC/OS-II.
PARAMETERS addr nblks blksize err
Pointer to starting address of the partition.
Number of memory blocks to create in the partition.
The size (in bytes) of the memory blocks.
Pointer to variable containing an error message.
RETURN VALUE
Pointer to the created memory partition control block if one is available, null pointer otherwise.
LIBRARY
UCOS2.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
274 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
OSMemGet
void * OSMemGet( OS_MEM * pmem, INT8U * err );
DESCRIPTION
Gets a memory block from the specified partition.
PARAMETERS pmem err
Pointer to partition’s memory control block
Pointer to variable containing an error message
RETURN VALUE
Pointer to a memory block or a null pointer if an error condition is detected.
LIBRARY
UCOS2.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
275
OSMemPut
INT8U OSMemPut( OS_MEM * pmem, void * pblk );
DESCRIPTION
Returns a memory block to a partition.
PARAMETERS pmem pblk
Pointer to the partition’s memory control block.
Pointer to the memory block being released.
RETURN VALUE
OS_NO_ERR
OS_MEM_FULL
The memory block was inserted into the partition.
If returning a memory block to an already FULL memory partition. (More blocks were freed than allocated!)
LIBRARY
UCOS2.LIB
SEE ALSO
276 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
OSMemQuery
INT8U OSMemQuery( OS_MEM * pmem, OS_MEM_DATA * pdata );
DESCRIPTION
Determines the number of both free and used memory blocks in a memory partition.
PARAMETERS pmem pdata
Pointer to partition’s memory control block.
Pointer to structure for holding information about the partition.
RETURN VALUE
OS_NO_ERR This function always returns no error.
LIBRARY
UCOS2.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
277
OSMutexAccept
INT8U OSMutexAccept( OS_EVENT * pevent, INT8U * err );
DESCRIPTION
This function checks the mutual exclusion semaphore to see if a resource is available. Unlike
OSMutexPend() , OSMutexAccept() does not suspend the calling task if the resource is not available or the event did not occur. This function cannot be called from an ISR because mutual exclusion semaphores are intended to be used by tasks only.
PARAMETERS pevent err
Pointer to the event control block.
Pointer to an error code that will be returned to your application:
• OS_NO_ERR - if the call was successful.
• OS_ERR_EVENT_TYPE - if pevent is not a pointer to a mutex
• OS_ERR_PEVENT_NULL - pevent is a null pointer
• OS_ERR_PEND_ISR - if you called this function from an ISR
RETURN VALUE
1 : Success, the resource is available and the mutual exclusion semaphore is acquired.
0 : Error, either the resource is not available, or you didn't pass a pointer to a mutual exclusion semaphore, or you called this function from an ISR.
LIBRARY
OS_MUTEX.C
278 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
OSMutexCreate
OS_EVENT *OSMutexCreate( INT8U prio, INT8U * err );
DESCRIPTION
This function creates a mutual exclusion semaphore. Note that:
• The LEAST significant 8 bits of the OSEventCnt field of the mutex’s event control block are used to hold the priority number of the task owning the mutex or 0xFF if no task owns the mutex.
• The MOST significant 8 bits of the OSEventCnt field of the mutex’s event control block are used to hold the priority number to use to reduce priority inversion.
PARAMETERS prio err
The priority to use when accessing the mutual exclusion semaphore. In other words, when the semaphore is acquired and a higher priority task attempts to obtain the semaphore then the priority of the task owning the semaphore is raised to this priority. It is assumed that you will specify a priority that is LOWER in value than ANY of the tasks competing for the mutex.
Pointer to error code that will be returned to your application:
• OS_NO_ERR - if the call was successful.
• OS_ERR_CREATE_ISR - you attempted to create a mutex from an ISR
• OS_PRIO_EXIST - a task at the priority inheritance priority already exist.
• OS_ERR_PEVENT_NULL - no more event control blocks available.
• OS_PRIO_INVALID - if the priority you specify is higher that the maximum allowed (i.e. > OS_LOWEST_PRIO)
RETURN VALUE
!= (void *)0
== (void *)0
Pointer to the event control clock (OS_EVENT) associated with the created mutex.
Error detected.
LIBRARY
OS_MUTEX.C
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
279
OSMutexDel
OS_EVENT *OSMutexDel( OS_EVENT * pevent, INT8U opt, INT8U * err );
DESCRIPTION
This function deletes a mutual exclusion semaphore and readies all tasks pending on it. Note that:
• This function must be used with care. Tasks that would normally expect the presence of the mutex MUST check the return code of OSMutexPend().
• This call can potentially disable interrupts for a long time. The interrupt disable time is directly proportional to the number of tasks waiting on the mutex.
• Because ALL tasks pending on the mutex will be readied, you MUST be careful because the resource(s) will no longer be guarded by the mutex.
PARAMETERS pevent opt err
Pointer to mutex’s event control block.
May be one of the following delete options:
• OS_DEL_NO_PEND - Delete mutex only if no task pending
• OS_DEL_ALWAYS - Deletes the mutex even if tasks are waiting. In this case, all pending tasks will be readied.
Pointer to an error code that can contain one of the following values:
• OS_NO_ERR - The call was successful and the mutex was deleted
• OS_ERR_DEL_ISR - Attempted to delete the mutex from an ISR
• OS_ERR_INVALID_OPT - An invalid option was specified
• OS_ERR_TASK_WAITING - One or more tasks were waiting on the mutex
• OS_ERR_EVENT_TYPE - If you didn't pass a pointer to a mutex pointer.
RETURN VALUE pevent
(OS_EVENT *)0
On error.
Mutex was deleted.
LIBRARY
OS_MUTEX.C
280 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
OSMutexPend
void OSMutexPend( OS_EVENT *pevent, INT16U timeout, INT8U *err );
DESCRIPTION
This function waits for a mutual exclusion semaphore. Note that:
• The task that owns the Mutex MUST NOT pend on any other event while it owns the mutex.
• You MUST NOT change the priority of the task that owns the mutex.
PARAMETERS pevent timeout err
Pointer to mutex’s event control block.
Optional timeout period (in clock ticks). If non-zero, your task will wait for the resource up to the amount of time specified by this argument. If you specify 0, however, your task will wait forever at the specified mutex or, until the resource becomes available.
Pointer to where an error message will be deposited. Possible error messages are:
OS_NO_ERR - The call was successful and your task owns the mutex
OS_TIMEOUT - The mutex was not available within the specified time.
OS_ERR_EVENT_TYPE - If you didn't pass a pointer to a mutex
OS_ERR_PEVENT_NULL - pevent is a null pointer
OS_ERR_PEND_ISR - If you called this function from an ISR and the result would lead to a suspension.
LIBRARY
OS_MUTEX.C
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
281
OSMutexPost
INT8U OSMutexPost( OS_EVENT * pevent );
DESCRIPTION
This function signals a mutual exclusion semaphore.
PARAMETERS pevent Pointer to mutex’s event control block.
RETURN VALUE
OS_NO_ERR
OS_ERR_EVENT_TYPE
OS_ERR_PEVENT_NULL
OS_ERR_POST_ISR
OS_ERR_NOT_MUTEX_OWNER
LIBRARY
OS_MUTEX.C
The call was successful and the mutex was signaled.
If you didn't pass a pointer to a mutex pevent is a null pointer
Attempted to post from an ISR (invalid for mutexes)
The task that did the post is NOT the owner of the MUTEX.
282 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
OSMutexQuery
INT8U OSMutexQuery( OS_EVENT * pevent, OS_MUTEX_DATA * pdata );
DESCRIPTION
This function obtains information about a mutex.
PARAMETERS pevent pdata
Pointer to the event control block associated with the desired mutex.
Pointer to a structure that will contain information about the mutex.
RETURN VALUE
OS_NO_ERR
OS_ERR_QUERY_ISR
OS_ERR_PEVENT_NULL
OS_ERR_EVENT_TYPE
The call was successful and the message was sent
Function was called from an ISR pevent is a null pointer
Attempting to obtain data from a non mutex.
LIBRARY
OS_MUTEX.C
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
283
OSQAccept
void * OSQAccept( OS_EVENT * pevent );
DESCRIPTION
Checks the queue to see if a message is available. Unlike OSQPend(), with OSQAccept() the calling task is not suspended if a message is unavailable.
PARAMETERS pevent Pointer to the message queue’s event control block.
RETURN VALUE
Pointer to message in the queue if one is available, null pointer otherwise.
LIBRARY
OS_Q.C (Prior to DC 8:UCOS2.LIB)
SEE ALSO
,
,
,
,
284 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
OSQCreate
OS_EVENT * OSQCreate( void ** start, INT16U qsize );
DESCRIPTION
Creates a message queue if event control blocks are available.
PARAMETERS start qsize
Pointer to the base address of the message queue storage area. The storage area MUST be declared an array of pointers to void: void
*MessageStorage[qsize].
Number of elements in the storage area.
RETURN VALUE
Pointer to message queue’s event control block or null pointer if no event control blocks were available.
LIBRARY
OS_Q.C (Prior to DC 8:UCOS2.LIB)
SEE ALSO
,
,
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
285
OSQDel
OS_EVENT * OSQDel( OS_EVENT * pevent, INT8U opt, INT8U * err );
DESCRIPTION
Deletes a message queue and readies all tasks pending on the queue. Note that:
• This function must be used with care. Tasks that would normally expect the presence of the queue MUST check the return code of OSQPend().
• OSQAccept() callers will not know that the intended queue has been deleted unless they check pevent to see that it's a null pointer.
• This call can potentially disable interrupts for a long time. The interrupt disable time is directly proportional to the number of tasks waiting on the queue.
• Because all tasks pending on the queue will be readied, you must be careful in applications where the queue is used for mutual exclusion because the resource(s) will no longer be guarded by the queue.
• If the storage for the message queue was allocated dynamically (i.e., using a malloc() type call) then your application must release the memory storage by call the counterpart call of the dynamic allocation scheme used. If the queue storage was created statically then, the storage can be reused.
PARAMETERS pevent opt err
Pointer to the queue’s event control block.
May be one of the following delete options:
• OS_DEL_NO_PEND - Delete queue only if no task pending
• OS_DEL_ALWAYS - Deletes the queue even if tasks are waiting. In this case, all the tasks pending will be readied.
Pointer to an error code that can contain one of the following:
• OS_NO_ERR - Call was successful and queue was deleted
• OS_ERR_DEL_ISR - Attempt to delete queue from an ISR
• OS_ERR_INVALID_OPT - Invalid option was specified
• OS_ERR_TASK_WAITING - One or more tasks were waiting on the queue
• OS_ERR_EVENT_TYPE - You didn't pass a pointer to a queue
• OS_ERR_PEVENT_NULL - If pevent is a null pointer.
RETURN VALUE pevent
(OS_EVENT *)0
Error
The queue was successfully deleted.
LIBRARY
OS_Q.C (Prior to DC 8:UCOS2.LIB)
286 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
OSQFlush
INT8U OSQFlush( OS_EVENT * pevent );
DESCRIPTION
Flushes the contents of the message queue.
PARAMETERS pevent Pointer to message queue’s event control block.
RETURN VALUE
OS_NO_ERR
OS_ERR_EVENT_TYPE
OS_ERR_PEVENT_NULL
Success.
A pointer to a queue was not passed.
If pevent is a null pointer.
LIBRARY
OS_Q.C (Prior to DC 8:UCOS2.LIB)
SEE ALSO
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
287
OSQPend
void * OSQPend( OS_EVENT * pevent, INT16U timeout, INT8U * err );
DESCRIPTION
Waits for a message to be sent to a queue.
PARAMETERS pevent timeout err
Pointer to message queue’s event control block.
Allow task to resume execution if a message was not received by the number of clock ticks specified. Specifying 0 means the task is willing to wait forever.
Pointer to a variable for holding an error code.
RETURN VALUE
Pointer to a message or, if a timeout occurs, a null pointer.
LIBRARY
OS_Q.C (Prior to DC 8:UCOS2.LIB)
SEE ALSO
288 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
OSQPost
INT8U OSQPost( OS_EVENT * pevent, void * msg );
DESCRIPTION
Sends a message to the specified queue.
PARAMETERS pevent msg
Pointer to message queue’s event control block.
Pointer to the message to send. A null pointer must not be sent.
RETURN VALUE
OS_NO_ERR
OS_Q_FULL
OS_ERR_POST_NULL_PTR
The call was successful and the message was sent.
The queue cannot accept any more messages because it is full.
OS_ERR_EVENT_TYPE
OS_ERR_PEVENT_NULL
If a pointer to a queue not passed.
If pevent is a null pointer.
If attempting to post to a null pointer.
LIBRARY
OS_Q.C (Prior to DC 8:UCOS2.LIB)
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
289
OSQPostFront
INT8U OSQPostFront( OS_EVENT * pevent, void * msg );
DESCRIPTION
Sends a message to the specified queue, but unlike OSQPost(), the message is posted at the front instead of the end of the queue. Using OSQPostFront() allows 'priority' messages to be sent.
PARAMETERS pevent msg
Pointer to message queue’s event control block.
Pointer to the message to send. A null pointer must not be sent.
RETURN VALUE
OS_NO_ERR
OS_Q_FULL
OS_ERR_EVENT_TYPE
OS_ERR_PEVENT_NULL
OS_ERR_POST_NULL_PTR
The call was successful and the message was sent.
The queue cannot accept any more messages because it is full.
A pointer to a queue was not passed.
If pevent is a null pointer.
Attempting to post to a non mailbox.
LIBRARY
OS_Q.C (Prior to DC 8:UCOS2.LIB)
SEE ALSO
,
,
290 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
OSQPostOpt
INT8U OSQPostOpt( OS_EVENT * pevent, void * msg, INT8U opt );
DESCRIPTION
This function sends a message to a queue. This call has been added to reduce code size since it can replace both OSQPost() and OSQPostFront(). Also, this function adds the capability to broadcast a message to all tasks waiting on the message queue.
Note: Interrupts can be disabled for a long time if you do a “broadcast.” In fact, the interrupt disable time is proportional to the number of tasks waiting on the queue.
PARAMETERS pevent msg opt
Pointer to message queue’s event control block.
Pointer to the message to send. A null pointer must not be sent.
Determines the type of POST performed:
• OS_POST_OPT_NONE - POST to a single waiting task (Identical to
OSQPost() )
• OS_POST_OPT_BROADCAST - POST to ALL tasks that are waiting on the queue
• OS_POST_OPT_FRONT - POST as LIFO (Simulates
OSQPostFront() )
The last 2 flags may be combined:
• OS_POST_OPT_FRONT + OS_POST_OPT_BROADCAST - is identical to OSQPostFront() except that it will broadcast msg to all waiting tasks.
RETURN VALUE
OS_NO_ERR
OS_Q_FULL
OS_ERR_EVENT_TYPE
OS_ERR_PEVENT_NULL
OS_ERR_POST_NULL_PTR
The call was successful and the message was sent.
The queue is full, cannot accept any more messages.
A pointer to a queue was not passed.
If pevent is a null pointer.
Attempting to post a null pointer.
LIBRARY
OS_Q.C (Prior to DC 8:UCOS2.LIB)
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
291
OSQQuery
INT8U OSQQuery( OS_EVENT * pevent, OS_Q_DATA * pdata );
DESCRIPTION
Obtains information about a message queue.
PARAMETERS pevent pdata
Pointer to message queue’s event control block.
Pointer to a data structure for message queue information.
RETURN VALUE
OS_NO_ERR
OS_ERR_EVENT_TYPE
OS_ERR_PEVENT_NULL
The call was successful and the message was sent
Attempting to obtain data from a non queue.
If pevent is a null pointer.
LIBRARY
OS_Q.C (Prior to DC 8:UCOS2.LIB)
SEE ALSO
,
,
292 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
OSSchedLock
void OSSchedLock( void );
DESCRIPTION
Prevents task rescheduling. This allows an application to prevent context switches until it is ready for them. There must be a matched call to OSSchedUnlock() for every call to
OSSchedLock() .
LIBRARY
UCOS2.LIB
SEE ALSO
OSSchedUnlock
void OSSchedUnlock( void );
DESCRIPTION
Allow task rescheduling. There must be a matched call to OSSchedUnlock() for every call to OSSchedLock().
LIBRARY
UCOS2.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
293
OSSemAccept
INT16U OSSemAccept( OS_EVENT * pevent );
DESCRIPTION
This function checks the semaphore to see if a resource is available or if an event occurred. Unlike OSSemPend(), OSSemAccept() does not suspend the calling task if the resource is not available or the event did not occur.
PARAMETERS pevent Pointer to the desired semaphore’s event control block
RETURN VALUE
Semaphore value:
If >0, semaphore value is decremented; value is returned before the decrement.
If 0, then either resource is unavailable, event did not occur, or null or invalid pointer was passed to the function.
LIBRARY
UCOS2.LIB
SEE ALSO
294 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
OSSemCreate
OS_EVENT * OSSemCreate( INT16U cnt );
DESCRIPTION
Creates a semaphore.
PARAMETERS
cnt The initial value of the semaphore.
RETURN VALUE
Pointer to the event control block (OS_EVENT) associated with the created semaphore, or null if no event control block is available.
LIBRARY
UCOS2.LIB
SEE ALSO
OSSemPend
void OSSemPend( OS_EVENT * pevent, INT16U timeout, INT8U * err );
DESCRIPTION
Waits on a semaphore.
PARAMETERS pevent timeout err
Pointer to the desired semaphore’s event control block
Time in clock ticks to wait for the resource. If 0, the task will wait until the resource becomes available or the event occurs.
Pointer to error message.
LIBRARY
UCOS2.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
295
OSSemPost
INT8U OSSemPost( OS_EVENT * pevent );
DESCRIPTION
This function signals a semaphore.
PARAMETERS pevent Pointer to the desired semaphore’s event control block
RETURN VALUE
OS_NO_ERR
OS_SEM_OVF
OS_ERR_EVENT_TYPE
OS_ERR_PEVENT_NULL
The call was successful and the semaphore was signaled.
If the semaphore count exceeded its limit. In other words, you have signalled the semaphore more often than you waited on it with either
OSSemAccept() or OSSemPend().
If a pointer to a semaphore not passed.
If pevent is a null pointer.
LIBRARY
UCOS2.LIB
SEE ALSO
296 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
OSSemQuery
INT8U OSSemQuery( OS_EVENT * pevent, OS_SEM_DATA * pdata );
DESCRIPTION
Obtains information about a semaphore.
PARAMETERS pevent pdata
Pointer to the desired semaphore’s event control block
Pointer to a data structure that will hold information about the semaphore.
RETURN VALUE
OS_NO_ERR
OS_ERR_EVENT_TYPE
OS_ERR_PEVENT_NULL
The call was successful and the message was sent.
Attempting to obtain data from a non semaphore.
If the pevent parameter is a null pointer.
LIBRARY
UCOS2.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
297
OSSetTickPerSec
INT16U OSSetTickPerSec( INT16U TicksPerSec );
DESCRIPTION
Sets the amount of ticks per second (from 1 - 2048). Ticks per second defaults to 64. If this function is used, the #define OS_TICKS_PER_SEC needs to be changed so that the time delay functions work correctly. Since this function uses integer division, the actual ticks per second may be slightly different that the desired ticks per second.
PARAMETERS
TicksPerSec Unsigned 16-bit integer.
RETURN VALUE
The actual ticks per second set, as an unsigned 16-bit integer.
LIBRARY
UCOS2.LIB
SEE ALSO
OSStart
void OSStart( void );
DESCRIPTION
Starts the multitasking process, allowing µC/OS-II to manage the tasks that have been created.
Before OSStart() is called, OSInit() MUST have been called and at least one task
MUST have been created. This function calls OSStartHighRdy which calls
OSTaskSwHoo k and sets OSRunning to TRUE.
LIBRARY
UCOS2.LIB
SEE ALSO
298 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
void OSStatInit( void );
DESCRIPTION
Determines CPU usage.
LIBRARY
UCOS2.LIB
OSStatInit
OSTaskChangePrio
INT8U OSTaskChangePrio( INT8U oldprio, INT8U newprio );
DESCRIPTION
Allows a task's priority to be changed dynamically. Note that the new priority MUST be available.
PARAMETERS oldprio newprio
RETURN VALUE
OS_NO_ERR
OS_PRIO_INVALID
OS_PRIO_EXIST
OS_PRIO_ERR
The priority level to change from.
The priority level to change to.
The call was successful.
The priority specified is higher that the maximum allowed (i.e.
OS_LOWEST_PRIO ).
The new priority already exist
There is no task with the specified OLD priority (i.e. the OLD task does not exist).
LIBRARY
UCOS2.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
299
OSTaskCreate
INT8U OSTaskCreate( void (*task)(), void *pdata, INT16U stk_size,
INT8U prio );
DESCRIPTION
Creates a task to be managed by µC/OS-II. Tasks can either be created prior to the start of multitasking or by a running task. A task cannot be created by an ISR.
PARAMETERS task pdata stk_size prior
Pointer to the task’s starting address.
Pointer to a task’s initial parameters.
Number of bytes of the stack.
The task’s unique priority number.
RETURN VALUE
OS_NO_ERR
OS_PRIO_EXIT
OS_PRIO_INVALID
The call was successful.
Task priority already exists (each task MUST have a unique priority).
The priority specified is higher than the maximum allowed (i.e.
OS_LOWEST_PRIO ).
LIBRARY
UCOS2.LIB
SEE ALSO
300 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
OSTaskCreateExt
INT8U OSTaskCreateExt( void (* task)(), void * pdata, INT8U prio,
INT16U id, INT16U stk_size, void * pext, INT16U opt );
DESCRIPTION
Creates a task to be managed by µC/OS-II. Tasks can either be created prior to the start of multitasking or by a running task. A task cannot be created by an ISR. This function is similar to
OSTaskCreate() except that it allows additional information about a task to be specified.
PARAMETERS task pdata
prio id stk_size pext opt
Pointer to task’s code.
Pointer to optional data area; used to pass parameters to the task at start of execution.
The task’s unique priority number; the lower the number the higher the priority.
The task’s identification number (0...65535).
Size of the stack in number of elements. If OS_STK is set to INT8U, stk_size corresponds to the number of bytes available. If OS_STK is set to INT16U, stk_size contains the number of 16-bit entries available. Finally, if OS_STK is set to INT32U, stk_size contains the number of 32-bit entries available on the stack.
Pointer to a user-supplied Task Control Block (TCB) extension.
The lower 8 bits are reserved by µC/OS-II. The upper 8 bits control application-specific options. Select an option by setting the corresponding bit(s).
RETURN VALUE
OS_NO_ERR
OS_PRIO_EXIT
OS_PRIO_INVALID
The call was successful.
Task priority already exists (each task MUST have a unique priority).
The priority specified is higher than the maximum allowed
(i.e.
OS_LOWEST_PRIO).
LIBRARY
UCOS2.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
301
OSTaskCreateHook
void OSTaskCreateHook( OS_TCB * ptcb );
DESCRIPTION
Called by µC/OS-II whenever a task is created. This call-back function resides in
UCOS2.LIB and extends functionality during task creation by allowing additional information to be passed to the kernel, anything associated with a task. This function can also be used to trigger other hardware, such as an oscilloscope. Interrupts are disabled during this call, therefore, it is recommended that code be kept to a minimum.
PARAMETERS ptcb Pointer to the TCB of the task being created.
LIBRARY
UCOS2.LIB
SEE ALSO
302 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
OSTaskDel
INT8U OSTaskDel( INT8U prio );
DESCRIPTION
Deletes a task. The calling task can delete itself by passing either its own priority number or
OS_PRIO_SELF if it doesn’t know its priority number. The deleted task is returned to the dormant state and can be re-activated by creating the deleted task again.
PARAMETERS prio Task’s priority number.
RETURN VALUE
OS_NO_ERR
OS_TASK_DEL_IDLE
OS_PRIO_INVALID
OS_TASK_DEL_ERR
OS_TASK_DEL_ISR
The call was successful.
Attempting to delete µC/OS-II's idle task.
The priority specified is higher than the maximum allowed (i.e.
OS_LOWEST_PRIO ) or, OS_PRIO_SELF not specified.
The task to delete does not exist.
Attempting to delete a task from an ISR.
LIBRARY
UCOS2.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
303
OSTaskDelHook
void OSTaskDelHook( OS_TCB * ptcb );
DESCRIPTION
Called by µC/OS-II whenever a task is deleted. This call-back function resides in
UCOS2.LIB. Interrupts are disabled during this call, therefore, it is recommended that code be kept to a minimum.
PARAMETERS ptcb Pointer to TCB of task being deleted.
LIBRARY
UCOS2.LIB
SEE ALSO
304 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
OSTaskDelReq
INT8U OSTaskDelReq( INT8U prio );
DESCRIPTION
Notifies a task to delete itself. A well-behaved task is deleted when it regains control of the CPU by calling OSTaskDelReq (OSTaskDelReq) and monitoring the return value.
PARAMETERS prio The priority of the task that is being asked to delete itself.
OS_PRIO_SELF is used when asking whether another task wants the current task to be deleted.
RETURN VALUE
OS_NO_ERR
OS_TASK_NOT_EXIST
OS_TASK_DEL_IDLE
OS_PRIO_INVALID
OS_TASK_DEL_REQ
The task exists and the request has been registered.
The task has been deleted. This allows the caller to know whether the request has been executed.
If requesting to delete uC/OS-II's idletask.
The priority specified is higher than the maximum allowed (i.e.
OS_LOWEST_PRIO ) or, OS_PRIO_SELF is not specified.
A task (possibly another task) requested that the running task be deleted.
LIBRARY
UCOS2.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
305
OSTaskIdleHook
void OSTaskIdleHook( void );
DESCRIPTION
This function is called by the idle task. This hook has been added to allow you to do such things as STOP the CPU to conserve power. Interrupts are enabled during this call.
LIBRARY
UCOS2.LIB
OSTaskQuery
INT8U OSTaskQuery( INT8U prio, OS_TCB * pdata );
DESCRIPTION
Obtains a copy of the requested task's task control block (TCB).
PARAMETERS
prio
pdata
RETURN VALUE
OS_NO_ERR
OS_PRIO_INVALID
OS_PRIO_ERR
Priority number of the task.
Pointer to task’s TCB.
The requested task is suspended.
The priority you specify is higher than the maximum allowed (i.e.
OS_LOWEST_PRIO ) or, OS_PRIO_SELF is not specified.
The desired task has not been created.
LIBRARY
UCOS2.LIB
306 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
OSTaskResume
INT8U OSTaskResume( INT8U prio );
DESCRIPTION
Resumes a suspended task. This is the only call that will remove an explicit task suspension.
PARAMETERS prio The priority of the task to resume.
RETURN VALUE
OS_NO_ERR
OS_PRIO_INVALID
The requested task is resumed.
The priority specified is higher than the maximum allowed (i.e.
OS_LOWEST_PRIO ).
OS_TASK_NOT_SUSPENDED The task to resume has not been suspended.
LIBRARY
UCOS2.LIB
SEE ALSO
OSTaskStatHook
void OSTaskStatHook( void );
DESCRIPTION
Called every second by µC/OS-II's statistics task. This function resides in UCOS2.LIB and allows an application to add functionality to the statistics task.
LIBRARY
UCOS2.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
307
OSTaskStkChk
INT8U OSTaskStkChk( INT8U prio, OS_STK_DATA * pdata );
DESCRIPTION
Check the amount of free memory on the stack of the specified task.
PARAMETERS prio pdata
The task’s priority.
Pointer to a data structure of type OS_STK_DATA.
RETURN VALUE
OS_NO_ERR
OS_PRIO_INVALID
OS_TASK_NOT_EXIST
OS_TASK_OPT_ERR
The call was successful.
The priority you specify is higher than the maximum allowed (i.e. >
OS_LOWEST_PRIO ) or, OS_PRIO_SELF not specified.
The desired task has not been created.
If OS_TASK_OPT_STK_CHK was NOT specified when the task was created.
LIBRARY
UCOS2.LIB
SEE ALSO
308 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
OSTaskSuspend
INT8U OSTaskSuspend( INT8U prio );
DESCRIPTION
Suspends a task. The task can be the calling task if the priority passed to OSTaskSuspend() is the priority of the calling task or OS_PRIO_SELF. This function should be used with great care. If a task is suspended that is waiting for an event (i.e., a message, a semaphore, a queue...) the task will be prevented from running when the event arrives.
PARAMETERS prio The priority of the task to suspend.
RETURN VALUE
OS_NO_ERR
OS_TASK_SUS_IDLE
OS_PRIO_INVALID
OS_TASK_SUS_PRIO
The requested task is suspended.
Attempting to suspend the idle task (not allowed).
The priority specified is higher than the maximum allowed (i.e.
OS_LOWEST_PRIO ) or, OS_PRIO_SELF is not specified.
The task to suspend does not exist.
LIBRARY
UCOS2.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
309
OSTaskSwHook
void OSTaskSwHook( void );
DESCRIPTION
Called whenever a context switch happens. The task control block (TCB) for the task that is ready to run is accessed via the global variable OSTCBHighRdy, and the TCB for the task that is being switched out is accessed via the global variable OSTCBCur.
LIBRARY
UCOS2.LIB
OSTCBInitHook
void OSTCBInitHook( OS_TCB * ptcb );
DESCRIPTION
This function is called by OSTCBInit() after setting up most of the task control block (TCB).
Interrupts may or may not be enabled during this call.
PARAMETER ptcb Pointer to the TCB of the task being created.
LIBRARY
UCOS2.LIB
310 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
OSTimeDly
void OSTimeDly( INT16U ticks );
DESCRIPTION
Delays execution of the task for the specified number of clock ticks. No delay will result if ticks is 0. If ticks is >0, then a context switch will result.
PARAMETERS ticks Number of clock ticks to delay the task.
LIBRARY
UCOS2.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
311
OSTimeDlyHMSM
INT8U OSTimeDlyHMSM( INT8U hours, INT8U minutes, INT8U seconds,
INT16U milli );
DESCRIPTION
Delays execution of the task until specified amount of time expires. This call allows the delay to be specified in hours, minutes, seconds and milliseconds instead of ticks. The resolution on the milliseconds depends on the tick rate. For example, a 10 ms delay is not possible if the ticker interrupts every 100 ms. In this case, the delay would be set to 0. The actual delay is rounded to the nearest tick.
PARAMETERS hours minutes seconds milli
Number of hours that the task will be delayed (max. is 255)
Number of minutes (max. 59)
Number of seconds (max. 59)
Number of milliseconds (max. 999)
RETURN VALUE
OS_NO_ERR
OS_TIME_INVALID_MINUTES
OS_TIME_INVALID_SECONDS
OS_TIME_INVALID_MS
Execution delay of task was successful
Minutes parameter out of range
Seconds parameter out of range
Milliseconds parameter out of range
OS_TIME_ZERO_DLY
LIBRARY
OS_TIME.C (Prior to DC 8:ucos2.lib)
SEE ALSO
,
312 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
OSTimeDlyResume
INT8U OSTimeDlyResume( INT8U prio );
DESCRIPTION
Resumes a task that has been delayed through a call to either OSTimeDly() or
OSTimeDlyHMSM() . Note that this function MUST NOT be called to resume a task that is waiting for an event with timeout. This situation would make the task look like a timeout occurred (unless this is the desired effect). Also, a task cannot be resumed that has called
OSTimeDlyHMSM() with a combined time that exceeds 65535 clock ticks. In other words, if the clock tick runs at 100 Hz then, a delayed task will not be able to be resumed that called
OSTimeDlyHMSM(0, 10, 55, 350) or higher.
PARAMETERS prio
RETURN VALUE
OS_NO_ERR
OS_PRIO_INVALID
Priority of the task to resume.
OS_TIME_NOT_DLY
OS_TASK_NOT_EXIST
Task has been resumed.
The priority you specify is higher than the maximum allowed (i.e.
OS_LOWEST_PRIO ).
Task is not waiting for time to expire.
The desired task has not been created.
LIBRARY
UCOS2.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
313
OSTimeDlySec
INT8U OSTimeDlySec( INT16U seconds );
DESCRIPTION
Delays execution of the task until seconds expires. This is a low-overhead version of
OSTimeDlyHMSM for seconds only.
PARAMETERS seconds The number of seconds to delay.
RETURN VALUE
OS_NO_ERR
OS_TIME_ZERO_DLY
The call was successful.
A delay of zero seconds was requested.
LIBRARY
UCOS2.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
314 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
OSTimeGet
INT32U OSTimeGet( void );
DESCRIPTION
Obtain the current value of the 32-bit counter that keeps track of the number of clock ticks.
RETURN VALUE
The current value of OSTime.
LIBRARY
UCOS2.LIB
SEE ALSO
OSTimeSet
void OSTimeSet( INT32U ticks );
DESCRIPTION
Sets the 32-bit counter that keeps track of the number of clock ticks.
PARAMETERS ticks The value to set OSTime to.
LIBRARY
UCOS2.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
315
OSTimeTick
void OSTimeTick( void );
DESCRIPTION
This function takes care of the processing necessary at the occurrence of each system tick. This function is called from the BIOS timer interrupt ISR, but can also be called from a high priority task. The user definable OSTimeTickHook() is called from this function and allows for extra application specific processing to be performed at each tick. Since
OSTimeTickHook() is called during an interrupt, it should perform minimal processing as it will directly affect interrupt latency.
LIBRARY
UCOS2.LIB
SEE ALSO
OSTimeTickHook
void OSTimeTickHook( void );
DESCRIPTION
This function, as included with Dynamic C, is a stub that does nothing except return. It is called every clock tick. Code in this function should be kept to a minimum as it will directly affect interrupt latency. This function must preserve any registers it uses other than the ones that are preserved at the beginning of the periodic interrupt (periodic_isr in VDRIVER.LIB), and therefore should be written in assembly. At the time of this writing, the registers saved by periodic_isr are: AF,IP,HL,DE and IX.
LIBRARY
UCOS2.LIB
SEE ALSO
316 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
OSVersion
INT16U OSVersion( void );
DESCRIPTION
Returns the version number of µC/OS-II. The returned value corresponds to µC/OS-II's version number multiplied by 100; i.e., version 2.00 would be returned as 200.
RETURN VALUE
Version number multiplied by 100.
LIBRARY
UCOS2.LIB
outchrs
char outchrs( char c, int n, int (*putc) () );
DESCRIPTION
Use putc to output n times the character c.
PARAMETERS c n putc
Character to output
Number of times to output
Routine to output one character. The function pointed to by putc should take a character argument.
RETURN VALUE
The character in parameter c.
LIBRARY
STDIO.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
317
outstr
char * outstr( char * string, int (*putc)() );
DESCRIPTION
Output the string pointed to by string via calls to putc. putc should take a one-character parameter.
PARAMETERS string putc
String to output
Routine to output one character. The function pointed to by putc should take a character argument.
RETURN VALUE
Pointer to null at end of string.
LIBRARY
STDIO.LIB
SEE ALSO
318 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
paddr
unsigned long paddr( void * pointer );
DESCRIPTION
Determines the physical address of a logical pointer. This function is compatible with both shared and separate I&D space compile modes. Use caution when converting a pointer in the xmem window, i.e., in the range 0xE000 to 0xFFFF, as this function will return the physical address based on the XPC on entry.
PARAMETERS pointer The pointer to convert.
RETURN VALUE
The physical address of the entity that the pointer is referencing .
LIBRARY
XMEM.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
319
paddrDS
unsigned long paddrDS( void * pointer );
DESCRIPTION
Converts a "Data Segment" logical pointer into its physical address. This function assumes the pointer points to static (excluding bbram) data, which eliminates some runtime testing as compared with the more general function, paddr(). paddrDS() will generate incorrect results if used for:
• addresses in the root code (that is, program code or constants)
• bbram (only available in fast RAM compile mode)
• stack (that is, auto variables)
• xmem segments
PARAMETERS pointer Logical static (non-bbram) data pointer to convert.
RETURN VALUE
The physical address of the pointer.
LIBRARY
XMEM.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
320 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
paddrSS
unsigned long paddrSS( void * pointer );
DESCRIPTION
The paddrSS function is deprecated and has been replaced by a macro redefining it to simply paddr. Refer to the paddr function help for usage information.
PARAMETERS pointer The pointer to convert.
RETURN VALUE
The physical address of the entity that the pointer is referencing.
LIBRARY
XMEM.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
321
palloc
void * palloc( Pool_t * p );
DESCRIPTION
Return next available free element from the given pool. Eventually, your application should return this element to the pool using pfree() to avoid memory leaks.
Assembler code can call palloc_fast() instead.
PARAMETERS p Pool handle structure, as previously passed to pool_init().
RETURN VALUE
Null: No free elements available
Otherwise, pointer to an element
LIBRARY
POOL.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
,
322 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
palloc_fast
xmem void * palloc_fast( Pool_t * p );
DESCRIPTION
Return next available free element from the given pool, which must be a root pool.
This is an assembler-only version of palloc().
*** Do _not_ call this function from C. *** palloc_fast does not perform any IPSET protection, parameter validation, or update the high-water mark. palloc_fast is a root function. The parameter must be passed in IX, and the returned element address is in HL.
REGISTERS
Parameter in IX
Trashes F, BC, DE
Return value in HL, carry flag.
EXAMPLE ld ix,my_pool lcall palloc_fast jr c,.no_free
; HL points to element
PARAMETERS p Pool handle structure, as previously passed to pool_init(). Pass this in IX.
RETURN VALUE
C flag set: no free elements were available.
C flag clear (NC): HL points to an element.
If the pool is not linked, your application can use this element provided it does not write more than p->elsize bytes to it (this was the elsize parameter passed to pool_init()). If the pool is linked, you can write p->elsize-4 bytes to it.
LIBRARY
POOL.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
323
pavail
word pavail( Pool_t * p );
DESCRIPTION
Return the number of elements that are currently available for allocation.
PARAMETERS p Pool handle structure, as previously passed to pool_init()or pool_xinit() .
RETURN VALUE
Number of elements available for allocation.
LIBRARY
POOL.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
324 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
pavail_fast
xmem word pavail_fast( Pool_t * p );
DESCRIPTION
Return the number of elements that are currently available for allocation.
This is an assembler-only version of pavail().
*** Do _not_ call this function from C. ***
REGISTERS
Parameter in IX
Trashes F, DE
Return value in HL, Z flag
EXAMPLE ld ix,my_pool lcall pavail_fast
; HL contains number of available elements
PARAMETERS p Pool handle structure, as previously passed to pool_init()or pool_xinit() . This must be provided in the IX register.
RETURN VALUE
Number of elements available for allocation. The return value is placed in HL. In addition, the
'Z' flag is set if there are no free elements.
LIBRARY
POOL.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
325
pcalloc
void * pcalloc( Pool_t * p );
DESCRIPTION
Return next available free element from the given pool. Eventually, your application should return this element to the pool using pfree() to avoid memory leaks.
The element is set to all zero bytes before returning.
PARAMETERS p Pool handle structure, as previously passed to pool_init().
RETURN VALUE
Null: No free elements were available
Otherwise, pointer to an element. If the pool is not linked, your application must not write more than p->elsize bytes to the element (this was the elsize parameter passed to pool_init() ). The application can write up to (p->elsize-4) bytes to the element if the pool is linked. (An element in root memory has 4 bytes of overhead when the pool is linked.)
LIBRARY
POOL.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
326 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
pfirst
void * pfirst( Pool_t * p );
DESCRIPTION
Get the first allocated element in a root pool. The pool MUST be set to being a linked pool using:
pool_link(p, <non-zero>)
Otherwise, the result is undefined.
PARAMETERS p Pool handle structure, as previously passed to pool_init().
RETURN VALUE
Null: There are no allocated elements
Otherwise, pointer to first (i.e., oldest) allocated element
LIBRARY
POOL.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
,
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
327
pfirst_fast
xmem void * pfirst_fast( Pool_t * p );
DESCRIPTION
Get the first allocated element in a root pool. The pool MUST be set to being a linked pool by using: pool_link(p, <non-zero>);
Otherwise the results are undefined.
This is an assembler-only version of pfirst().
*** Do _not_ call this function from C. ***
REGISTERS
Parameter in IX
Trashes F, DE
Return value in HL, carry flag
EXAMPLE ld ix,my_pool lcall pfirst_fast jr c,.no_elems
; HL points to first element
PARAMETERS p Pool handle structure, as previously passed to pool_init(). Pass this in the IX register.
RETURN VALUE
C flag set, HL=0: There are no allocated elements.
C flag clear (NC): HL points to first element.
LIBRARY
POOL.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
328 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
pfree
void pfree( Pool_t * p, void * e );
DESCRIPTION
Free an element that was obtained via palloc(). Note: if you free an element that was not allocated from this pool, or was already free, or was outside the pool, then your application will crash! You can detect most of these programming errors by defining the following symbols before #use pool.lib:
POOL_DEBUG
POOL_VERBOSE
PARAMETERS p e
Pool handle structure, as previously passed to palloc().
Element to free, which was returned from palloc().
RETURN VALUE
None
LIBRARY
POOL.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
329
pfree_fast
xmem void pfree_fast( Pool_t * p, void * e );
DESCRIPTION
Free an element that was previously obtained via palloc().
This is an assembler-only version of pfree().
*** Do _not_ call this function from C. *** pfree_fast does not perform any IPSET protection or parameter validation. pfree_fast is a xmem function. The parameters must be passed in machine registers.
REGISTERS
Parameters in IX, DE respectively
Trashes BC, DE, HL
EXAMPLE
PARAMETERS p ld ix,my_pool ld de,(element_addr) lcall pfree_fast e
Pool handle structure, as previously passed to pool_alloc()or palloc_fast . This must be in the IX register.
Element to free, which was returned from palloc(). This must be in the
DE register.
RETURN VALUE
None
LIBRARY
POOL.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
330 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
phwm
word phwm( Pool_t * p );
DESCRIPTION
Return the largest number of elements ever simultaneously allocated from the given pool, i.e., the pool high water mark.
You can use this function to help size a pool, since it may be difficult to determine the optimum number of elements without running a trial program.
PARAMETERS p Pool handle structure, as previously passed to pool_init() or pool_xinit() .
RETURN VALUE
Maximum number of elements ever allocated.
LIBRARY
POOL.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
331
pktXclose
void pktXclose( void ); /* X is A-F */
DESCRIPTION
Disables serial port X. The functions pktEclose() and pktFclose() may be used with the Rabbit 3000 and Rabbit 4000.
LIBRARY
PACKET.LIB
pktXgetErrors
char pktXgetErrors( void ); /* X is A-F */
DESCRIPTION
Gets a bit field with flags set for any errors that occurred on port X. These flags are then cleared, so that a particular error will only cause the flag to be set once.
The functions pktEgetErrors() and pktFgetErrors() may be used with the
Rabbit 3000 and Rabbit 4000.
RETURN VALUE
A bit field with flags for various errors. The errors along with their bit masks are as follows:
PKT_BUFFEROVERFLOW 0x01
PKT_RXOVERRUN 0x02
PKT_PARITYERROR
PKT_NOBUFFER
0x04
0x08
LIBRARY
PACKET.LIB
332 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
pktXinitBuffers
int pktXinitBuffers( int buf_count, int buf_size ); /* X is A-F */
DESCRIPTION
Allocates extended memory for channel X receive buffers. This function should not be called more than once in a program. The total memory allocated is buf_count*(buf_size + 2) bytes.
The functions pktEinitBuffers() and pktFinitBuffers() may be used with the
Rabbit 3000 and Rabbit 4000.
PARAMETERS buf_count buf_size
The number of buffers to allocate. Each buffer can store one received packet. Increasing this number allows for more pending packets and a larger latency time before packets must be processed by the user's program.
The number of bytes each buffer can accommodate. This should be set to the size of the largest possible packet that can be expected.
RETURN VALUE
1 : Success, extended memory was allocated.
0 : Failure, no memory allocated, the packet channel cannot be used.
LIBRARY
PACKET.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
333
pktXopen
int pktXopen( long baud, int mode, char options, int (*test_packet)()
); /* X is A-F */
DESCRIPTION
Opens serial port X. The functions pktEopen() and pktFopen() may be used with the
Rabbit 3000 and Rabbit 4000.
The packet driver is meant to be used with a variety of transceiver hardware, so some functions must be defined by the user. Each of these functions, listed below, take no arguments and return nothing.
• pktXinit() - Initializes the communication hardware. Called inside pktXopen(). This function may be written in C. It will only be called once each time the packet driver is opened, so speed is not a major concern. This is where I/O pins should be configured and any other setup should be performed.
• pktXrx() - Sets the hardware to receive data. This function must be written in assembly.
Any registers besides the 8-bit accumulator A must be preserved first, and restored before returning. This function is called when the driver switches from transmit to receive mode once there are no packets to send. This function is necessary for half-duplex connections and other types of shared bus schemes so that the transmitter can be disabled, allowing other nodes to use the lines.
• pktXtx() - Sets the hardware to transmit data. This function must be written in assembly.
The same rules for register usage as for pktXrx() apply. This function is called whenever the driver switches from receive to transmit mode in response to an additional packet or packets being available for sending. A typical use of this function is to enable any necessary transmitter hardware.
See the sample program Samples/PKTDEMO.C for an example of how to write these usersupplied functions. See technical note TN213 “Rabbit Serial Port Software” for more information on the packet driver.
334 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
pktXopen (cont’d)
PARAMETERS baud mode
Bits per second of data transfer: minimum is 2400.
Type of packet scheme used, the options are:
• PKT_GAPMODE
• PKT_9BITMODE
• PKT_CHARMODE options Further specification for the packet scheme. The value of this depends on the mode used:
• gap mode - minimum gap size (in byte times)
• 9-bit mode - type of 9-bit protocol
• PKT_RABBITSTARTBYTE
• PKT_LOWSTARTBYTE
• PKT_HIGHSTARTBYTE
• char mode - character marking start of packet test_packet Pointer to a function that tests for completeness of a packet. The function should return 1 if the packet is complete, or 0 if more data should be read in. For gap mode the test function is not used and should be set to null.
RETURN VALUE
1 : The Rabbit’s bps setting is within 5% of the input baud.
0 : The Rabbit’s bps setting differs by more than 5% of the input baud
LIBRARY
PACKET.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
335
pktXreceive
int pktXreceive( void * buffer, int buffer_size ); /* X is A-F */
DESCRIPTION
Gets a received packet, if there is one, from serial port X.
The functions pktEreceive() and pktFreceive() may be used with the Rabbit 3000 and Rabbit 4000.
PARAMETERS buffer A buffer for the packet to be written into.
buffer_size Length of the data buffer.
RETURN VALUE
>0 : Number of bytes in the successfully received packet.
0 : No new packet has been received.
-1 : The packet is too large for the given buffer.
-2 : A needed test_packet function is not defined.
LIBRARY
PACKET.LIB
336 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
pktXsend
int pktXsend( void *send_buffer, int buffer_length, char delay );
/* X is A-F */
DESCRIPTION
Initiates the sending of a packet of data using serial port X. This function will always return immediately. If there is already a packet being transmitted, this call will return 0 and the packet will not be transmitted, otherwise it will return 1. pktXsending() checks if the packet is done transmitting. The system will be using the buffer until then.
The functions pktEsend() and pktFsend() may be used with the Rabbit 3000 and
Rabbit 4000.
PARAMETERS send_buffer The data to be sent buffer_length Length of the data buffer to transmit delay The number of byte times to delay before sending the data (0-255) This is used to implement protocol-specific delays between packets
RETURN VALUE
1 : The packet is going to be transmitted.
0 : There is already a packet transmitting, and the new packet was refused.
LIBRARY
PACKET.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
337
pktXsending
int pktXsending( void ); /* X is A-F */
DESCRIPTION
Tests if a packet is currently being sent on serial port X. If pktXsending() returns true, the transmitter is busy and cannot accept another packet.
The functions pktEsending() and pktFsending() may be used with the Rabbit 3000 and Rabbit 4000.
RETURN VALUE
1 : A packet is being transmitted.
0 : Port X is idle, ready for a new packet.
LIBRARY
PACKET.LIB
pktXsetParity
void pktXsetParity( char mode ); /* X is A-F */
DESCRIPTION
Configures parity generation and checking. Can also configure for 2 stop bits.
The functions pktEsetParity() and pktFsetParity() may be used with the
Rabbit 3000 and Rabbit 4000.
PARAMETERS mode Code for mode of parity bit:
• PKT_NOPARITY - no parity bit (8N1 format, default)
• PKT_OPARITY - odd parity (8O1 format)
• PKT_EPARITY - even parity (8E1 format)
• PKT_TWOSTOP - an extra stop bit (8N2 format)
LIBRARY
PACKET.LIB
338 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
plast
void * plast( Pool_t * p );
DESCRIPTION
Get the last allocated element in a root pool. The pool MUST be set to being a linked pool using pool_link(p, <non-zero>) ; otherwise, the results are undefined.
PARAMETERS p Pool handle structure, as previously passed to pool_init().
RETURN VALUE null : There are no allocated elements
!null
: Pointer to last, i.e., youngest, allocated element
LIBRARY
POOL.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
339
plast_fast
xmem void * plast_fast( Pool_t * p );
DESCRIPTION
Get the last allocated element in a root pool. The pool MUST be set to being a linked pool using pool_link(p, <non-zero>); otherwise, the results are undefined.
This is an assembler-only version of plast().
*** Do _not_ call this function from C. ***
Registers
Parameter in IX
Trashes F, DE
Return value in HL, carry flag
Example ld ix,my_pool lcall plast_fast jr c,.no_elems
; HL points to last element
PARAMETERS p Pool handle structure, as previously passed to pool_init(). Pass this in IX register.
RETURN VALUE
C flag set, HL=0: there are no allocated elements
C flag clear (NC): HL points to last element.
LIBRARY
POOL.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
340 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
pmovebetween
void * pmovebetween( Pool_t * p, void * e, void * d, void * f );
DESCRIPTION
Atomically remove allocated element “e” and re-insert it between allocated elements “d” and
“f.” “Atomically” means that the POOL_IPSET level is used to lock out other CPU contexts from altering the pool while this operation is in progress. In addition, “d” and “f” are checked to ensure that the following conditions still hold: pprev(p, f) == d and pnext(p, d) == f in other words, “f” follows “d.” This is useful since your application may have determined “d” and “f” some time ago, but in the meantime some other task may have re-ordered the queue or deleted these elements. In this case, the return value will be null. Your application should then re-evaluate the appropriate queue elements and retry this function.
The pool MUST be set to being a linked pool by using: pool_link(p, <non-zero>)
Otherwise the results are undefined.
PARAMETERS p e d
Pool handle structure, as previously passed to pool_init().
Address of element to move, obtained by, e.g., plast(). This must be an allocated element in the given pool; otherwise, the results are undefined. If null, then the last element is implied (i.e., whatever plast() would return). If there are no elements at all, or this parameter does not point to a valid allocated element, then the results are undefined (and probably catastrophic).
If e == d or e == f, then there is no action except to check whether
“f” follows “d.” This parameter may refer to an unlinked (but allocated) element.
First reference element. The element “e” will be inserted after this element.
On entry, it must be true that pnext(p, d) == f. Otherwise, null is returned. If this parameter is null, then “f” must point to the first element in the list, and “e” is inserted at the start of the list.
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
341
pmovebetween (cont’d)
f Second reference element. The element “e” will be inserted before this element. On entry, it must be true that pprev(p, f) == d. Otherwise, null is returned. If this parameter is null, then “d” must point to the last element in the list, and “e” is inserted at the end of the list.
Note: If both “d” and “f” are null, then it must be true that there are no allocated elements in the linked list, and the element “e” is added as the only element in the list. This proviso only obtains when the element “e” is initially allocated from an empty pool with: pool_link(p, POOL_LINKED_BY_APP)
The allocated element is not in the linked list of allocated elements.
RETURN VALUE
Returns the parameter value “e,” unless “e” was null; in which case the value of plast(), if called at function entry, would be returned. If the initial conditions for “d” and “f” do not hold, then null is returned with no further action.
EXAMPLES void * d, * e, * f; e = plast(p); f = pnext(p, d = pfirst(p)); pmovebetween(p, e, d, f);
//
// element to move d, f are first 2 elements
LIBRARY
POOL.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
,
,
,
342 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
pmovebetween_fast
void * pmovebetween_fast( Pool_t *p, void *e, void *d, void *f );
DESCRIPTION
See description under pmovebetween(). This is an assembler- callable version (do not call from C). It does not issue IPSET protection or check parameters.
REGISTERS: Parameters in IX, DE, BC, HL respectively
Trashes AF, BC, DE, BC', DE', HL'
Return value in HL, carry flag.
PARAMETERS p e d f
Pool handle structure, as previously passed to pool_init(). Pass in IX register
Address of element to move. Pass in DE register.
The first reference element. Pass in BC register.
The second reference element. Pass in HL register.
RETURN VALUE
In HL. Either set to “e” parameter, or 0. The carry flag is set if HL==0; otherwise it is clear.
LIBRARY
POOL.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
343
pnel
word pnel( Pool_t * p );
DESCRIPTION
Return the number of elements that are in the pool, both free and used. This includes elements appended using pool_append() etc.
PARAMETERS p Pool handle structure, as previously passed to pool_init() or pool_xinit() .
RETURN VALUE
Number of elements total
LIBRARY
POOL.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
344 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
pnext
void * pnext( Pool_t * p, void * e );
DESCRIPTION
Get the next allocated element in a root pool. The pool MUST be set to being a linked pool using pool_link(p, <non-zero>) ; otherwise, the results are undefined.
You can easily iterate through all of the allocated elements of a root pool using the following construct: void * e;
Pool_t * p; for (e = pfirst(p); e; e = pnext(p, e)) {
...
}
PARAMETERS p e
Pool handle structure, as previously passed to pool_init().
Previous element address, obtained by, e.g., pfirst(). This must be an allocated element in the given pool; otherwise, the results are undefined.
Be careful when iterating through a list and deleting elements using pfree() : once the element is deleted, it is no longer valid to pass its address to this function.
If this parameter is null, then the result is the same as pfirst(). This ensures the invariant pnext(p, pprev(p, e)) == e.
RETURN VALUE null : There are no more elements
!null
: Pointer to next allocated element
LIBRARY
POOL.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
345
pnext_fast
xmem void * pnext_fast( Pool_t * p, void * e );
DESCRIPTION
Get the next allocated element in a root pool. The pool MUST be set to being a linked pool using pool_link(p, <non-zero>) ; otherwise, the results are undefined.
This is an assembler-only version of pnext().
*** Do _not_ call this function from C. ***
Registers
Parameters in IX, DE respectively
Trashes F, DE
Return value in HL, carry flag
Example ld ix,my_pool ld de,(current_element) lcall pnext_fast jr c,.no_more_elems
; HL points to the next allocated element
PARAMETERS p e
Pool handle structure, as previously passed to pool_init(). Pass this in IX register.
Current element, address in DE register. See pnext() for a full description.
RETURN VALUE
C flag set, HL=0: There are no more elements
C flag clear (NC): HL points to next element
LIBRARY
POOL.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
,
,
346 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
poly
float poly( float x, int n, float c[] );
DESCRIPTION
Computes polynomial value by Horner's method. For example, for the fourth-order polynomial
10x
4
– 3x
2
+ 4x + 6 , n would be 4 and the coefficients would be c[4] = 10.0
c[3] = 0.0
c[2] = –3.0
c[1] = 4.0
c[0] = 6.0
PARAMETERS x n c
RETURN VALUE
The polynomial value.
LIBRARY
MATH.LIB
Variable of the polynomial.
The order of the polynomial
Array containing the coefficients of each power of x.
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
347
pool_append
int pool_append( Pool_t * p, void * base, word nel );
DESCRIPTION
Add another root memory area to an existing pool. It is assumed that the element size is the same as the element size of the existing pool.
The data area does not have to be contiguous with the existing data area, but it must be nel*elsize bytes long (where elsize is the element size of the existing pool, and nel is the parameter to this function).
The total pool size must obey the constraints documented with pool_init().
PARAMETERS p base nel
Pool handle structure, as previously passed to pool_init().
Base address of the root data memory area to append to this pool. This must be nel*elsize bytes long. Typically, this would be a static (global) array.
Number of elements in the memory area.The sum of nel and the current number of elements must not exceed 32767.
RETURN VALUE
Currently always zero. If you define the macro POOL_DEBUG, then parameters are checked. If the parameters look bad, then an exception is raised. You can define POOL_VERBOSE to get printf() messages.
LIBRARY
POOL.LIB
SEE ALSO
348 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
pool_init
int pool_init( Pool_t * p, void * base, word nel, word elsize );
DESCRIPTION
Initialize a root memory pool. A pool is a linked list of fixed-size blocks taken from a contiguous area. You can use pools instead of malloc() when fixed-size blocks are all that is needed.
You can have several pools, with different size blocks. Using memory pools is very efficient compared with more general functions like malloc(). (There is currently no malloc() implementation with Dynamic C.)
This function should only be called once, at program startup time, for each pool to be used.
Note: the product of nel and elsize must be less than 65535 (however, this will usually be limited further by the actual amount of root memory available).
After calling this function, your application must not change any of the fields in the Pool_t structure.
PARAMETERS p base nel elsize
Pool handle structure. This is allocated by the caller, but this function will initialize it. Normally, this would be allocated in static memory by declaring a global variable of type Pool_t.
Base address of the root data memory area to be managed in this pool. This must be nel*elsize bytes long. Typically, this would be a static (global) array.
Number of elements in the memory area. 1..32767
Size of each element in the memory area. 2..32767
RETURN VALUE
Currently always zero. If you define the macro POOL_DEBUG, then parameters are checked. If the parameters look bad, then an exception is raised. You can define POOL_VERBOSE to get printf() messages.
LIBRARY
POOL.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
349
pool_link
int pool_link( Pool_t * p, int link );
DESCRIPTION
Tell the specified pool to maintain a doubly-linked list of allocated elements.
This function should only be called when the pool is completely free; i.e.,
pavail() == pnel()
PARAMETERS p link
Pool handle structure, as previously passed to pool_init() or pool_xinit() .
Must be one of the following:
• POOL_NOT_LINKED (0): the pool is not to be linked.
• POOL_LINKED_AUTO (1): the pool is linked, and newly allocated elements are always added at the end of the list.
• POOL_LINKED_BY_APP (2): the pool is linked, but newly allocated elements are not added to the list. The application must call preorder() or pmovebetween() to insert the element. This option is only available for root pools.
WARNING: if you set the POOL_LINKED_BY_APP option, then the allocated element must NOT be passed to any other pool API function except for pfree(), preorder() (as the “e” parameter) or pmovebetween() (as the “e” parameter). After calling preorder() or pmovebetween(), then it is safe to pass this element to all appropriate functions.
RETURN VALUE
Currently always zero. If you define the macro POOL_DEBUG, then parameters are checked. If the parameters look bad, then an exception is raised. You can define POOL_VERBOSE to get printf() messages.
LIBRARY
POOL.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
350 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
pool_xappend
int pool_xappend( Pool_t * p, long base, word nel );
DESCRIPTION
Add another xmem memory area to an existing pool. It is assumed that the element size is the same as the element size of the existing pool.
The data area does not have to be contiguous with the existing data area, but it must be nel*elsize bytes long (where elsize is the element size of the existing pool, and nel is the parameter to this function).
The total pool size must obey the constraints documented with pool_xinit().
PARAMETERS p base nel
Pool handle structure, as previously passed to pool_xinit().
Base address of the xmem data memory area to append to this pool. This must be nel*elsize bytes long. Typically, this would be an area allocated using xalloc().
Number of elements in the memory area. 1..65534. The sum of this and the current number of elements must not exceed 65535.
RETURN VALUE
Currently always zero. If you define the macro POOL_DEBUG, then parameters are checked. If the parameters look bad, then an exception is raised. You can define POOL_VERBOSE to get printf() messages.
LIBRARY
POOL.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
351
pool_xinit
int pool_xinit( Pool_t * p, long base, word nel, word elsize );
DESCRIPTION
Initialize an xmem memory pool. A pool is a linked list of fixed-size blocks taken from a contiguous area. You can use pools instead of malloc() when fixed-size blocks are all that is needed.
You can have several pools, with different size blocks. Using memory pools is very efficient compared with more general functions like malloc(). (There is currently no malloc() implementation with Dynamic C.)
This function should only be called once, at program startup time, for each pool to be used.
After calling this function, your application must not change any of the fields in the Pool_t structure.
PARAMETERS p base nel elsize
Pool handle structure. This is allocated by the caller, but this function will initialize it. Normally, this would be allocated in static memory by declaring a global variable of type Pool_t.
Base address of the xmem data memory area to be managed in this pool.
This must be nel*elsize bytes long. Typically, this would be an area allocated by xalloc() when your program starts.
Number of elements in the memory area. 1..65535
Size of each element in the memory area. 4..65535
RETURN VALUE
Currently always zero. If you define the macro POOL_DEBUG, then parameters are checked. If the parameters look bad, then an exception is raised. You can define POOL_VERBOSE to get printf() messages.
LIBRARY
POOL.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
,
,
,
352 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
float pow( float x, float y );
DESCRIPTION
Raises x to the yth power.
PARAMETERS x y
Value to be raised
Exponent
RETURN VALUE x to the yth power
LIBRARY
MATH.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
pow pow10
float pow10( float x );
DESCRIPTION
10 to the power of x.
PARAMETERS x
RETURN VALUE
10 raised to power x
Exponent
LIBRARY
MATH.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
353
powerspectrum
void powerspectrum( int * x, int N, * int blockexp );
DESCRIPTION
Computes the power spectrum from a complex spectrum according to
Power[k] = (Re X[k])
2
+ (Im X[k])
2
The N-point power spectrum replaces the N-point complex spectrum. The power of each complex spectral component is computed as a 32-bit fraction. Its more significant 16-bits replace the imaginary part of the component; its less significant 16-bits replace the real part.
If the complex input spectrum is a positive-frequency spectrum computed by fftreal(), the imaginary part of the X[0] term (stored x[1]) will contain the real part of the fmax term and will affect the calculation of the dc power. If the dc power or the fmax power is important, the
fmax term should be retrieved from x[1] and x[1] set to zero before calling powerspectrum() .
The power of the k th term can be retrieved via
P[k]=*(long*)&x[2k]*2^blockexp .
The value of blockexp is first doubled to reflect the squaring operation applied to all elements in array x. Then it is further increased by 1 to reflect an inherent division by two that occurs during the squaring operation.
PARAMETERS x
N blockexp
Pointer to N-element array of complex fractions.
Number of complex elements in array x.
Pointer to integer block exponent.
LIBRARY
FFT.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
,
354 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
pprev
void * pprev( Pool_t * p, void * e );
DESCRIPTION
Get the previously allocated element in a root pool. The pool MUST be set to being a linked pool using pool_link(p, <non-zero>); otherwise, the results are undefined.
You can easily iterate through all of the allocated elements of a root pool using the following construct: void * e;
Pool_t * p;
PARAMETERS p e for (e = plast(p); e; e = pprev(p, e)) {
...
}
Pool handle structure, as previously passed to pool_init().
Previous element address, obtained by, e.g., plast(). This must be an allocated element in the given pool; otherwise, the results are undefined. Be careful when iterating through a list and deleting elements using pfree() : once the element is deleted, it is no longer valid to pass its address to this function. If this parameter is null, then the result is the same as plast(). This ensures the invariant pprev(p, pnext(p, e)) == e
RETURN VALUE null : There are no more elements
!null
: Pointer to previous allocated element
LIBRARY
POOL.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
355
pprev_fast
xmem void * pprev_fast( Pool_t * p, void * e );
DESCRIPTION
Get the previous allocated element in a root pool. The pool MUST be set to being a linked pool by using pool_link(p, <non-zero>); otherwise, the results are undefined.
This is an assembler-only version of pprev().
*** Do _not_ call this function from C. ***
Registers
Parameters in IX, DE respectively
Trashes F, DE
Return value in HL, carry flag
Example ld ix,my_pool ld de,(current_element) lcall pprev_fast jr c,.no_more_elems
; HL points to previously allocated element
PARAMETERS p e
Pool handle structure, as previously passed to pool_init(). Pass this in IX register.
Current element, address in DE register. See pprev() for fuller description.
RETURN VALUE
C flag set, HL=0: There are no more elements
C flag clear (NC): HL points to previous element
LIBRARY
POOL.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
356 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
pputlast
void * pputlast(Pool_t * p, void * e);
DESCRIPTION
Atomically remove allocated element “e” and re-insert it at the end of the allocated list. “Atomically” means that the POOL_IPSET level is used to lock out other CPU contexts from altering the pool while this operation is in progress.
This is equivalent to: pmovebetween(p, e, plast(p), NULL); but is considerably faster.
A common use for this function is to insert an element allocated when the
POOL_LINKED_BY_APP attribute is set for the pool, at the end of the allocated list. This is useful when, say, an ISR allocates and uses a buffer without placing it on the allocated list. Only when the buffer is complete does the ISR use this function to place it on the queue for reading by the main application.
The pool MUST be set to being a linked pool by using: pool_link(p, <non-zero>); otherwise the results are undefined.
PARAMETERS p e
Pointer to pool handle structure, as previously passed to pool_init().
Address of element to move. If NULL, then this function behaves as plast() .
RETURN VALUE
Same as the “e” parameter, unless “e” is NULL in which case the existing last element is returned as per plast().
LIBRARY
POOL.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
357
pputlast_fast
void * pputlast_fast(Pool_t * p, void * e);
DESCRIPTION
See description under pputlast(). This is an assembler-callable version (do not call from
C). It does not issue IPSET protection or check parameters.
Registers:
Parameters in IX (“p”) and DE (“e”)
Trashes F, DE, BC
Return value in HL
PARAMETERS p e
Pointer to pool handle structure, as previously passed to pool_init().
Pass in IX register
Address of element to move. Pass in DE register. If NULL, then this function behaves as plast_fast().
RETURN VALUE
In HL. Same as the “e” parameter, unless “e” is NULL in which case the existing last element is returned as per plast_fast().
LIBRARY
POOL.LIB
SEE ALSO
premain
void premain( void );
DESCRIPTION
Dynamic C calls premain to start initialization functions such as VdInit. The final thing premain does is call main. This function should never be called by an application program.
It is included here for informational purposes only.
LIBRARY
PROGRAM.LIB
358 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
preorder
void * preorder( Pool_t *p, void *e, void *where, word options );
DESCRIPTION
Atomically remove allocated element “e” and re-insert it before or after element “where.”
“Atomically” means that the POOL_IPSET level is used to lock out other CPU contexts from altering the pool while this operation is in progress.
The pool MUST be set to being a linked pool by using: pool_link(p, <non-zero>)
Otherwise the results are undefined.
PARAMETERS p e where options
Pool handle structure, as previously passed to pool_init().
Address of element to move, obtained by e.g., plast(). This must be an allocated element in the given pool; otherwise, the results are undefined. If null, then the last element is implied (i.e., whatever plast() would return). If there are no elements at all, or this parameter does not point to a valid allocated element, then the results are undefined (and probably catastrophic).
The reference element. The element “e” will be inserted before or after this element, depending on the options parameter. If e==where, then there is no action. If this parameter is null, then the reference element is assumed to be the first element (i.e., whatever pfirst() would return). If there are no elements at all, or this parameter does not point to a valid allocated element, then the results are undefined (and probably catastrophic).
Option flags. Currently, the only options are:
POOL_INSERT_BEFORE
POOL_INSERT_AFTER which specifies whether “e” is to be inserted before or after “where.”
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
359
preorder (cont’d)
RETURN VALUE
Returns the parameter value “e” unless “e” was null, in which case the value of plast(), when called at function entry, would be returned.
IMPORTANT: If null is returned, that means that some other task (context, or
ISR) modified the linked list while this operation was in progress. In this case, the application should call this function again with the same parameters, since this operation will NOT have completed. This would be a rare occurrence; however, multitasking applications should handle this case correctly.
EXAMPLES void * r; void * s; s = pnext(p, pfirst(p); r = plast(p);
// s is second element
// r is last element preorder(p, s, r, POOL_INSERT_AFTER);
// If s != r, then s will become the new last element. You can use null
// parameters to perform the common case of moving the last element
// to the head of the list: preorder(p, NULL, NULL, POOL_INSERT_BEFORE);
// which is identical to:.
preorder(p, plast(p), pfirst(p), POOL_INSERT_BEFORE);
LIBRARY
POOL.LIB
SEE ALSO
360 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
printf
int printf( char *fmt, ... );
DESCRIPTION
This function is similar to sprintf(), but outputs the formatted string to the Stdio window.
Prior to Dynamic C 7.25, printf() would work only with the controller in program mode connected to a PC running Dynamic C. As of Dynamic C 7.25, it is possible to redirect printf() output to a serial port during run mode by defining a macro to specify the serial port. See the sample program SAMPLES/STDIO_SERIAL.C for more information.
See below for the complete list of Dynamic C Conversion Specifiers
.
The user should make sure that:
• there are enough arguments after fmt to fill in the format parameters in the format string
• the types of arguments after fmt match the conversion specifiers in fmt
The macro STDIO_DISABLE_FLOATS can be defined if it is not necessary to format floating point numbers. If this macro is defined, %e, %f and %g will not be recognized. This can save thousands of bytes of code space.
The macro STDIO_ENABLE_LONG_STRINGS can be defined if it is necessary to print strings to the Stdio window that are longer than the default of 127 bytes. Without defining this macro, such strings are truncated. The drawback of defining this macro is that if it is defined in a multi-tasking application where more than one task is utilizing printf and at least one of the tasks is printing strings longer than 127 bytes, the user must ensure that calls to printf are serialized via a semaphore or similar means. If calls to printf are not serialized under these conditions, printf output from the different tasks may be interleaved in the Stdio window.
Note: this function is task reentrant and it has a 128 byte buffer .
PARAMETERS fmt
...
String to be formatted.
Format arguments.
RETURN VALUE
Number of characters written
LIBRARY
STDIO.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
361
printf (cont’d)
DYNAMIC C CONVERSION SPECIFIERS
%ls - null terminated string in xmem
%g - floating point , same as %f or %e depending upon value and precision
%x - hexadecimal , result in lowercase
, same as %x but result in uppercase
%s - string
The precision specifier (the number between “%” and “s”) determines the maximum number of characters to display.
362
As shown in the screenshot above, a value to the right of “.” causes the string to be displayed with that number of characters, ignoring extra characters. A value by itself or to the left of “.” causes padding. Negative values cause the string to be left justified, with spaces added to the right if necessary. Positive values cause the string to be right justified, with spaces added to the left if necessary.
rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
printf (cont’d)
%ls - null terminated string in xmem
This conversion specifier is identical to “%s” but the strings come from extended memory instead of root memory.
xdata mystring {“Now is the time.”}; printf(“%ls”, mystring); // Now is the time.
%d - signed decimal
Width specifier l: short values must not include l; without l, long values are treated as short
Precision specifier n: includes '-' and if necessary treats argument as signed short n; n = 30000; printf("%d", n); printf("%5d", n); printf("%6d", n); printf("%4d", n); unsigned short n; n = 40000;
// 30000
// 30000
// 30000
// **** printf("%d", n); printf("%6d", n); printf("%7d", n); printf("%5d", n); long n; n = 300000; printf("%ld", n); printf("%7ld", n);
// -25536
// -25536
// -25536
// *****
// 300000
// 300000
%u - unsigned decimal
Width specifier l: long values must include l, short values must not:
Precision specifier n: includes '-' if necessary treats argument as if it were unsigned short n; n = -25536; printf("%u", n); // 40000 unsigned short n; n = 40000; printf("%d", n); // 40000
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
363
364
printf (cont’d)
%f - float
Width specifier l is ignored for Dynamic C float and double (both 4 bytes)
Precision specifier n.d: n is the total width including '-' and '.' ; if n is zero or is omitted, it is ignored and only d is used.
float f; f = -88.8888; printf("%f", f); printf("%10f", f); printf("%9f", f); printf("%.0f", f); printf("%.3f", f); printf("%.0f", f); printf("%0.3f", f); printf("%7.3f", f); printf("%8.3f", f); printf("%6.3f", f);
// -88.888801
// -88.888801
// *********
// -89
// -88.889
// -88.889
// -88.889
// -88.889
// -88.889
// ******
%e - exponential
Width specifier l is ignored for Dynamic C float and double (both 4 bytes)
Precision specifier n.d: n is the total width excluding exponent sign; if n is zero or is omitted, it is ignored and only d is used; if n larger than width, the result is not padded. d is decimal places of n.nnn..E[+/-]nn format float f; f = -88.8888; printf("%e\n", f); printf("%13e\n", f); printf("%12e\n", f); printf("%.0e\n", f); printf("%.1e\n", f); printf("%.3e\n", f); printf("%0.3e\n", f); printf("%9.3e\n", f); printf("%15.3e\n", f); printf("%8.3e\n", f); printf("%8.3e\n", -f);
// -8.888880E+01
// -8.888880E+01
// -8.888880E+01
// -9E+01
// -8.9E+01
// -8.889E+01
// -8.889E+01
// -8.889E+01
// -8.889E+01
// ********
// 8.889E+01 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
printf (cont’d)
%g - floating point
(Same as %f or %e depending upon value and precision.) float f, g, h; f = -888.8888; g = 888888.0
g = 8888880.0
printf("%g\n", g); printf("%g\n", h); printf("%g\n", f); printf("%13g\n", f); printf("%12g\n", f); printf("%.0g\n", f); printf("%.1g\n", f); printf("%.2g\n", f); printf("%.3g\n", f); printf("%7.3g\n", f); printf("%0.3g\n", f); printf("%9.3g\n", f); printf("%15.3g\n", f); printf("%8.3g\n", f); printf("%8.3g\n", -f);
// 888888.0
// 8.888880E+06
//-888.888790
// -888.888790
// -888.888790
// -8.9E+02
// -8.9E+02
// -8.89E+02
// -888.889
// *******
// -888.889
// -888.889
// -888.889
// -888.889
// 888.889
%p - pointer
Specifies a 16-bit logical pointer.
int i, *iptr; i = 0; ptr = &i; printf("%p\n",ptr); // prints value of ptr in hex.
// logical memory location of i
%lp - pointer
Specifies a 32-bit physical pointer.
long i, *iptr; i = 0; ptr = &i; printf("%lp\n",ptr);
Dynamic C Functions
// prints value of ptr in hex.
// physical memory location of i rabbit.com
365
printf (cont’d)
%x - hexadecimal
Result in lowercase
Width specifier l: short values must not include l; without l, long values are treated as short
Precision specifier n: must be at least as large as total width; treats argument as if it were unsigned short n; n = 30000; printf("%x", n); printf("%5x", n); printf("%6x", n); printf("%3x", n); unsigned short n; n = 40000; printf("%x", n);
//7530
// 7530
// 7530
// ***
// 9c40 long m, n; m = -25536; n = 0x10000 + 0xabc; printf("%x\n", m); printf("%x\n", z);
// 9c40
// abc
%X - hexadecimal
Same as %x except the result is in uppercase.
%c - single character
Precision specifier n is ignored for %c; treats argument as if it were char long n; n = 0x10000 + 0x100 + 'A'; printf("%0c", n); // A short n; n = 0x100 + 'A'; printf("%0c", n); char n; n = 'A'; printf("%0c", n);
// A
// A
366
Not supported:
%o - octal
%E - same as %e, result uppercase (the result is always in uppercase in Dynamic C)
%G - same as %g, result uppercase (the result is always in uppercase in Dynamic C) rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
putchar
void putchar( int ch );
DESCRIPTION
Puts a single character to Stdout. The user should make sure only one process calls this function at a time.
PARAMETERS ch Character to be displayed.
LIBRARY
STDIO.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
puts
int puts( char * s );
DESCRIPTION
This function displays the string on the stdio window in Dynamic C. The Stdio window is responsible for interpreting any escape code sequences contained in the string. Only one process at a time should call this function.
PARAMETERS s Pointer to string argument to be displayed.
RETURN VALUE
1 : Success.
LIBRARY
STDIO.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
367
pwm_init
unsigned long pwm_init( unsigned long frequency );
DESCRIPTION
Sets the base frequency for the pulse width modulation (PWM) and enables the PWM driver on all four channels. The base frequency is the frequency without pulse spreading. Pulse spreading
(see pwm_set()) will increase the frequency by a factor of 4.
This function is intended for use with the Rabbit 3000 and Rabbit 4000.
PARAMETER frequency Requested frequency (in Hz)
RETURN VALUE
The actual frequency that was set. This will be the closest possible match to the requested frequency.
LIBRARY
PWM.LIB (was in R3000.LIB prior to DC 10)
368 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
pwm_set
int pwm_set( int channel, int duty_cycle, int options );
DESCRIPTION
Sets a duty cycle for one of the pulse width modulation (PWM) channels. The duty cycle can be a value from 0 to 1024, where 0 is logic low the whole time, and 1024 is logic high the whole time. Option flags are used to enable features on an individual PWM channel. Bit masks for these are:
• PWM_SPREAD - sets pulse spreading. The duty cycle is spread over four separate pulses to increase the pulse frequency.
• PWM_OPENDRAIN - sets the PWM output pin to be open-drain instead of a normal push-pull logic output.
This function is intended for use with the Rabbit 3000 and Rabbit 4000.
PARAMETERS channel duty_cycle options
channel(0 to 3) value from 0 to 1024 combination of optional flags (see above)
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success.
-1 : Error, an invalid channel number is used.
-2 : Error, requested duty_cycle is invalid.
LIBRARY
PWM.LIB (was in R3000.LIB prior to DC 10)
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
369
pxalloc
long pxalloc( Pool_t * p );
DESCRIPTION
Return next available free element from the given pool. Eventually, your application should return this element to the pool using pfree() to avoid memory leaks.
PARAMETERS p Pool handle structure, as previously passed to pool_xinit().
RETURN VALUE
0 : No free elements are available.
!0
: Physical (xmem address) of an element. If the pool is not linked, your application can use this element provided it does not write more than p->elsize bytes to it (this was the elsize parameter passed to pool_xinit()). If the pool is linked, you can write up to
(p->elsize-8) bytes to it. (Each element has 8 bytes of overhead when the pool is linked.)
LIBRARY
POOL.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
370 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
pxalloc_fast
xmem long pxalloc_fast( Pool_t * p );
DESCRIPTION
Return next available free element from the given pool. Eventually, your application should return this element to the pool using pxfree() to avoid memory leaks.
This is an assembler-only version of pxalloc().
*** Do _not_ call this function from C. *** pxalloc_fast does not perform any IPSET protection, parameter validation, or update the high-water mark. pxalloc_fast is a root function. The parameter must be passed in IX, and the returned element address is in BCDE.
REGISTERS
Parameter in IX
Trashes AF, HL
Return value in BCDE, carry flag.
EXAMPLE
PARAMETERS p ld ix,my_pool lcall pxalloc_fast jr c,.no_free
; BCDE points to element
Pool handle structure, as previously passed to pool_init() Pass this in the IX register.
RETURN VALUE
C flag set: No free elements are available. (BCDE is undefined in this case.)
NC flag: BCDE points to an element If the pool is not linked, your application must not write more than p->elsize bytes to it (this was the elsize parameter passed to pool_xinit() ). If the pool is linked, you can write (p->elsize-8) bytes to it. (An element has 8 bytes of overhead when the pool is linked.)
LIBRARY
POOL.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
371
pxcalloc
long pxcalloc( Pool_t * p );
DESCRIPTION
Return next available free element from the given pool. Eventually, your application should return this element to the pool using pxfree() to avoid memory leaks.
The element is set to all zero bytes before returning.
PARAMETERS p Pool handle structure, as previously passed to pool_xinit().
RETURN VALUE
0 : No free elements are available.
!0
: Physical (xmem address) of an element. If the pool is not linked, your application must not write more than p->elsize bytes to it (this was the elsize parameter passed to pool_xinit() ). The application can write up to (p->elsize-8) bytes to the element if the pool is linked. (An element has 8 bytes of overhead when the pool is linked.)
LIBRARY
POOL.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
,
372 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
pxfirst
long pxfirst( Pool_t * p );
DESCRIPTION
Get the first allocated element in an xmem pool. The pool MUST be set to being a linked pool using pool_link(p, <non-zero>); otherwise, the results are undefined.
PARAMETERS p Pool handle structure, as previously passed to pool_xinit().
RETURN VALUE
0 : There are no allocated elements
!0
: Pointer to first, i.e., oldest, allocated element.
LIBRARY
POOL.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
373
pxfirst_fast
xmem long pxfirst_fast( Pool_t * p );
DESCRIPTION
Get the first allocated element in an xmem pool. The pool MUST be set to being a linked pool using pool_link(p, <non-zero>); otherwise, the results are undefined.
This is an assembler-only version of pxfirst().
*** Do _not_ call this function from C. ***
Registers
Parameter in IX
Trashes F, HL
Return value in BCDE, carry flag
Example ld ix,my_pool lcall pxfirst_fast jr c,.no_elems
; BCDE points to first element
PARAMETERS p Pool handle structure, as previously passed to pool_init(). Pass this in IX register.
RETURN VALUE
C flag set: There are no allocated elements
C flag clear (NC): BCDE points to first element
LIBRARY
POOL.LIB
SEE ALSO
374 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
pxfree
void pxfree( Pool_t * p, long e );
DESCRIPTION
Free an element that was previously obtained via pxalloc().
Note: if you free an element that was not allocated from this pool, or was already free, or was outside the pool, then your application will crash! You can detect most of these programming errors by defining the following symbols before #use pool.lib:
POOL_DEBUG
POOL_VERBOSE
PARAMETERS p e
Pool handle structure, as previously passed to pxalloc ()
Element to free, which was returned from pxalloc().
.
RETURN VALUE null : There are no more elements
!null
: Pointer to previous allocated element
LIBRARY
POOL.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
375
pxfree_fast
xmem void pxfree_fast( Pool_t * p, long e );
DESCRIPTION
Free an element that was previously obtained via pxalloc(). This is an assembler-only version of pxfree().
*** Do _not_ call this function from C. *** pxfree_fast does not perform any IPSET protection or parameter validation. pxfree_fast is an xmem function. The parameters must be passed in machine registers.
Registers
Parameters in IX, BCDE respectively
Trashes AF, BC, DE, HL
Example ld ix,my_pool ld de,(element_addr) ld bc,(element_addr+2) lcall pxfree_fast
PARAMETERS p e
Pool handle structure, as previously passed to palloc() or palloc_fast . This must be in the IX register.
Element to free, which was returned from palloc(). This must be in the
BCDE register (physical address)
RETURN VALUE null : There are no more elements
!null
: Pointer to previous allocated element
LIBRARY
POOL.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
376 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
pxlast
long pxlast( Pool_t * p );
DESCRIPTION
Get the last allocated element in an xmem pool. The pool MUST be set to being a linked pool using pool_link(p, <non-zero>); otherwise, the results are undefined.
PARAMETERS p Pool handle structure, as previously passed to pool_xinit().
RETURN VALUE
0 : There are no allocated elements
!0
: Pointer to last, i.e., youngest, allocated element
LIBRARY
POOL.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
377
pxlast_fast
xmem long pxlast_fast( Pool_t * p );
DESCRIPTION
Get the last allocated element in an xmem pool. The pool MUST be set to being a linked pool using pool_link(p, <non-zero>); otherwise, the results are undefined.
This is an assembler-only version of pxlast().
*** Do _not_ call this function from C. ***
Registers
Parameter in IX
Trashes F, HL
Return value in BCDE, carry flag
Example ld ix,my_pool lcall pxlast_fast jr c,.no_elems
; BCDE points to last element
PARAMETERS p Pool handle structure, as previously passed to pool_xinit(). Pass this in IX register.
RETURN VALUE
C flag set: There are no more elements
C flag clear (NC): BCDE points to last element
LIBRARY
POOL.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
378 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
pxnext
long pxnext( Pool_t * p, long e );
DESCRIPTION
Get the next allocated element in an xmem pool. The pool MUST be set to being a linked pool using pool_link(p, <non-zero>); otherwise, the results are undefined.
You can easily iterate through all of the allocated elements of a root pool using the following construct: long e;
Pool_t * p; for (e = pxfirst(p); e; e = pxnext(p, e)) {
...
}
PARAMETERS p e
Pool handle structure, as previously passed to pool_xinit().
Previous element address, obtained by e.g. pxfirst(). This must be an allocated element in the given pool, otherwise the results are undefined. Be careful when iterating through a list and deleting elements using pxfree() : once the element is deleted, is is no longer valid to pass its address to this function. If this parameter is zero, then the result is the same as pxfirst(). This ensures the invariant pxnext(p, pxprev(p, e)) == e.
RETURN VALUE
0 : There are no more elements
!0
: Pointer to the next allocated element
LIBRARY
POOL.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
379
pxnext_fast
xmem long pxnext_fast( Pool_t * p, long e );
DESCRIPTION
Get the next allocated element in an xmem pool. The pool MUST be set to being a linked pool using pool_link(p, <non-zero>); otherwise, the results are undefined.
This is an assembler-only version of pxnext().
*** Do _not_ call this function from C. ***
Registers
Parameters in IX, DE respectively
Trashes AF, HL
Return value in BCDE, carry flag
Example ld ix,my_pool ld de,(current_element) ld bc,(current_element+2) lcall pxnext_fast jr c,.no_more_elems
; BCDE points to next allocated element
PARAMETERS p e
Pool handle structure, as previously passed to pool_xinit(). Pass this in the IX register.
Current element, address in BCDE register. See pxnext() for fuller description.
RETURN VALUE
C flag set: There are no more elements
C flag clear (NC): BCDE points to next element
LIBRARY
POOL.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
380 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
pxprev
long pxprev( Pool_t * p, long e );
DESCRIPTION
Get the previous allocated element in an xmem pool. The pool MUST be set to being a linked pool using pool_link(p, <non-zero>); otherwise the results are undefined.
You can easily iterate through all of the allocated elements of an xmem pool using the following construct: long e;
Pool_t * p; for (e = pxlast(p); e; e = pxprev(p, e)) {
...
}
PARAMETERS p e
Pool handle structure, as previously passed to pool_xinit().
Previous element address, obtained by e.g., pxlast(). This must be an allocated element in the given pool; otherwise, the results are undefined.
Be careful when iterating through a list and deleting elements using pxfree() : once the element is deleted, it is no longer valid to pass its address to this function. If this parameter is zero, then the result is the same as pxlast(). This ensures the invariant pxlast(p, pxnext(p, e)) == e
RETURN VALUE
0 : There are no more elements
!0
: Points to previously allocated element
LIBRARY
POOL.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
381
pxprev_fast
xmem long pxprev_fast( Pool_t * p, long e );
DESCRIPTION
Get the previous allocated element in an xmem pool. The pool MUST be set to being a linked pool using pool_link(p, <non-zero>); otherwise, the results are undefined.
This is an assembler-only version of pxprev().
*** Do _not_ call this function from C. ***
Registers
Parameters in IX, DE respectively
Trashes AF, HL
Return value in BCDE, carry flag
Example ld ix,my_pool ld de,(current_element) ld bc,(current_element+2) lcall pxprev_fast jr c,.no_more_elems
; BCDE points to previously allocated element
PARAMETERS p e
Pool handle structure, as previously passed to pool_xinit(). Pass this in IX register.
Current element, address in BCDE register. See pxprev() for fuller description.
RETURN VALUE
C flag set: there are no more elements
C flag clear (NC): BCDE points to previous element
LIBRARY
POOL.LIB
SEE ALSO
382 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
qd_error
char qd_error( int channel );
DESCRIPTION
Gets the current error bits for that qd channel. This function is intended to be used with the Rabbit 3000 and Rabbit 4000.
PARAMETERS channel The channel to read errors from (currently 1 or 2).
RETURN VALUE
Set of error flags, that can be decoded with the following masks:
QD_OVERFLOW
QD_UNDERFLOW
0x01
0x02
LIBRARY
QD.LIB (was in R3000.LIB prior to DC 10)
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
383
qd_init
void qd_init( int iplevel );
DESCRIPTION
If your board has a Rabbit 3000A microprocessor installed, the quadrature decoder can be set for 10 bit counter operation. For 10 bit operation, add the following macro at the top of your application program.
#define QD_10BIT_OPERATION
If the above macro is not defined then the quadrature decoder defaults to 8 bit counter operation.
With the Rabbit 3000 processor you must use the default 8-bit operation; defining the 10-bit macro will cause a compile time error.
Sample program Samples/Rabbit3000/QD_Phase_10bit.c demonstrates the use of the macro.
If your board has a Rabbit 4000 microprocessor installed, the quadrature decoder inputs must be chosen with one of the following defines. Define only one per quadrature decoder.
#define QD1_USEPORTD
#define QD1_USEPORTEL
#define QD1_USEPORTEH
// use port D pins 1 and 0
// use port E pins 1 and 0
// use port E pins 5 and 4
#define QD2_USEPORTD
#define QD2_USEPORTEL
#define QD2_USEPORTEH
// use port D pins 3 and 2
// use port E pins 3 and 2
// use port E pins 7 and 6
If no macro is defined for a decoder, that decoder will be disabled.
PARAMETERS iplevel The interrupt priority for the ISR that handles the count overflow. This should usually be 1.
LIBRARY
QD.LIB (was in R3000.LIB prior to DC 10)
384 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
qd_read
long qd_read( int channel );
DESCRIPTION
Reads the current quadrature decoder count. Since this function waits for a clear reading, it can potentially block if there is enough flutter in the decoder count.
This function is intended to be used with the Rabbit 3000 and Rabbit 4000.
PARAMETERS channel The channel to read (currently 1 or 2).
RETURN VALUE
Returns a signed long for the current count.
LIBRARY
QD.LIB (was in R3000.LIB prior to DC 10)
qd_zero
void qd_zero( int channel );
DESCRIPTION
Sets the count for a channel to 0. This function is intended to be used with the Rabbit 3000 and
Rabbit 4000.
PARAMETERS channel The channel to reset (currently 1 or 2)
LIBRARY
QD.LIB (was in R3000.LIB prior to DC 10)
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
385
qsort
int qsort( char * base, unsigned n, unsigned s, int (*cmp) () );
DESCRIPTION
Quick sort with center pivot, stack control, and easy-to-change comparison method. This version sorts fixed-length data items. It is ideal for integers, longs, floats and packed string data without delimiters. Raw integers, longs, floats or strings may be sorted, however, the string sort is not efficient.
PARAMETERS base n s cmp
Base address of the raw string data.
Number of blocks to sort.
Number of bytes in each block.
User-supplied compare routine for two block pointers, p and q, that returns an int with the same rules used by Unix strcmp(p,q):
= 0: Blocks p and q are equal
< 0: p is less than q
> 0: p is greater than q
Beware of using ordinary strcmp()—it requires a null at the end of each string.
RETURN VALUE
0 if the operation is successful.
LIBRARY
SYS.LIB
EXAMPLE - Sorts an array of integers .
int mycmp(int *p, int *q){ return (*p - *q);} const int q[10] = {12,1,3,-2,16,7,9,34,-90,10}; const int p[10] = {12,1,3,-2,16,7,9,34,-90,10}; main() { int i; qsort(p,10,2,mycmp); for(i=0;i<10;++i) printf("%d. %d, %d\n",i,p[i],q[i]);
}
Output from the above sample program:
0. -90, 12
1. -2, 1
2. 1, 3
3. 3, -2
4. 7, 16
5. 9, 7
6. 10, 9
7. 12, 34
8. 16, -90
9. 34, 10
386 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
rad
float rad( float x );
DESCRIPTION
Convert degrees (360 for one rotation) to radians (2
for a rotation).
PARAMETERS x Degree value to convert.
RETURN VALUE
The radians equivalent of degree.
LIBRARY
SYS.LIB
SEE ALSO
rand
float rand( void );
DESCRIPTION
Returns a uniformly distributed random number in the range 0.0
v < 1.0. Uses algorithm: rand = ( 5 * rand ) modulo 2
32
A default seed value is set on startup, but can be changed with the srand() function. rand() is not reentrant.
RETURN VALUE
A uniformly distributed random number: 0.0
v < 1.0.
LIBRARY
MATH.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
387
randb
float randb( void );
DESCRIPTION
Uses algorithm: rand = ( 5 * rand ) modulo 2
32
A default seed value is set on startup, but can be changed with the srand() function. randb() is not reentrant.
RETURN VALUE
Returns a uniformly distributed random number: -1.0
v < 1.0.
LIBRARY
MATH.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
randg
float randg( void );
DESCRIPTION
Returns a gaussian-distributed random number in the range -16.0
v < 16.0 with a standard deviation of approximately 2.6. The distribution is made by adding 16 random numbers (see rand() ). This function is not task reentrant.
RETURN VALUE
A gaussian distributed random number: -16.0
v <16.0.
LIBRARY
MATH.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
388 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
RdPortE
int RdPortE( unsigned int port );
DESCRIPTION
Reads an external I/O register specified by the argument.
PARAMETERS port Address of external parallel port data register.
RETURN VALUE
Returns an integer, the lower 8 bits of which contain the result of reading the port specified by the argument. Upper byte contains zero.
LIBRARY
SYSIO.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
389
RdPortI
int RdPortI( int port );
DESCRIPTION
Reads an internal I/O port specified by the argument (use RdPortE() for external port).
All of the Rabbit internal registers have predefined macros corresponding to the name of the register. PADR is #defined to be 0x30, etc.
PARAMETERS port Address of internal I/O port
RETURN VALUE
Returns an integer, the lower 8 bits of which contain the result of reading the port specified by the argument. Upper byte contains zero.
LIBRARY
SYSIO.LIB
SEE ALSO
390 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
ReadCompressedFile
int ReadCompressedFile( ZFILE * input, UBYTE * buf, int lenx );
DESCRIPTION
This function decompresses a compressed file (input ZFILE, opened with
OpenInputCompressedFile() ) using the LZ compression algorithm on-the-fly, placing a number of bytes (lenx) into a user-specified buffer (buf).
PARAMETERS input buf lenx
Input bit file.
Output buffer.
Number of bytes to read. This can be increased to get more throughput or decreased to free up variable space.
RETURN VALUE
Number of bytes read
LIBRARY
LZSS.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
391
read_rtc
unsigned long read_rtc( void );
DESCRIPTION
Reads seconds (32 bits) directly from the Real-time Clock (RTC). Use with caution! In most cases use long variable SEC_TIMER, which contains the same result, unless the RTC has been changed since the start of the program.
If you are running the processor off the 32 kHz crystal and using a Dynamic C version prior to
7.30, use read_rtc_32kHz() instead of read_rtc(). Starting with DC 7.30, read_rtc_32kHz() is deprecated because it is no longer necessary. Programmers should only use read_rtc().
RETURN VALUE
Time in seconds since January 1, 1980 (if RTC set correctly).
LIBRARY
RTCLOCK.LIB
SEE ALSO
read_rtc_32kHz
unsigned long read_rtc_32kHz( void );
DESCRIPTION
Reads the real-time clock directly when the Rabbit processor is running off the 32 kHz oscilla-
tor. See read_rtc() for more details.
RETURN VALUE
Time in seconds since January 1, 1980 (if RTC set correctly).
LIBRARY
RTCLOCK.LIB
392 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
readUserBlock
int readUserBlock( void * dest, unsigned addr, unsigned numbytes );
DESCRIPTION
Reads a number of bytes from the User block on the primary flash to a buffer in root memory.
Please note that portions of the User block may be used by the BIOS for your board to store values. For example, any board with an A to D converter will require the BIOS to write calibration constants to the User block. For some versions of the BL2000 and the BL2100 this memory area is 0x1C00 to 0x1FFF. See the user’s manual for your particular board for more information before overwriting any part of the User block. Also, see the Rabbit Microprocessor
Designer’s Handbook for more information on the User block.
Note: When using a board with serial bootflash (e.g., RCM4300, RCM4310), readUserBlockArray() should be called until it returns zero or a negative error code. A positive return value indicates that the SPI port needed by the serial flash is in use by another device. However, if using µC/OS-II and _SPI_USE_UCOS_MUTEX is
#defined, then this function only needs to be called once. If the mutex times out waiting for the SPI port to free up, the run time error ERR_SPI_MUTEX_ERROR will occur. See the description for _rcm43_InitUCOSMutex() for more information on using
µC/OS-II and _SPI_USE_UCOS_MUTEX.
PARAMETERS dest addr numbytes
Pointer to destination to copy data to.
Address offset in User block to read from.
Number of bytes to copy.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success
-1 : Invalid address or range
-2 : No valid ID block found (block version 3 or later)
The return values below are applicable only if _SPI_USE_UCOS_MUTEX is not #defined:
-ETIME : (Serial flash only, time out waiting for SPI) postive N: (Serial flash only, SPI in use by device N)
LIBRARY
IDBLOCK.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
393
readUserBlockArray
int readUserBlockArray( void * dests[], unsigned numbytes[], int numdests, unsigned addr );
DESCRIPTION
Reads a number of bytes from the User block on the primary flash to a set of buffers in root memory. This function is usually used as the inverse function of writeUserBlockArray() .
This function was introduced in Dynamic C version 7.30.
Note: Portions of the User block may be used by the BIOS to store values such as calibration constants. See the manual for your particular board for more information before overwriting any part of the User block.
Note: When using a board with serial bootflash (e.g., RCM4300, RCM4310), readUserBlockArray() should be called until it returns zero or a negative error code. A positive return value indicates that the SPI port needed by the serial flash is in use by another device. However, if using µC/OS-II and _SPI_USE_UCOS_MUTEX is
#defined, then this function only needs to be called once. If the mutex times out waiting for the SPI port to free up, the run time error ERR_SPI_MUTEX_ERROR will occur. See the description for _rcm43_InitUCOSMutex() for more information on using
µC/OS-II and _SPI_USE_UCOS_MUTEX.
PARAMETERS dests numbytes numdests addr
Pointer to array of destinations to copy data to.
Array of numbers of bytes to be written to each destination.
Number of destinations.
Address offset in User block to read from.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success
-1 : Invalid address or range
-2 : No valid System ID block found (block version 3 or later)
The return values below are applicable only if _SPI_USE_UCOS_MUTEX is not #defined:
-ETIME : (Serial flash only, time out waiting for SPI) postive N: (Serial flash only, SPI in use by device N)
LIBRARY
IDBLOCK.LIB
SEE ALSO
394 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
registry_enumerate
int registry_enumerate( RegistryContext * r, int (*f)(), int keyvalues, void far * ptr);
DESCRIPTION
Enumerate registry r->old_spec, calling the specified function “f” for each section header and, optionally, key=value pair.
The registry_get() function also performs enumeration; in fact it is a wrapper for this function.
PARAMETERS r f keyvalues ptr
RegistryContext structure, with at least the old_spec field initialized.
For example, use registry_prep_read() to set up the struct correctly.
r->old_spec: Open resource handle of a readable resource containing the registry settings. This is read from the current seek position, thus in most cases call this function with a freshly opened resource handle.
Callback function to be invoked. The function prototype must be as follows: int f(void far * ptr, int new_sect, char * sect, char far * key, char far * value) { ... } where the parameters are:
• ptr - this is passed through from the 4th parameter to the registry_enumerate() function (see below).
• new_sect - boolean indicating whether this call is to introduce a new section. If true, then 'sect' is the new section name, and 'key' and 'value' are not relevant.
• sect - name of section if new_sect flag is true
• key - key (field) ascii string if new_sect is false
• value - value as an ascii string if new_sect is false.
Boolean indicating whether the callback function is to be invoked for key=value pairs (if true). In either case, the callback is inkoked whenever a new section is found, and the new_sect callback parameter will be set true.
An arbitrary pointer which will be passed through to the callback on each invocation.
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
395
registry_enumerate (cont’d)
RETURN VALUE
<0: failure to write or read the resource
0: success
LIBRARY registry.lib
SEE ALSO sspec_open,
,
396 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
registry_get
int registry_get( char * basename, char far * section,
RegistryEntry * re, ServerContext * sctx, int (*f)(), int keyvalues, void far * ptr);
DESCRIPTION
Convenience function for reading and/or enumerating registry contents. This basically combines calls to the following functions: registry_prep_read() registry_read() and/or registry_enumerate() registry_finish_read()
If the field array (re) is not NULL, then registry_read() will be called. If the callback function (f) is not NULL, then registry_enumerate() will be called. If both re and f are not NULL, then read will be invoked before enumerate.
PARAMETERS basename section re sctx f() keyvalues ptr
Base name of registry file, as a Zserver resource name. This file must not have an extension, since the extensions ".1", ".2" and so on are appended to the name.
Section name to read (may be NULL to read the anonymous section at the start of the registry file).
Array of fields to read. See registry_read() function description for details.
Server context.
Callback function. See registry_enumerate() for details.
Boolean indicating whether callback receives key=value pairs as well as section headers. If false, it only receives section headers.
Arbitrary application data which will be dutifully passed through to the callback without alteration.
RETURN VALUE
<0 : general failure, code will be negative of one of the codes in ERRNO.LIB.
0 : OK
LIBRARY register.lib
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
397
registry_finish_read
int registry_finish_read( RegistryContext * r);
DESCRIPTION
Finish reading a registry, and clean up resources. Most applications will use the sequence of functions: registry_prep_read() registry_read() and/or registry_enumerate()| registry_finish_read()
PARAMETER r RegistryContext struct, as set by registry_prep_read().
RETURN VALUE
<0: general failure, code will be negative of one of the codes in ERRNO.LIB.
0: OK.
LIBRARY registry.lib
SEE ALSO
,
,
398 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
registry_finish_write
int registry_finish_write( RegistryContext * r);
DESCRIPTION
Finish updating a registry, and clean up resources. Most applications will use the sequence of functions registry_prep_write() registry_write() registry_finish_write()
PARAMETER r RegistryContext structure, as set by registry_prep_read().
RETURN VALUE
<0: general failure, code will be negative of one of the codes in ERRNO.LIB.
0: OK
LIBRARY registry.lib
SEE ALSO
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
399
registry_prep_read
int registry_prep_read( RegistryContext * r, char * basename,
ServerContext * context);
DESCRIPTION
Prepare for reading a registry. This function helps organize registry resources in order to create a robust registry.
Most applications will use the sequence of functions: registry_prep_read() registry_read() and/or registry_enumerate() registry_finish_read() or simply registry_get()
Registry updates require reading from an old registry, editing it, then writing the modified result to a new registry resource. This requires two resources to be open. Normally, the "old" registry will be deleted once the update is successful. If there is a power outage or reset during this process, it is possible for two registry files to exist when the system is restarted. This causes problems, since one of the registries may be corrupt. This API imposes a naming convention on the old/new resources so that a non-corrupt registry can always be found.
The algorithm used appends an extension to the basename resource name. The extension is ".1",
".2" or ".3". The "current" registry resource will cycle through these extensions. It is assumed that exactly 0, 1 or 2 of these resources will exist at any time. This means that at least one of the possible resource names will not exist. (If all three exist, then the behavior is undefined, since the resources must have been created outside the registry system. The application is responsible for ensuring this does not happen, otherwise the ability to find a non-corrupt registry will be compromised).
400 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
registry_prep_read (cont’d)
If none of the resources exist, then this indicates a brand new registry. If exactly one exists, then this is the old (and presumed non-corrupt) registry. If two exist, it is assumed that one of the resources is OK and the other corrupt. Since there are only 3 possible extensions, and they increment in wrap-around fashion, the "lowest" numbered extension is assumed to be the non-corrupt one, with "lowest" being in the sense of modulo 3. This is summarized in the following table:
Existing Extensions
-
1
2
3
1,2
2,3
1,3
1,2,3
Assumed Non-corrupt
None, new registry
1
2
3
1 (2 will be deleted)
2 (3 will be deleted)
3 (1 will be deleted)
Should not happen - will arbitrarily pick 1 and delete
2,3.
In the case that more than one registry extension was found, the presumed corrupt resource is automatically deleted to clean up the registry.
PARAMETERS r basename
RegistryContext structure. This is used to pass information in a consistent manner between the major registry API functions. It may be passed uninitialized to this function. This function fills in the r->old_spec field to indicate the open resource which will be used by registry_read(). The value may also be set to -1 if there was an error or no existing resource could be located.
Base name (including path) of the registry This should NOT include any extension (e.g. ".foo") since the extension is manipulated by this function.
In practice, this will need to be a resource name on non-volatile storage, which supports names with extensions. In practice, this limits the appropriate filesystem to FAT filesystem only. For example registry_prep_read("/A/myreg", &spec); will select from a set of registry files called /A/myreg.1, /A/myreg.2,
/A/myreg.3 of which, normally, only one will exist at any time.
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
401
registry_prep_read (cont’d)
context ServerContext struct. E.g. from http_getContext().
RETURN VALUE
<0 : General failure, code will be negative of one of the codes in ERRNO.LIB.
0 : there is currently no resource of the given name. This is not necessarily an error, since it will be returned if the registry has not yet been created.
1,2,3 : An existing presumed non-corrupt resource has been opened. The numeric return code indicates which of the extensions was located.
LIBRARY register.lib
SEE ALSO
,
,
402 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
registry_prep_write
int registry_prep_write( RegistryContext * r, char * basename,
ServerContext * context);
DESCRIPTION
Prepare for updating a registry. This function helps organize registry resources in order to create a robust registry.
Most applications will use the sequence of functions registry_prep_write() registry_write() registry_finish_write() or, more simply, just registry_update()
See the function description for registry_prep_read() for details concerning the organization of registry files.
Like registry_prep_read(), this function opens an existing presumed non-corrupt registry for reading, and also a new empty registry (the "next" registry) for writing the updated esults, as required by registry_write().
PARAMETERS r basename context
RegistryContext struct. This is used to pass information in a consistent manner between the major registry API functions. It may be passed uninitialized to this function.
Base name (including path) of the registry. This should NOT include any extension (e.g. ".foo") since the extension is manipulated by this function.
In practice, this will need to be a resource name on non-volatile storage, which supports names with extensions. In practice, this limits the appropriate filesystem to FAT filesystem only. For example registry_prep_write("/A/myreg", &oldspec, &newspec); will select from a set of registry files called
/A/myreg.1, /A/myreg.2, /A/myreg.3\ of which, normally, only two will exist at any time; one will be opened for reading, and the other will be empty and ready for writing.
ServerContext structure. E.g. from http_getContext().
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
403
registry_prep_write (cont’d)
RETURN VALUE
<0: general failure, code will be negative of one of the codes in ERRNO.LIB.
0: there is currently no resource of the given name. *oldp will be set to -1 in this case. This is not necessarily an error, since it will be returned if the registry has not yet been created. You can pass *oldp to registry_write() in this case, and it will correctly create the new registry without attempting to read the (non-existent) "old" registry.
1,2,3: An existing presumed non-corrupt resource has been opened, and the open resource handle returned in *oldp. The numeric return code indicates which of the extensions was located.
Note that the "new" registry file will be this number plus 1 (except that 4 becomes 1).
LIBRARY register.lib
SEE ALSO
,
,
404 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
registry_read
int registry_read( RegistryContext * r, char far * section,
RegistryEntry far * entries);
DESCRIPTION
Read the registry r->old_spec using the specified registry entries. Only entries in the named
“section” are read, and the results are placed at the locations pointed to by the RegistryEntry array elements.
Note: Since this function requires some temporary malloc memory, you should ensure that there is at least _REGBUF_SIZE bytes of available system-space malloc memory. The
_REGBUF_SIZE macro defaults to 1025 bytes, but you may override this definition before #use registry.lib.
r RegistryContext structure, with at least the old_spec field initialized. For example, use registry_prep_read() to set up this structure correctly.
r->old_spec:
Open resource handle of a readable resource containing the registry settings. This is read from the current seek position, thus in most cases you will want to call this function with a freshly opened resource handle.
section entries
Section name. If NULL or empty string, then the first (anonymous) section of the registry is implied.
List of registry entries to read. See the registry_write() description for details. The “value” field will be set to point to the location where the read value is stored. If the key does not exist in the specified section, then the contents at this location will be untouched. Thus, you can set “default” values at each location before calling registry_read().
As for registry_write(), the list MUST be terminated with an entry with the REGOPTION_EOL option.
RETURN VALUE
<0: failure to write or read the resource
0: success
LIBRARY register.lib
SEE ALSO sspec_open,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
405
registry_update
int registry_update( char * basename, char far * section,
RegistryEntry * re, ServerContext * sctx);
DESCRIPTION
Convenience function for updating a registry with a minimum of fuss. Basically combines the function calls: registry_prep_write() registry_write() registry_finish_write()
PARAMETERS basename section re sctx
Base name of registry file, as a Zserver resource name. This file must not have an extension, since the extensions ".1", ".2" and so on are appended to the name.
Section name to update (may be NULL to update the anonymous section at the start of the registry file).
Array of update commands. See the registry_write() function description for details. If this pointer is NULL, the entire section is deleted.
Server context.
RETURN VALUE
<0: general failure, code will be negative of one of the codes in ERRNO.LIB.
0: OK
LIBRARY register.lib
SEE ALSO
,
,
406 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
registry_write
int registry_write( RegistryContext * r, char far * section,
RegistryEntry far * entries);
DESCRIPTION
Modify the old registry r->old_spec using the specified registry entries, writing the result to r->new_spec. Only entries in the named “section” may be altered. This function also allows entries and sections to be deleted.
The new and old files must be different, since this function depends on reading from the old file, performing the requested modifications, and writing the new file -- this is all done line-by-line.
Generally, you will need two resource files which will alternate. Only when the modifications are successfully complete will the old file be deleted. This makes the update process more resistant to corruption caused by e.g., the user turning off the power in the middle of the update.
The helper function registry_prep_write() automates this process.The function registry_update() encapsulates the basic registry update process.
NOTE: since this function requires some temporary malloc memory, you should ensure that there is at least _REGBUF_SIZE bytes of available system-space malloc memory. The
_REGBUF_SIZE macro defaults to 1025 bytes, but you may override this definition before
#use registry.lib.
Registry resources are similar to Windows “.ini” file format. They are ASCII formatted (and thus human readable) and consist of one or more “sections,” each of which has zero or more key=value lines. For example:
[net settings] ip=10.10.6.100
ssid=Rabbit
[app settings] some integer=23 a string=hello world
Each section is headed by a string enclosed in square brackets. Within each section is a list of key strings followed by '=' followed by the value of that entry. The key string is arbitrary except that it cannot start with '[' or contain any '=', null or newline characters. The value string is arbitrary except that newline and null characters are not allowed. Section names are arbitrary except they cannot contain ']', null or newline characters. Spaces are always significant. In particular, don't put spaces on either side of the '=' separator.
If there are duplicate keys in the entries table, then it is undefined which of the entries actually gets stored. Don't do it.
Normally, you do not need to be concerned with the above format rules, since the library functions enforce them.
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
407
registry_write (cont’d)
If you need to store null (binary zero) or newline (binary 0x0A or, in C syntax, "\n") then your application will need to use some sort of convention for escaping such characters, or you can use the REGOPTION_BIN() option which will store the string expanded into ASCII hexadecimal, which is completely safe.
Individual key/value entries may be deleted by specifying the REGOPTION_DELETE flag with the appropriate entries.
PARAMETERS r section
RegistryContext structure, with at least the old_spec and new_spec fields initialized. For example, use registry_prep_write() to set up this structure correctly.
r ->old_spec:
Open resource handle of a readable resource containing the old registry settings. This is read from the current seek position, thus in most cases you will want to call this function with a freshly opened resource handle. This may also be -1, which indicates there is *no* old registry to update, and a new registry will be written to new_spec.
r->new_spec: Open resource handle of a writable resource, to which the old registry (modified with the given settings) will be written. Normally, this should initially be an empty resource file. The new settings will be written starting at the current seek position in this resource.
Note that the resource handles remain open when this function returns.
Section name. If NULL or empty string, then the first (anonymous) section of the registry is implied.
408 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
registry_write (cont’d)
entries List of replacement registry entries. The list MUST be terminated with an entry with the REGOPTION_EOL option.
Caution: If this pointer is NULL, then the entire section is deleted.
Each element in this array is as follows: typedef struct { char far * key; void far * value; int options;
// Entry key. Must not contain '=' or newlines, and
// must not start with '['. Must be null-terminated.
// Entry value. Type determined by options. If the
// REGOPTION_STRING option is set, this must
// not contain newlines and must be null terminated.
// Entry options and flags: If value is greater
// than zero, then value is an arbitrary binary
// value with the specified length. It will be
// stored in the registry with twice that many
// ascii hex digits. If value is <= -10, then it i
// ascii string with max length of (-options-8)
// Otherwise, this field is a simple enumeration
#define REGOPTION_EOL
// indicating the data type as follows:
0 // End of list
#define REGOPTION_SHORT (-1) // Signed short (2 byte) - stored as decimal
#define REGOPTION_LONG (-2) // Signed long (4 byte) - tored as decimal
#define REGOPTION_BOOL (-3) // int (2 byte) - stored as 1 (if non-zero) or 0
#define REGOPTION_FLOAT (-4) // IEEE float (4 byte)
// Only avail if STDIO_DISABLE_FLOATS
// *not* defined, stored in %f format
#define REGOPTION_RESV5
#define REGOPTION_RESV6
(-5)
(-6)
#define REGOPTION_DELETE (-7) // Delete this entry if found
#define REGOPTION_NOP (-8) // No operation: convenience for
#define REGOPTION_RESV9
// constructingRegistryEntry lists.
(-9) // For variable length data...
#define REGOPTION_BIN(len) (len)
// Binary of given fixed length - stored expanded into ascii hexadecimal.
// len must be 1.._REGBUF_SIZE/2-M where M is the size of the key plus 2.
// As a rule of thumb, be careful when len is more than about 256.
#define REGOPTION_STRING(len) (-8-(len))
// Null-terminated string up to len chars counting the null terminator - stored as-is.
// len must be at least 2. len must not be more than _REGBUF_SIZE-M where M is the
// size of the key plus 2. As a rule of thumb, be careful when len is more than about 512.
word work; // Work field for registry read/write lib functions
// May be left uninitialized by the caller unless otherwise noted in the function description.
} RegistryEntry;
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
409
registry_write (cont’d)
RETURN VALUE
<0: failure to write or read the resource
0: success
LIBRARY
REGISTRY.LIB
SEE ALSO sspec_open,
,
410 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
res
void res( void * address, unsigned int bit );
DESCRIPTION
Dynamic C may expand this call inline. Clears specified bit at memory address to 0. Bit may be from 0 to 31. This is equivalent to the following expression, but more efficient:
*(long *)address &= ~(1L << bit)
PARAMETERS address bit
Address of byte containing bits 7-0.
Bit location where 0 represents the least significant bit.
LIBRARY
UTIL.LIB
SEE ALSO
RES
void RES( void * address, unsigned int bit );
DESCRIPTION
Dynamic C may expand this call inline. Clears specified bit at memory address to 0. bit may be from 0 to 31. This is equivalent to the following expression, but more efficient:
*(long *)address &= ~(1L << bit)
PARAMETERS address bit
Address of byte containing bits 7-0.
Bit location where 0 represents the least significant bit.
LIBRARY
UTIL.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
411
ResetErrorLog
void ResetErrorLog( void );
DESCRIPTION
This function resets the exception and restart type counts in the error log buffer header. This function is not called by default from anywhere. It should be used to initialized the error log when a board is programmed by means other than Dynamic C, cloning, the Rabbit Field Utility
(RFU), or a service processor. For example, if boards are mass produced with pre-programmed flash chips, then the test program that runs on the boards should call this function.
LIBRARY
ERRORS.LIB
root2vram
int root2vram( void * src, int start, int length );
DESCRIPTION
This function copies data to the VBAT RAM. Tamper detection on the Rabbit 4000 erases the
VBAT RAM with any attempt to enter bootstrap mode.
PARAMETERS src start length
The address to the data in root to be copied to vbat ram.
The start location within the VBAT RAM (0-31).
The length of data to write to VBAT RAM. The length should be greater than 0.
The parameters length + start should not exceed 32.
LIBRARY
VBAT.LIB
SEE ALSO
412 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
root2xmem
int root2xmem( unsigned long dest, void * src, unsigned len );
DESCRIPTION
Stores len characters from logical address src to physical address dest.
PARAMETERS dest src len
Physical address.
Logical address.
Numbers of bytes.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success.
-1 : Attempt to write flash memory area, nothing written.
-2 : Source not all in root.
LIBRARY
XMEM.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
413
rtc_timezone
int rtc_timezone( long * seconds, char * tzname );
DESCRIPTION
This function returns the timezone offset as known by the library. The timezone is obtained from the following sources, in order of preference:
1. The DHCP server. This can only be used if the TCP/IP stack is in use, and USE_DHCP is defined.
2. The TIMEZONE macro. This should be defined by the program to an _hour_ offset - may be floating point.
PARAMETERS seconds tzname
Pointer to result longword. This will be set to the number of seconds offset from Coordinated Universal Time (UTC). The value will be negative for west; positive for east of Greenwich.
If null, no timezone name is returned. Otherwise, this must point to a buffer of at least 7 bytes. The buffer is set to a null-terminated string of between
0 and 6 characters in length, according to the value of the TZNAME macro.
If TZNAME is not defined, then the returned string is zero length ("").
RETURN VALUE
0 : timezone obtained from DHCP.
-1 : timezone obtained from TIMEZONE macro. The value of this macro (which may be int, float or a variable name) is multiplied by 3600 to form the return value.
-2 : timezone is zero since the TIMEZONE macro was not defined.
LIBRARY
RTCLOCK.LIB
414 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
runwatch
void runwatch( void );
DESCRIPTION
Runs and updates watch expressions if Dynamic C has requested it with a Ctrl-U. Should be called periodically in user program.
LIBRARY
SYS.LIB
sdspi_debounce
int sdspi_debounce( sd_device * sd );
DESCRIPTION
This function waits for and debounces the card insertion switch. When it returns True (1), then a card is fully inserted.
PARAMETER sd The device structure for the SD card.
RETURN VALUE
1: Success, card fully inserted
0: No card present
LIBRARY
SDFLASH.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
415
sdspi_get_csd
int sdspi_get_csd( sd_device * sd );
DESCRIPTION
This function is called to execute protocol command 9 to retrieve the SD card's Card Specific
Data (CSD) and store it in the respective SD driver configuration object. The CSD data is used to determine the SD card's physical storage and timing attributes.
PARAMETERS
sd The device structure for the SD card.
RETURN VALUE
0: Success
-EIO : I/O error
-EINVAL : Invalid parameter given
-ENOMEDIUM : No SD card in socket
-ESHAREDBUSY : Shared SPI port busy
LIBRARY
SDFLASH.LIB
416 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
sdspi_get_scr
int sdspi_get_scr( sd_device * sd );
DESCRIPTION
This function executes application specific command 51 to retrieve the SD card's Configuration
Register (SCR) and store it in the respective SD driver configuration object. The SCR data is used to identify the SD card's physical interface version and security version. It also contains erase state (all 0's or 1's) and supported bus widths.
PARAMETERS sd The device structure for the SD card.
RETURN VALUE
0: Success
-EIO : I/O error
-EINVAL : Invalid parameter given
-ENOMEDIUM : No SD card in socket
-ESHAREDBUSY : Shared SPI port busy
LIBRARY
SDFLASH.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
417
sdspi_getSectorCount
long sdspi_getSectorCount( sd_device * dev );
DESCRIPTION
Return number of usable 512 byte sectors on an SD card.
PARAMETER dev Pointer to sd_device struct for initialized flash device.
RETURN VALUE
Number of sectors
LIBRARY
SDFLASH.LIB
sdspi_get_status_reg
int sdspi_get_status_reg( sd_device *sd, int * status );
DESCRIPTION
This function is called to execute protocol command 13 to retrieve the status register value of the SD card.
PARAMETERS sd status
Pointer to the device structure for the SD card.
Pointer to variable that returns the status.
RETURN VALUE
0: Success, Card status placed in status
-EIO : I/O error
-ENOMEDIUM : No SD card in socket
-ESHAREDBUSY : Shared SPI port busy
LIBRARY
SDFLASH.LIB
418 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
sdspi_init_card
int sdspi_init_card( sd_device * sd );
DESCRIPTION
Initializes the SD card pointed to by sd. Function executes protocol command “1” which clears
HCS bit and activates the card’s initialization sequence.
PARAMETERS sd Pointer to sd_device structure for the SD card.
RETURN VALUE
0: Success
-EIO : I/O error
-EINVAL : Invalid parameter given
-ENOMEDIUM : No SD card in socket
-ESHAREDBUSY : Shared SPI port busy
LIBRARY
SDFLASH.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
419
sdspi_initDevice
int sdspi_initDevice( int indx, sd_dev_interface * sd_dev );
DESCRIPTION
Initializes the SD card pointed to by sd_dev and adds information about the cards interface to the SD device array in the position pointed to by indx. Sets up the default block size of 512 bytes used by sector read/write functions. This function should be called before any calls to other sdspi functions.
PARAMETERS indx sd_dev
Index into the SD device array to add the card.
Pointer to sd_dev_interface for the SD card.
RETURN VALUE
0: Success
-EIO : I/O error
-EINVAL : Invalid parameter given
-ENOMEDIUM : No SD card in socket
-ESHAREDBUSY : SPI port busy
LIBRARY
SDFLASH.LIB
420 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
sdspi_isWriting
int sdspi_isWriting( sd_device * dev );
DESCRIPTION
Returns 1 if the SD card is busy writing a sector.
PARAMETER dev Pointer to initialized sd_device structure for the flash chip
RETURN VALUE
1: Busy
0: Ready, not currently writing
LIBRARY
SDFLASH.LIB
sdspi_notbusy
int sdspi_notbusy( int port );
DESCRIPTION
This function tests for a busy status from the SD card on the port given. It is assumed that the card is already enabled.
PARAMETER port The base address for the SD card's SPI port
RETURN VALUE
1: The card is not busy, write/erase has ended
0: The card is busy, write/erase in progress
LIBRARY
SDFLASH.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
421
sdspi_print_dev
void sdspi_print_dev( sd_device * dev );
DESCRIPTION
Prints parameters from the SD device structure.
PARAMETER dev Pointer to sd_device structure of the SD card.
LIBRARY
SDFLASH.LIB
422 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
sdspi_process_command
int sdspi_process_command( sd_device *sd, SD_CMD_REPLY * cmd_reply, int mode );
DESCRIPTION
This function sends the command placed in the cmd_reply structure and retrieves a reply and data (optional) as defined in the cmd_reply structure. Pointers to TX and RX buffers are retrieved from the cmd_reply structure and used for command transmission and reply/data reception. Reply is parsed and placed in cmd_reply.reply. Errors encountered will give a negative return value.
The SPI semaphore is obtained before the command is sent. The mode parameter controls whether the semaphore will be released after command execution and reply/data reception. If mode is zero, both semaphore and chip select are active on a successful return. An end command sequence and release of the semaphore must be handled by caller.
If mode is not 0, the semaphore will be released before returning. In addition, if mode is 2 then an SD card reset is in progress. This enables the distinguishing of certain I/O error conditions that would normally be grouped with the -EIO error code and instead return the -EAGAIN error code, indicating reset retries should continue.
PARAMETER sd cmd_reply mode
Pointer to sd_device structure of the SD card.
Pointer to cmd_reply structure, which contains: cmd - command to be executed argument - arguments for the command reply - storage for command reply reply_size - size in bytes of expected reply data_size - size in bytes of expected data tx_buffer - pointer to TX buffer to use rx_buffer - pointer to RX buffer to use
One of the following:
0 = SPI port semaphore should be retained.
1 = If SPI port to be released before return.
2 = Attempting SD card reset, otherwise same as mode “1”.
(Enables -EAGAIN return value.)
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
423
sdspi_process_command (cont’d)
RETURN VALUE
0: Success
-EIO : I/O error
-EAGAIN : Allowable I/O error during card reset
-EINVAL : Invalid parameter given
-ENOMEDIUM : No SD card in socket
-ESHAREDBUSY : Shared SPI port busy
LIBRARY
SDFLASH.LIB
sdspi_read_sector
int sdspi_read_sector( sd_device * sd, unsigned long sector_number, void * data_buffer );
DESCRIPTION
This function is called to execute protocol command 17 to read a 512 byte block of data from the SD card.
PARAMETER sd Pointer to sd_device structure of the SD card.
sector_number The sector number to read.
data_buffer Pointer to a buffer for the 512 bytes read.
RETURN VALUE
0: Success
-EIO : I/O error
-EINVAL : Invalid parameter given
-ENOMEDIUM : No SD card in socket
-ESHAREDBUSY : Shared SPI port busy
LIBRARY
SDFLASH.LIB
424 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
sdspi_reset_card
int sdspi_reset_card( sd_device * sd );
DESCRIPTION
Resets the SD card pointed to by sd. Function executes protocol command 0 to force the card to Idle mode. This command is sent multiple times to reset the SD card.
PARAMETER sd Pointer to sd_device structure of the SD card.
RETURN VALUE
0: Success
-EIO : I/O error
-EINVAL : Invalid parameter given
-ENOMEDIUM : No SD card in socket
-ESHAREDBUSY : Shared SPI port busy
LIBRARY
SDFLASH.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
425
sdspi_sendingAP
int sdspi_sendingAP( sd_device * sd );
DESCRIPTION
Sends AP command 55 to set Alternate Command mode on the next command sent to the card.
This function does not release the port sharing semaphore unless an error is encountered.
PARAMETER sd Pointer to sd_device structure of the SD card.
RETURN VALUE
0: Success
-EIO :I/O error
-ENOMEDIUM : No SD card in socket
-ESHAREDBUSY : Shared SPI port busy
LIBRARY
SDFLASH.LIB
sdspi_setLED
void sdspi_setLED( sd_device * sd, char state );
DESCRIPTION
This function sets the LED for the given SD card based on state. If state is 0, the LED is turned off. If state is not zero, the LED is turned on.
PARAMETER sd state
Pointer to sd_device structure of the SD card.
The state to set the LED to: 0 = Off and Non-zero = On
LIBRARY
SDFLASH.LIB
426 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
sdspi_set_block_length
int sdspi_set_block_length( sd_device * sd, int block_length );
DESCRIPTION
This function executes protocol command 16 to set the block length for the SD card. The default block length for SD cards is 512 bytes. Please note that sdspi_write_sector() and sdspi_read_sector() work on 512 byte blocks only. If you change the block size, these functions will need to be modified, or you will need to execute commands directly through sdspi_process_command() and internal write block and read block functions.
PARAMETER sd Pointer to device structure of the SD card.
block_length The block size in bytes for the SD card.
RETURN VALUE
0: Success
-EIO : I/O error
-EINVAL : Invalid parameter given
-ENOMEDIUM : No SD card in socket
-ESHAREDBUSY : Shared SPI port busy
LIBRARY
SDFLASH.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
427
sdspi_WriteContinue
int sdspi_WriteContinue( sd_device * sd );
DESCRIPTION
This function completes the previously started write command to the SD card when non-blocking mode is enabled. It looks for the end of the busy signal from the card, then strobes the chip select. This function should be called repeatedly until the -EBUSY code is not returned, at which point the SPI port is freed. There is a timeout mechanism for the busy signal. If exceeded, the port is freed and the -EIO error code is returned.
PARAMETERS sd The device structure for the SD card.
RETURN VALUE
0: Success
-EIO : I/O error or timeout
-EBUSY : SD card is busy with write operation; call sdspi_WriteContinue() again
LIBRARY
SDFLASH.LIB
428 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
sdspi_write_sector
int sdspi_write_sector( sd_device * sd, unsigned long sector_number, char * data_buffer );
DESCRIPTION
This function is called to execute protocol command 24 to write a 512 byte block of data to the
SD card.
PARAMETER sd Pointer to device structure of the SD card.
sector_number The sector number to write.
data_buffer Pointer to a buffer of 512 bytes to write.
RETURN VALUE
0: Success
-EIO : I/O error
-EACCES : Write protected block, no write access
-EINVAL : Invalid parameter given
-ENOMEDIUM : No SD card in socket
-ESHAREDBUSY : Shared SPI port busy
-EBUSY : SD card is busy with write operation; call sdspi_WriteContinue() to complete (only when SD_NON_BLOCK is defined)
LIBRARY
SDFLASH.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
429
servo_alloc_table
void servo_alloc_table( int which, int entries );
DESCRIPTION
Allocate an xmem data area for servo statistics collection. This function should be called once only (for each servo) at application startup time.
PARAMETERS which entries
Servo (0 or 1)
Number of entries to allocate. Each entry is 8 bytes, and stores 4 integer values. The maximum value for this parameter is 8190.
LIBRARY
SERVO.LIB
SEE ALSO
servo_closedloop
void servo_closedloop( int which, int reset );
DESCRIPTION
Run specified servo in closed-loop (PID) mode.
PARAMETERS which reset
Servo (0 or 1).
Whether to reset the current command list. The command list executes even while in open loop mode (although it will have no visible effect in that mode). If reset is non-zero, then the command list will be reset to empty and the motor will halt at the current position.
LIBRARY
SERVO.LIB
SEE ALSO
430 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
servo_disable_0
void servo_disable_0( void );
DESCRIPTION
Disable drive to the first servo motor. This function only works if an auxiliary control signal is connected to the motor driver. The I/O pin used for this function is specified by the macros:
#define SERVO_ENABLE_PORT_0 PGDR
#define SERVO_ENABLE_PORTSHADOW_0 PGDRShadow
#define SERVO_ENABLE_PIN_0 6 and, optionally,
#define SERVO_ENABLE_DDR_0 PGDDR
#define SERVO_ENABLE_DDRSHADOW_0 PGDDRShadow
#define SERVO_ENABLE_ACTIVEHIGH_0
This function is limited to toggling the output pin. If enabling or disabling the servo motor requires more complicated actions, you can substitute your own function by defining
#define SERVO_DISABLE_0 yyyy where yyyy is the name of your own function (which is assumed to take no parameters and have no return value)
LIBRARY
SERVO.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
431
servo_disable_1
void servo_disable_1( void );
DESCRIPTION
Disable drive to the second servo motor. This function only works if an auxiliary control signal is connected to the motor driver. The I/O pin used for this function is specified by the macros:
#define SERVO_ENABLE_PORT_1 PGDR
#define SERVO_ENABLE_PORTSHADOW_1 PGDRShadow
#define SERVO_ENABLE_PIN_1 7 and, optionally,
#define SERVO_ENABLE_DDR_1 PGDDR
#define SERVO_ENABLE_DDRSHADOW_1 PGDDRShadow
#define SERVO_ENABLE_ACTIVEHIGH_1
This function is limited to toggling the output pin. If enabling or disabling the servo motor requires more complicated actions, you can substitute your own function by defining
#define SERVO_DISABLE_1 yyyy where yyyy is the name of your own function (which is assumed to take no parameters and have no return value)
LIBRARY
SERVO.LIB
SEE ALSO
432 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
servo_enable_0
void servo_enable_0( void );
DESCRIPTION
Enable drive to the first servo motor. This function only works if an auxiliary control signal is connected to the motor driver. The I/O pin used for this function is specified by the macros:
#define SERVO_ENABLE_PORT_0 PGDR
#define SERVO_ENABLE_PORTSHADOW_0 PGDRShadow
#define SERVO_ENABLE_PIN_0 6 and, optionally,
#define SERVO_ENABLE_DDR_0 PGDDR
#define SERVO_ENABLE_DDRSHADOW_0 PGDDRShadow
#define SERVO_ENABLE_ACTIVEHIGH_0
This function is limited to toggling the output pin high or low. If enabling or disabling the servo motor requires more complicated actions, you can substitute your own function by defining
#define SERVO_ENABLE_0 xxxx where xxxx is the name of your own function (which is assumed to take no parameters and have no return value).
LIBRARY
SERVO.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
433
servo_enable_1
void servo_enable_1( void );
DESCRIPTION
Enable drive to the second servo motor. This function only works if an auxiliary control signal is connected to the motor driver. The I/O pin used for this function is specified by the macros:
#define SERVO_ENABLE_PORT_1 PGDR
#define SERVO_ENABLE_PORTSHADOW_1 PGDRShadow
#define SERVO_ENABLE_PIN_1 7 and, optionally,
#define SERVO_ENABLE_DDR_1 PGDDR
#define SERVO_ENABLE_DDRSHADOW_1 PGDDRShadow
#define SERVO_ENABLE_ACTIVEHIGH_1
This function is limited to toggling the output pin high or low. If enabling or disabling the servo motor requires more complicated actions, you can substitute your own function by defining
#define SERVO_ENABLE_1 xxxx where xxxx is the name of your own function (which is assumed to take no parameters and have no return value).
LIBRARY
SERVO.LIB
SEE ALSO
434 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
servo_gear
void servo_gear( int count0, int count1, int slave0, int slave1 );
DESCRIPTION
NOTE: this function is currently not efficient enough for production use (owing to use of long multiplication and division). It is provided as an example of the use of callbacks from the ISR.
If two servos are in use, couple or cross-couple their positioning. This only works if
NUM_SERVOS is 2, and both servos are in closed loop mode.
There are four possible sub-modes of operation, which depend on the slave0/1 parameters.
0
0
1
1 slave0
0
1
0
1 slave1 Operation
Non-gear mode: neither servo is slaved. This is the normal, default, mode.
Second servo is slaved from first servo. For every 'count0' increments of the first servo's encoder, the second servo will be moved 'count1' increments.
First servo is slaved from second servo. For every 'count1' increments of the second servo's encoder, the first servo will be moved 'count0' increments.
Both servos cross-coupled. Movement will only result from an externally applied torque. This is a true simulation of mechanical gearing.
Call this function with count0 or count1 zero, or both slave0 and slave1 zero, to exit from gear mode. When a servo that was slaved is set to normal mode, its velocity is set to zero.
PARAMETERS count0 Encoder increment for the first servo which results from count1 increments of the second servo.
count1 Encoder increment for the second servo which results from count0 increments of the first servo.
Together, count0 and count1 determine the gearing ratio. Neither value should be set to a magnitude greater than about 500, to avoid internal arithmetic overflow. In any gear mode, the total movement of either servo should be limited to less than about 2M counts in either direction from the point at which gear mode was set. If a smaller range of movement is acceptable, then the maximum of either count parameter may be increased proportionally. The value of count0/count1 or count1/count0 should not have a magnitude greater than about 10 to avoid encoder quantization problems, especially in cross-coupled mode.
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
435
servo_gear (cont’d)
slave0 slave1
1 if first servo slaved to second, else zero.
1 if second servo slaved to first, else zero.
LIBRARY
SERVO.LIB
SEE ALSO
436 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
servo_graph
int servo_graph( int which, word start, word nlines, word samples, word what, int low, int high );
DESCRIPTION
Draw ASCII-art graph of servo response. This is primarily intended for debugging. It should be called after resetting the sample collection table using servo_stats_reset(), then executing a movement whose response is to be graphed.
PARAMETERS which start nlines samples what low high
Servo (0 or 1)
Starting sample number
Number of lines (sample bins) in graph - vertical axis
Number of samples to cover (should be multiple of nlines)
Which statistic to print: 0 is for error; 1 for error integral; 2 for error rate
(differential), 3 for PWM output setting. These may be customized to have different meanings
Low range of horizontal axis
High range of horizontal axis
RETURN VALUE
0: OK
-1: error
LIBRARY
SERVO.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
437
servo_init
void servo_init( void );
DESCRIPTION
This function must be called once at the beginning of application code to initialize the servo library.
LIBRARY
SERVO.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
servo_millirpm2vcmd
long servo_millirpm2vcmd( int which, long millirpm );
DESCRIPTION
Convert 1/1000 RPM units to velocity command value. Basic formula is: vcmd =
SERVO_COUNT_PER_REV_n
60000
SERVO_LOOP_RATE_HZ
Floating point is used to retain 24 bit precision.
PARAMETERS which millirpm
Servo (0 or 1).
Input in units of 1/1000 RPM.
RETURN VALUE
Output in units suitable for command velocity setting i.e units of 1/65536 encoder counts per
ISR execution (sample).
LIBRARY
SERVO.LIB
SEE ALSO
438 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
servo_move_to
int servo_move_to( int which, long pos, long ticks, long accel_ticks, long final_v );
DESCRIPTION
Move to new position, pos. Assumes current position is “cmd” and current velocity is “vcmd”
(with the values of these read from the control structure at beginning of routine).
Each "tick" represents the time interval between loop updates. This routine measures time intervals in units of ticks.
accel_ticks (<= ticks) is the number of ticks allocated to acceleration/deceleration phase of movement. The remaining part of the movement is performed at constant velocity. Acceleration and deceleration are computed to be of the same magnitude at beginning and end of motion (but may be opposite signs). final_v is the velocity to be achieved at end of movement. This routine returns as soon as the necessary command list is installed for execution by the ISR. The movement will not be completed until “ticks” ISR executions.
NB: if the average velocity (vt) required to complete the movement is greater than +/-16k counts per tick, then the movement is stretched to a longer time interval so as to make the peak velocity equal to the +/- 8k counts/tick (which is higher than any physical motor can follow). accel_ticks is set to 16384 if it is over that (since rounding errors can accumulate over long periods of low acceleration).
If this routine is called again before the previous motion is completed, then the previous motion will be overridden by the new motion. This routine uses floating point, since the mathematics are quite complex. It takes several milliseconds to execute, so should not be called to perform motions which complete in less than, say, 50ms.
This routine does not attempt to control rate of change of acceleration ("jerk" or d^3x/dt^3). It approximates the required movement profile as parabolic (constant acceleration) and linear
(constant velocity) segments.
PARAMETERS which pos
Servo (0 or 1).
Position to be achieved at end of movement.
ticks final_v
Number of ISR executions (loop update rate) over which to complete the movement. If less than 1, it is set to 1.
accel_ticks Number of ticks over which acceleration is to be applied. The remainder of the interval, ticks - accel_ticks, is performed at constant velocity. If greater than "ticks", it is set equal to "ticks".
Final velocity to be achieved at end of movement.
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
439
servo_move_to (cont’d)
RETURN VALUE
0: OK.
1: computed velocity is "extremely high": time interval stretched to make velocity fit within allowable fixed-point limits (i.e. 8192 encoder counts per sample).
LIBRARY
SERVO.LIB
SEE ALSO
servo_openloop
void servo_openloop( int which, word pwm );
DESCRIPTION
Run specified servo in open-loop mode (no PID control). Note that this bypasses dynamic current-limiting (if any defined) so should be used with caution.
PARAMETERS which pwm
Servo (0 or 1).
Output PWM setting (0-1024). 0 indicates maximum reverse speed, 1024 is maximum forward speed. 512 is nominally zero speed (but this depends on amplifier offset).
LIBRARY
SERVO.LIB
SEE ALSO
440 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
servo_qd_zero_0
void servo_qd_zero_0( void );
DESCRIPTION
Reset the first servo encoder reading to zero. The servo motor is not moved; only the notion of the current position is reset to zero. This should only be called when the servo is in open loop mode.
LIBRARY
SERVO.LIB
SEE ALSO
servo_qd_zero_1
void servo_qd_zero_1 (void ;)
DESCRIPTION
Reset the second servo encoder reading to zero. The servo motor is not moved; only the notion of the current position is reset to zero. This should only be called when the servo is in open loop mode.
LIBRARY
SERVO.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
441
servo_read_table
int servo_read_table(int which, word entry, word nent, int data[12]);
DESCRIPTION
Read one or more table entries, returning average, max and min of all samples in the specified group starting at entry, for nent samples.
PARAMETERS which entry nent data[12]
Servo (0 or 1)
First sample number
Number of entries starting at "entry"
Returned data: 3 sets of 4 contiguous entries. The first set (data[0]..data[3]) contains the average; the second set (data[4]..data[7]) contains the maximum; and the last set (data[8]..data[11]) contains the minimum. The elements of each set correspond with the table data: the first element is the instantaneous error; the second is the error integral; the third is the error rate; and the 4th is the PWM output. These may be customized to have different meanings.
RETURN VALUE
0: OK
1: no such entry or entries.
LIBRARY
SERVO.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
442 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
servo_set_coeffs
void servo_set_coeffs( int which, int prop, int integral, int diff );
DESCRIPTION
Set the PID closed loop control coefficients. The normal sign for all coefficients should be positive in order to implement a stable control loop. See Technical Note 233 for details.
PARAMETERS which prop integral diff
Servo (0 or 1)
Proportional coefficient
Integral ("reset") coefficient
Derivative ("rate") coefficient
LIBRARY
SERVO.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
443
servo_set_pos
void servo_set_pos( int which, long pos, long vel );
DESCRIPTION
Move the specified servo motor to a specified position and set the specified velocity at that position. This cancels any move which is currently in effect.
PARAMETERS which pos vel
Servo (0 or 1)
Position, as an encoder count
Velocity, in units of encoder counts per loop update interval, times 65536.
You can convert RPM to a suitable velocity command using servo_millirpm2vcmd() .
LIBRARY
SERVO.LIB
SEE ALSO
444 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
servo_set_vel
void servo_set_vel( int which, long vel );
DESCRIPTION
Move the specified servo motor at a constant velocity. This cancels any move that is currently in effect.
PARAMETERS which vel
Servo (0 or 1).
Velocity, in units of encoder counts per loop update interval, times 65536.
You can convert RPM to a suitable velocity command using servo_millirpm2vcmd().
LIBRARY
SERVO.LIB
SEE ALSO
servo_stats_reset
void servo_stats_reset( int which );
DESCRIPTION
Reset the statistics table. This is used immediately prior to a command movement, so that the table is filled with the results of the movement command. Once reset, one table row is filled in for each execution of the update loop (ISR driven). This continues until the table is full, or it is reset again.
PARAMETER which Servo (0 or 1)
LIBRARY
SERVO.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
445
servo_torque
void servo_torque( int which, int torque );
DESCRIPTION
Run specified servo in open loop controlled torque mode. The torque is limited by the dynamic current limit feature, if available.
PARAMETERS which torque
Servo (0 or 1)
Amount of torque expressed as a fraction of the maximum permissible torque, times 10,000. For example, to set the torque to 1/10 the maximum value in the reverse direction, call servo_torque(0, -1000).
LIBRARY
SERVO.LIB
SEE ALSO
446 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
serCheckParity
int serCheckParity( char rx_byte, char parity );
DESCRIPTION
This function is different from the other serial routines in that it does not specify a particular serial port. This function takes any 8-bit character and tests it for correct parity. It will return true if the parity of rx_byte matches the parity specified. This function is useful for checking individual characters when using a 7-bit data protocol.
PARAMETERS rx_byte parity
The 8 bit character being tested for parity.
The character ‘O’ for odd parity, or the character ‘E’ for even parity.
RETURN VALUE
1 : Parity of the byte being tested matches the parity supplied as an argument.
0 : Parity of the byte does not match.
LIBRARY
RS232.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
447
serXclose
void serXclose(); /* where X is A-F */
DESCRIPTION
Disables serial port X. This function is non-reentrant.
The functions serEclose() and serFclose() may be used with the Rabbit 3000 and
Rabbit 4000.
LIBRARY
RS232.LIB
serXdatabits
void serXdatabits ( state ); /* where X is A-F */
DESCRIPTION
Sets the number of data bits in the serial format for this channel. Currently seven or eight bit modes are supported. A call to serXopen() must be made before calling this function. This function is non-reentrant.
The functions serEdatabits() and serFdatabits() may be used with the Rabbit
3000 and Rabbit 4000.
Note: Alternatively you can use another form of this function that has been generalized for all serial ports. Instead of substituting for “X” in the function name, the prototype of the generalized function is: serXdatabits(int port, ...), where “port” is one of the macros
SER_PORT_A through SER_PORT_F.
PARAMETERS state An integer indicating what bit mode to use. It is best to use one of the macros provided for this:
• PARAM_7BIT - Configures serial port to use 7 bit data.
• PARAM_8BIT - Configures serial port to use 8 bit data (default condition).
LIBRARY
RS232.LIB
448 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
serXdmaOff
int serXdmaOff( void ); /* where X is A-F */
DESCRIPTION
Stops DMA transfers and unallocates the channels. Restarts the serial interrupt capability.
Note: Alternatively you can use another form of this function that has been generalized for all serial ports. Instead of substituting for “X” in the function name, the function prototype is: serXdmaOff(int port), where “port” is one of the macros SER_PORT_A through
SER_PORT_F .
RETURN VALUE
0: Success
DMA Error codes: Error
LIBRARY
RS232.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
449
serXdmaOn
int serXdmaOn( int tcmask, int rcmask ); /* where X is A-F */
DESCRIPTION
Enables DMA for serial send and receive. This function should be called directly after serXopen() .
Note: Alternatively you can use another form of this function that has been generalized for all serial ports. Instead of substituting for “X” in the function name, the function prototype is: serXdmaOn(int port, ...), where “port” is one of the macros SER_PORT_A through
SER_PORT_F .
Important Flow Control Note:
Because the DMA flowcontrol uses the external request feature, only two serial ports can use
DMA flowcontrol at a time. For the CTS pin, one serial port can use PD2, PE2, or PE6, and the other can use PD3, PE3 or PE7.
How DMA Serial Works:
DMA Transmit:
When a serial function is called to transmit data, a DMA transfer begins. The length of that transfer is either the length requested, or the rest of the transmit buffer size from the current position. An interrupt is fired at the end of the transmit at which time another transmit is set up if more data is ready to go.
DMA Receive:
When serXdmaOn() is called, a continuous chain of DMA transfers begins sending any data received on the serial line to the circular buffer. With flowcontrol on, there is an interrupt after each segment of the data transfer. At that point, if receiving another segment would overwrite data, the RTSoff function is called.
For more information see the description at the beginning of RS232.LIB.
PARAMETERS tcmask rcmask
Channel mask for DMA transmit. Use DMA_CHANNEL_ANY to choose any available channel.
Channel mask for DMA receive. Use DMA_CHANNEL_ANY to choose any available channel.
RETURN VALUE
DMA error code or 0 for success
LIBRARY
RS232.LIB
SEE ALSO
450 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
serXflowcontrolOff
void serXflowcontrolOff( void ); /* where X is A-F */
DESCRIPTION
Turns off hardware flow control for serial port X. A call to serXopen() must be made before calling this function. This function is non-reentrant.
The functions serEflowcontrolOff() and serFflowcontrolOff() may be used with the Rabbit 3000 and Rabbit 4000.
Note: Alternatively you can use another form of this function that has been generalized for all serial ports. Instead of substituting for “X” in the function name, the prototype of the generalized function is: serXflowcontrolOff(int port), where “port” is one of the macros
SER_PORT_A through SER_PORT_F.
LIBRARY
RS232.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
451
serXflowcontrolOn
void serXflowcontrolOn( void ); /* where X is A-F */
DESCRIPTION
Turns on hardware flow control for channel X. This enables two digital lines that handle flow control, CTS (clear to send) and RTS (ready to send). CTS is an input that will be pulled active low by the other system when it is ready to receive data. The RTS signal is an output that the system uses to indicate that it is ready to receive data; it is driven low when data can be received.
A call to serXopen() must be made before calling this function.
This function is non-reentrant.
The functions serEflowcontrolOn() and serFflowcontrolOn() may be used with the Rabbit 3000 and Rabbit 4000.
If pins for the flow control lines are not explicitly defined, defaults will be used and compiler warnings will be issued. The locations of the flow control lines are specified using a set of 5 macros.
SERX_RTS_PORT Data register for the parallel port that the RTS line is on. e.g.
PCDR
SERA_RTS_SHADOW Shadow register for the RTS line's parallel port. e.g. PCDRShadow
SERA_RTS_BIT
SERA_CTS_PORT
SERA_CTS_BIT
The bit number for the RTS line
Data register for the parallel port that the CTS line is on
The bit number for the CTS line
LIBRARY
RS232.LIB
452 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
serXgetc
int serXgetc( void ); /* where X is A-F */
DESCRIPTION
Get next available character from serial port X read buffer. This function is non-reentrant.
The functions serEgetc() and serFgetc() may be used with the Rabbit 3000 and
Rabbit 4000.
Note: Alternatively you can use another form of this function that has been generalized for all serial ports. Instead of substituting for “X” in the function name, the prototype of the generalized function is: serXgetc(int port), where “port” is one of the macros
SER_PORT_A through SER_PORT_F.
RETURN VALUE
Success: the next character in the low byte, 0 in the high byte.
Failure: -1, which indicates either an empty or a locked receive buffer.
LIBRARY
RS232.LIB
EXAMPLE
// echoes characters main() { int c; serAopen(19200); while (1) { if ((c = serAgetc()) != -1) { serAputc(c);
}
} serAclose()
}
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
453
serXgetError
int serXgetError( void ); /* where X is A-F */
DESCRIPTION
Returns a byte of error flags, with bits set for any errors that occurred since the last time this function was called. Any bits set will be automatically cleared when this function is called, so a particular error will only be reported once. This function is non-reentrant.
The flags are checked with bitmasks to determine which errors occurred. Error bitmasks:
• SER_PARITY_ERROR
• SER_OVERRUN_ERROR
The functions serEgetError() and serFgetError() may be used with the
Rabbit 3000 and Rabbit 4000.
Note: Alternatively you can use another form of this function that has been generalized for all serial ports. Instead of substituting for “X” in the function name, the prototype of the generalized function is: serXgetError(int port), where “port” is one of the macros
SER_PORT_A through SER_PORT_F.
RETURN VALUE
The error flags byte.
LIBRARY
RS232.LIB
454 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
serXopen
int serXopen( long baud ); /* where X is A-F */
DESCRIPTION
Opens serial port X. This function is non-reentrant.
The user must define the buffer sizes for each port being used with the buffer size macros
XINBUFSIZE and XOUTBUFSIZE. The values must be a power of 2 minus 1, e.g.
#define XINBUFSIZE 63
#define XOUTBUFSIZE 127
Defining the buffer sizes to 2 n
- 1 makes the circular buffer operations very efficient. If a value not equal to 2 n
- 1 is defined, a default of 31 is used and a compiler warning is given.
The functions serEopen() and serFopen() may be used with the Rabbit 3000 and
Rabbit 4000.
Note: The default pin setup of Serial Port E uses parallel port C pins which conflict with the programming port. Opening serial port E with the default settings while in debug mode will therefore kill PC host/target communication.
The user must #define the following if not using the default (PCDR) settings:
SERE_TXPORT define to PEDR or PDDR
SERE_RXPORT define to PEDR or PDDR
Note: The alternate pins on parallel port D can be used for serial port B by defining
SERB_USEPORTD at the beginning of a program. See the section on parallel port D in the
Rabbit documentation for more detail on the alternate serial port pins.
For Rabbit 4000 Users: To use DMA for transfers, call serXdmaOn() after this function.
PARAMETERS baud Bits per second (bps) of data transfer. Note that the baud rate must be greater than or equal to the peripheral clock frequency divided by 8192.
RETURN VALUE
1 : The Rabbit's bps setting is within 5% of the input baud.
0 : The Rabbit's bps setting differs by more than 5% of the input baud.
LIBRARY
RS232.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
,
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
455
serXparity
void serXparity( int parity_mode ); /* where X is A-F */
DESCRIPTION
Sets parity mode for channel X. A call to serXopen() must be made before calling this function.
Parity generation for 8-bit data can be unusually slow due to the current method for generating high 9th bits. Whenever a 9th high bit is needed, the UART is disabled for approximately 10 baud times to create a long stop bit that should be recognized by the receiver as a high 9th bit.
The long delay is imposed because we are using the serial port itself to handle timing for the delay. Creating a shorter delay would the require use of some other timer resource.
This function is non-reentrant.
The functions serEparity() and serFparity() may be used with the Rabbit 3000 and
Rabbit 4000.
Note: Alternatively you can use another form of this function that has been generalized for all serial ports. Instead of substituting for “X” in the function name, the prototype of the generalized function is: serXparity(int port, ...), where “port” is one of the macros
SER_PORT_A through SER_PORT_F.
PARAMETERS parity_mode An integer indicating what parity mode to use. It is best to use one of the macros provided:
• PARAM_NOPARITY - Disables parity handling (default).
• PARAM_OPARITY - Odd parity; parity bit set to “0” if odd number of
1’s in data bits.
• PARAM_EPARITY - Even parity; parity bit set to “1” if even number of
1’s in data bits.
• PARAM_MPARITY - Mark parity; parity bit always set to logical 1.
(Rabbit 4000 only)
• PARAM_SPARITY - Space parity; parity bit always set to logical 0.
(Rabbit 4000 only)
• PARAM_2STOP - 2 stop bits.
From a logical standpoint, the first three of these PARAM_ macros cannot be combined, but even PARAM_2STOP must stand alone due to limitations in the UART hardware that will not allow parity bits and extra stop bits.
LIBRARY
RS232.LIB
456 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
serXpeek
int serXpeek( void ); /* where X is A-F */
DESCRIPTION
Returns first character in input buffer X, without removing it from the buffer. This function is non-reentrant.
The functions serEpeek() and serFpeek() may be used with the Rabbit 3000 and Rabbit
4000.
Note: Alternatively you can use another form of this function that has been generalized for all serial ports. Instead of substituting for “X” in the function name, the prototype of the generalized function is: serXpeek(int port), where “port” is one of the macros
SER_PORT_A through SER_PORT_F.
RETURN VALUE
An integer with first character in buffer in the low byte.
-1 if the buffer is empty.
LIBRARY
RS232.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
457
serXputc
int serXputc( char c ); /* where X is A-F */
DESCRIPTION
Writes a character to serial port X write buffer. This function is non-reentrant.
The functions serEputc() and serFputc() may be used with the Rabbit 3000 and Rabbit
4000.
Note: Alternatively you can use another form of this function that has been generalized for all serial ports. Instead of substituting for “X” in the function name, the prototype of the generalized function is: serXputc(int port, ...), where “port” is one of the macros
SER_PORT_A through SER_PORT_F.
PARAMETERS c Character to write to serial port X write buffer.
RETURN VALUE
0 if buffer locked or full, 1 if character sent.
LIBRARY
RS232.LIB
EXAMPLE main() { // echoes characters int c; serAopen(19200); while (1) { if ((c = serAgetc()) != -1) { serAputc(c);
}
} serAclose();
}
458 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
serXputs
int serXputs( char * s ); /* where X is A-F */
DESCRIPTION
Calls serXwrite(s, strlen(s)); does not write null terminator. This function is nonreentrant.
The functions serEputs() and serFputs() may be used with the Rabbit 3000 and Rabbit
4000.
Note: Alternatively you can use another form of this function that has been generalized for all serial ports. Instead of substituting for “X” in the function name, the prototype of the generalized function is: serXputs(int port, ...), where “port” is one of the macros
SER_PORT_A through SER_PORT_F.
PARAMETERS s Null terminated character string to write
RETURN VALUE
The number of characters actually sent from serial port X.
LIBRARY
RS232.LIB
EXAMPLE
// writes a null-terminated string of characters, repeatedly main() { const static char s[] = "Hello Rabbit"; serAopen(19200); while (1) { serAputs(s);
} serAclose();
}
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
459
serXrdFlush
void serXrdFlush( void ); /* where X is A-F */
DESCRIPTION
Flushes serial port X input buffer. This function is non-reentrant.
The functions serErdFlush() and serFrdFlush() may be used with the Rabbit 3000 and Rabbit 4000.
Note: Alternatively you can use another form of this function that has been generalized for all serial ports. Instead of substituting for “X” in the function name, the prototype of the generalized function is: serXrdFlush(int port), where “port” is one of the macros
SER_PORT_A through SER_PORT_F.
LIBRARY
RS232.LIB
serXrdFree
int serXrdFree( void ); /* where X is A-F */
DESCRIPTION
Calculates the number of characters of unused data space. This function is non-reentrant.
The functions serErdFree() and serFrdFree() may be used with the Rabbit 3000 and
Rabbit 4000.
Note: Alternatively you can use another form of this function that has been generalized for all serial ports. Instead of substituting for “X” in the function name, the prototype of the generalized function is: serXrdFree(int port), where “port” is one of the macros
SER_PORT_A through SER_PORT_F.
RETURN VALUE
The number of chars it would take to fill input buffer X.
LIBRARY
RS232.LIB
460 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
serXrdUsed
int serXrdUsed( void ); /* where X is A-F */
DESCRIPTION
Calculates the number of characters ready to read from the serial port receive buffer. This function is non-reentrant.
The functions serErdUsed() and serFrdUsed() may be used with the Rabbit 3000 and
Rabbit 4000.
Note: Alternatively you can use another form of this function that has been generalized for all serial ports. Instead of substituting for “X” in the function name, the prototype of the generalized function is: serXrdUsed(int port), where “port” is one of the macros
SER_PORT_A through SER_PORT_F.
RETURN VALUE
The number of characters currently in serial port X receive buffer.
LIBRARY
RS232.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
461
serXread
int serXread( void * data, int length, unsigned long tmout );
/* where X is A-F */
DESCRIPTION
Reads length bytes from serial port X or until tmout milliseconds transpires between bytes.
The countdown of tmout does not begin until a byte has been received. A timeout occurs immediately if there are no characters to read. This function is non-reentrant.
The functions serEread() and serFread() may be used with the Rabbit 3000 and Rabbit
4000.
Note: Alternatively you can use another form of this function that has been generalized for all serial ports. Instead of substituting for “X” in the function name, the prototype of the generalized function is: serXread(int port, ...), where “port” is one of the macros
SER_PORT_A through SER_PORT_F.
PARAMETERS data length tmout
Data structure to read from serial port X
Number of bytes to read
Maximum wait in milliseconds for any byte from previous one
RETURN VALUE
The number of bytes read from serial port X.
LIBRARY
RS232.LIB
EXAMPLE
// echoes a blocks of characters main() { int n; char s[16]; serAopen(19200); while (1) { if ((n = serAread(s, 15, 20)) > 0) { serAwrite(s, n);
}
} serAclose();
}
462 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
serXwrFlush
void serXwrFlush( void ); /* where X is A-F */
DESCRIPTION
Flushes serial port X transmit buffer, meaning that the buffer contents will not be sent. This function is non-reentrant.
The functions serEwrFlush() and serFwrFlush() may be used with the Rabbit 3000 and Rabbit 4000.
Note: Alternatively you can use another form of this function that has been generalized for all serial ports. Instead of substituting for “X” in the function name, the prototype of the generalized function is: serXwrFlush(int port), where “port” is one of the macros
SER_PORT_A through SER_PORT_F.
LIBRARY
RS232.LIB
serXwrFree
int serXwrFree( void ); /* where X is A-F */
DESCRIPTION
Calculates the free space in the serial port transmit buffer. This function is non-reentrant.
The functions serEwrFree() and serFwrFree() may be used with the Rabbit 3000 and
Rabbit 4000.
Note: Alternatively you can use another form of this function that has been generalized for all serial ports. Instead of substituting for “X” in the function name, the prototype of the generalized function is: serXwrFree(port), where “port” is one of the macros
SER_PORT_A through SER_PORT_F.
RETURN VALUE
The number of characters the serial port transmit buffer can accept before becoming full.
LIBRARY
RS232.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
463
serXwrite
int serXwrite( void * data, int length ); /* X is A-F */
DESCRIPTION
Transmits length bytes to serial port X. This function is non-reentrant.
The functions serEwrite() and serFwrite() may be used with the Rabbit 3000 and
Rabbit 4000.
Note: Alternatively you can use another form of this function that has been generalized for all serial ports. Instead of substituting for “X” in the function name, the prototype of the generalized function is: serXwrite(int port, ...), where “port” is one of the macros
SER_PORT_A through SER_PORT_F.
PARAMETERS data length
Data structure to write to serial port X
Number of bytes to write
RETURN VALUE
The number of bytes successfully written to the serial port.
LIBRARY
RS232.LIB
EXAMPLE
// writes a block of characters, repeatedly main() { const char s[] = "Hello Rabbit"; serAopen(19200);
} serAclose();
} while (1) { serAwrite(s, strlen(s));
464 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
serXwrUsed
int serXwrUsed( void ); /* where X is A-F */
DESCRIPTION
Returns the number of characters in the output buffer. This function is non-reentrant.
The functions serErdUsed() and serFrdUsed() may be used with the Rabbit 3000 and
Rabbit 4000.
Note: Alternatively you can use another form of this function that has been generalized for all serial ports. Instead of substituting for “X” in the function name, the prototype of the generalized function is: serXwrUsed(int port), where “port” is one of the macros
SER_PORT_A through SER_PORT_F.
RETURN VALUE
The number of characters currently in the output buffer.
LIBRARY
RS232.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
465
set
void set( void * address, unsigned int bit );
DESCRIPTION
Dynamic C may expand this call inline. Sets specified bit at memory address to 1. bit may be from 0 to 31. This is equivalent to the following expression, but more efficient:
*(long *)address |= 1L << bit
PARAMETERS address bit
Address of byte containing bits 7-0
Bit location where 0 represents the least significant bit
LIBRARY
UTIL.LIB
SEE ALSO
SET
void SET( void * address, unsigned int bit );
DESCRIPTION
Dynamic C may expand this call inline. Sets specified bit at memory address to 1. bit may be from 0 to 31. This is equivalent to the following expression, but more efficient:
*(long *)address |= 1L << bit
PARAMETERS address bit
Address of byte containing bits 7-0.
Bit location where 0 represents the least significant bit.
LIBRARY
UTIL.LIB
SEE ALSO
466 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
set32kHzDivider
void set32kHzDivider( int setting );
DESCRIPTION
Sets the expanded 32kHz oscillator divider for the Rabbit 3000 processor. This function does not enable running the 32kHz oscillator instead of the main clock. This function will affect the actual rate used by the processor when the 32kHz oscillator has been enabled to run by a call to use32kHzOsc() .
This function is not task reentrant.
PARAMETER setting 32kHz divider setting. The following are valid:
• OSC32DIV_1 - don't divide 32kHz oscillator
• OSC32DIV_2 - divide 32kHz oscillator by two
• OSC32DIV_4 - divide 32kHz oscillator by four
• OSC32DIV_8 - divide 32kHz oscillator by eight
• OSC32DIV_16 - divide 32kHz oscillator by sixteen
LIBRARY
SYS.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
467
setClockModulation
void setClockModulation( int setting );
DESCRIPTION
Changes the setting of the Rabbit 3000 CPU clock modulation. Calling this function will force a 500 clock delay before the setting is changed to ensure that the previous modulation setting has cleared before the next one is set. See the Rabbit 3000 Microprocessor User's Manual for more details about clock modulation for EMI reduction.
PARAMETER setting Clock modulation setting. Allowed values are:
• 0 = no modulation
• 1 = weak modulation
• 2 = strong modulation
LIBRARY
SYS.LIB
468 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
set_cpu_power_mode
int set_cpu_power_mode( int mode, char clkDoubler, char shortChipSelect );
DESCRIPTION
Sets operating power of the controller. Suspend serial communication and other data transmission activity prior to calling this function, which sets higher priority interrupt while switching clock frequencies.
This function is non-reentrant.
PARAMETERS mode Mode operation. Use the following table values below. (The higher the value the lower the power consumption of controller.)
4
5
2
3
Mode
1
Description
Cclk=Pclk=MainOsc
Cclk=Pclk=MainOsc/2
Cclk=Pclk=MainOsc/4
Cclk=Pclk=MainOsc/6
Cclk=Pclk=MainOsc/8
6
7
8
9
10
Comments
Debug capable
Debug capable (19200 baud)
Debug capable (9600 baud)
Cclk=Pclk= 32.768KHz
Cclk=Pclk=32KHz/2=16.384KHz
Cclk=Pclk=32KHz/4 =8.192KHz
Cclk=Pclk=32KHz/8=4.096KHz
Cclk=Pclk=32kHz/16 =2.048KHz
Periodic Interrupt disabled, so call hitwd()
Periodic Interrupt disabled, so call hitwd()
Periodic Interrupt disabled, so call hitwd()
Periodic Interrupt disabled, so call hitwd()
Periodic Interrupt disabled, so call hitwd()
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
469
set_cpu_power_mode (cont’d)
clkDoubler Clock doubler setting: CLKDOUBLER_ON or CLKDOUBLER_OFF.
CPU will operate at half selected speed when turned off. This parameter only affects main oscillator modes, not 32 kHZ oscillator modes.
Turning Clock doubler off reduces power consumption.
shortChipSelect Short Chip Select setting. Use SHORTCS_OFF, or SHORTCS_ON.
Note: When short chip select is on, make sure that interrupts are disabled during I/O operations. Turning Short Chip Select on may reduce power consumption. See the Rabbit processor manual for more information regarding chip selects and low power operation.
RETURN VALUE
0: valid parameter
-1: invalid parameter
LIBRARY low_power.lib
470 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
setjmp
int setjmp( jmp_buf env );
DESCRIPTION
Store the PC (program counter), SP (stack pointer) and other information about the current state into env. The saved information can be restored by executing longjmp().
Note: you cannot use setjmp() to move out of slice statements, costatements, or cofunctions.
Typical usage: switch (setjmp(e)) { case 0: f(); break; case 1:
// first time
// try to execute f(), may call longjmp()
// if we get here, f() was successful
// to get here, f() called longjmp()
/* do exception handling */ break; case 2:
...
// similar to above, but different exception code
} f() { g()
...
} g() {
...
longjmp(e,2); // exception code 2, jump to setjmp() statement,
// setjmp() returns 2, so execute
// case 2 in the switch statement
}
PARAMETERS env Information about the current state
RETURN VALUE
Returns zero if it is executed. After longjmp() is executed, the program counter, stack pointer and etc. are restored to the state when setjmp() was executed the first time. However, this time setjmp() returns whatever value is specified by the longjmp() statement.
LIBRARY
SYS.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
471
SetSerialTATxRValues
long SetSerialTATxRValues( long bps, char *divisor, int tatXr );
DESCRIPTION
Sets up the possibly shared serial timer (TATxR) resources required to achieve, as closely as possible, the requested serial bps rate. The algorithm attempts to find, when necessary and if possible, the lowest value for the TAT1R that will precisely produce the requested serial bps rate. For this reason, an application that requires the TAT1R to be shared should generally first set up its usage with (1) the most critical timer A1 cascade rate, or (2) the lowest timer A1 cascade rate. That is, consider setting up the most critical stage (PWM, servo, triac, ultra-precise serial rate, etc.) first, else set up the slowest usage (often, the lowest serial rate) first.
Note that this function provides no TATxR resource sharing protection for an application that uses any of the individual TATxR resources either directly or indirectly. For example, this function affords no protection to an application that sets a direct usage TAT7R timer interrupt and also opens serial port D such that TAT7R is used to set the serial data rate.
A run time error occurs if parameter(s) are invalid. Also, this function is not reentrant.
PARAMETERS bps divisor tatXr
The requested serial bits per second (BPS, baud) rate.
An optional pointer to the caller's serial timer divisor variable. If the caller is not interested in the actual serial timer (TATxR) divisor value that is set by this function, then NULL may be passed.
The TATxR for the serial timer whose value(s) are to be set. Use exactly one of the following macros:
• TAT4R for serial port A
• TAT5R for serial port B
• TAT6R for serial port C
• TAT7R for serial port D
• TAT2R for serial port E
• TAT3R for serial port F
RETURN VALUE
The actual serial rate BPS (baud) setting that was achieved.
LIBRARY sys.lib
SEE ALSO
472 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
SetVectExtern2000
unsigned SetVectExtern2000( int priority, void * isr );
DESCRIPTION
Sets up the external interrupt table vectors for external interrupts 0 and 1. This function should be used for Rabbit 2000 processors revision IQ2 due to a bug in the chip's interrupt handling.
(See Technical Note 301, “Rabbit 2000 Microprocessor Interrupt Issue,” on the Rabbit Semiconductor website for more information.)
Once this function is called, both external interrupts 0 and 1 should be enabled with priority levels set higher than any currently running interrupts. (All system interrupts in the BIOS run at interrupt priority 1.) The interrupt priority is set via the control register I0CR for external interrupt 0 and I1CR for external interrupt 1.
The actual priority used by the interrupt service routine (ISR) is passed to this function.
PARAMETERS priority isr
Priority the ISR should run at. Valid values are 1, 2 or 3.
ISR handler address. Must be a root address.
RETURN VALUE
Address of vector table entry, or zero if priority is not valid.
LIBRARY
SYS.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
473
SetVectExtern3000
unsigned SetVectExtern3000( int interruptNum, void * isr );
DESCRIPTION
Function to set one of the external interrupt jump table entries for the Rabbit 3000 and some versions of the Rabbit 2000. All Rabbit interrupts use jump vectors. See SetVectIntern() for more information.
PARAMETERS interruptNum External interrupt number. 0 and 1 are the only valid values.
isr ISR handler address. Must be a root address.
RETURN VALUE
Jump address in vector table.
LIBRARY
SYS.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
474 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
SetVectExtern4000
unsigned SetVectExtern4000( int interruptNum, void * isr );
DESCRIPTION
Function to set one of the external interrupt jump table entries for the Rabbit 4000, Rabbit 3000 and some versions of the Rabbit 2000. All Rabbit interrupts use jump vectors. See
SetVectIntern() for more information.
PARAMETERS interruptNum External interrupt number. 0 and 1 are the only valid values.
isr ISR handler address. Must be a root address.
RETURN VALUE
Jump address in vector table.
LIBRARY
SYS.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
475
SetVectIntern
unsigned SetVectIntern( int vectNum, void * isr );
DESCRIPTION
Sets an internal interrupt table entry. All Rabbit interrupts use jump vectors. This function writes a jp instruction (0xC3) followed by the 16 bit ISR address to the appropriate location in the vector table. The location in RAM of the vector table is determined and set by the BIOS automatically at startup. The start of the table is always on a 0x100 boundary.
It is perfectly permissible to have ISRs in xmem and do long jumps to them from the vector table. It is even possible to place the entire body of the ISR in the vector table if it is 16 bytes long or less, but this function only sets up jumps to 16 bit addresses.
The following table shows the vectNum value for each peripheral or RST. The offset into the vector table is also shown. The following vectors are valid for all Rabbit processors.
Peripheral or RST
Periodic interrupt
RST 10 instruction
RST 38 instruction
Slave Port
Timer A
Timer B
Serial Port A
Serial Port B
Serial Port C
Serial Port D vectNum
0x00
0x02
0x07
0x08
0x0A
0x0B
0x0C
0x0D
0x0E
0x0F
Vector Table Offset
0x00
0x20
0x70
0x80
0xA0
0xB0
0xC0
0xD0
0xE0
0xF0
The following vectors are valid starting with the Rabbit 3000.
Peripheral or RST
Input Capture
Quadrature Encoder
Serial port E
Serial port F vectNum
0x1A
0x19
0x1C
0x1D
Vector Table Offset
0x01A0
0x0190
0x01C0
0x01D0
476 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
SetVectIntern (cont’d)
The following vectors are valid starting with the Rabbit 3000 Revision 1.
Peripheral or RST
Pulse Width Modulator
Secondary Watchdog vectNum
0x17
0x01
Vector Table Offset
0x0170
0x10
The following vectors are valid starting with the Rabbit 4000.
Peripheral or RST
Timer C
Network Port A vectNum
0x1F
0x1E
Vector Table Offset
0x01F0
0x01E0
The following three RSTs are included for completeness, but should not be set by the user as they are used by Dynamic C.
Peripheral or RST
RST 18 instruction
RST 20 instruction
RST 28 instruction vectNum
0x03
0x04
0x05
Vector Table Offset
0x30
0x40
0x50
PARAMETERS vectNum isr
Interrupt number. See the above table for valid values.
ISR handler address. Must be a root address.
RETURN VALUE
Address of vector table entry, or zero if vectNum is not valid.
LIBRARY
SYS.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
477
sf_getPageCount
long sf_getPageCount( sf_device * dev );
DESCRIPTION
Return number of pages in a flash device.
PARAMETER dev Pointer to sf_device struct for initialized flash device.
RETURN VALUE
Number of pages.
LIBRARY
SFLASH.LIB
sf_getPageSize
unsigned int sf_getPageSize( sf_device * dev );
DESCRIPTION
Return size (in bytes) of a page on the current flash device.
PARAMETER dev Pointer to sf_device struct for initialized flash device.
RETURN VALUE
Bytes in a page.
LIBRARY
SFLASH.LIB
478 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
sf_init
int sf_init( void );
DESCRIPTION
Initializes serial flash chip. This function must be called before the serial flash can be used. Currently supported devices are:
• AT45DB041
• AT45DB081
• AT45DB642
• AR45DB1282
Note: This function blocks and only works on boards with one serial flash device.
RETURN VALUE
0 for success
-1 if no flash chip detected
-2 if error communicating with flash chip
-3 if unknown flash chip type
LIBRARY
SFLASH.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
479
sf_initDevice
int sf_initDevice( sf_device * dev, int cs_port, char * cs_shadow, int cs_pin );
DESCRIPTION
Replaces sf_init().
The function sfspi_init() must be called before any calls to this function. Initializes serial flash chip. This function must be called before the serial flash can be used. Currently supported devices are:
• AT45DB041
• AT45DB081
• AT45DB642
• AR45DB1282
PARAMETERS dev cs_port cs_shadow cs_pin
Pointer to an empty sf_device struct that will be filled in on return. The struct will then act as a handle for the device.
I/O port for the active low chip select pin for the device.
Pointer to the shadow variable for cs_port.
I/O port pin number for the chip select signal.
RETURN VALUE
0 for success
-1if no flash chip detected
-2 if error communicating with flash chip
-3 if unknown flash chip type
LIBRARY
SFLASH.LIB
480 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
sf_isWriting
int sf_isWriting( sf_device * dev );
DESCRIPTION
Returns 1 if the flash device is busy writing to a page.
PARAMETER dev Pointer to sf_device struct for initialized flash device
RETURN VALUE
1 busy
0 ready, not currently writing
LIBRARY
SFLASH.LIB
sf_pageToRAM
int sf_pageToRAM( long page );
DESCRIPTION
Command the serial flash to copy the contents of one of its flash pages into its RAM buffer.
Note: This function blocks and only works on boards with one serial flash device.
PARAMETER page The page to copy.
RETURN VALUE
0 for success
-1 for error
LIBRARY
SFLASH.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
481
sf_RAMToPage
int sf_RAMToPage( long page );
DESCRIPTION
Command the serial flash to write its RAM buffer contents to one of the flash memory pages.
Note: This function blocks and only works on boards with one serial flash device.
PARAMETER page The page to which the RAM buffer contents will be written t
RETURN VALUE
0 for success
-1 for error
LIBRARY
SFLASH.LIB
482 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
sf_readDeviceRAM
int sf_readDeviceRAM( sf_device * dev, long buffer, int offset, int len, int flags );
DESCRIPTION
Read data from the RAM buffer on the serial flash chip into an xmem buffer.
PARAMETERS dev buffer offset len flags
Pointer to sf_device struct for initialized flash device.
Address of an xmem buffer.
The address in the serial flash RAM to start reading from.
The number of bytes to read.
Can be one of the following:
SF_BITSREVERSED - Reads the data in bit reversed order from the flash chip. This improves speed, but the data must have been also written in reversed order (see sf_XWriteRAM)
SF_RAMBANK1 (default) - Reads from the first RAM bank on the flash device
SF_RAMBANK2 - Reads from the alternate RAM bank on the flash device
RETURN VALUE
0: Success
-1: Error
LIBRARY
SFLASH.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
483
sf_readPage
int sf_readPage( sf_device * dev, int bank, long page );
DESCRIPTION
Replaces sf_pageToRAM().
Command the serial flash to copy from one of its flash pages to one of its RAM buffers.
PARAMETERS dev bank page
Pointer to sf_device struct for initialized flash device.
Which RAM bank to write the data to. For Atmel 45DBxxx devices, this can be 1 or 2.
The page to read from.
RETURN VALUE
0: Success
-1: Error
LIBRARY
SFLASH.LIB
484 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
sf_readRAM
int sf_readRAM( char * buffer, int offset, int len );
DESCRIPTION
Read data from the RAM buffer on the serial flash chip.
Note: This function blocks and only works on boards with one serial flash device.
PARAMETER buffer offset len
Pointer to character buffer to copy data into.
Address in the serial flash RAM to start reading from
Number of bytes to read
RETURN VALUE
0: Success
-1: Error
LIBRARY
SFLASH.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
485
sf_writeDeviceRAM
int sf_writeDeviceRAM( sf_device * dev, long buffer, int offset, int len, int flags );
DESCRIPTION
Write data to the RAM buffer on the serial flash chip from a buffer in xmem.
PARAMETER dev buffer offset len flags
Pointer to sf_device struct for initialized flash device.
Pointer to xmem data to write into the flash chip RAM.
The address in the serial flash RAM to start writing at.
The number of bytes to write.
Can be one of the following:
• SF_BITSREVERSED - Allows the data to be written to the flash in reverse bit order. This improves speed, and works fine as long as the data is read back out with this same flag.
Ignored on R4000 based cores, but reserved for legacy code support.
• SF_RAMBANK1 (default) - Writes to the first RAM bank on the flash device
• SF_RAMBANK2 - Writes to the alternate RAM bank on the flash device
RETURN VALUE
0: Success
-1: Error
LIBRARY
SFLASH.LIB
486 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
sf_writePage
int sf_writePage( sf_device * dev, int bank, long page );
DESCRIPTION
Replaces sf_RAMToPage().
Command the serial flash to write its RAM buffer contents to one of its flash memory pages.
Check for completion of the write operation using sf_isWriting().
PARAMETERS dev bank page
Pointer to sf_device struct for initialized flash device.
Which RAM bank to write the data from. For Atmel 45DBxxx devices, this can be 1 or 2
The page to write the RAM buffer to
RETURN VALUE
0: Success
-1: Error
LIBRARY
SFLASH.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
487
sf_writeRAM
int sf_writeRAM( char * buffer, int offset, int len );
DESCRIPTION
Write data to the RAM buffer on the serial flash chip.
Note: This function blocks and only works on boards with one serial flash device.
PARAMETER buffer offset len
Pointer to data that will be written the flash chip RAM.
Address in the serial flash RAM to start writing at.
Number of bytes to write.
RETURN VALUE
0 for success
-1 for error
LIBRARY
SFLASH.LIB
sfspi_init
int sfspi_init( void );
DESCRIPTION
Initialize SPI driver for use with serial flash. This must be called before any calls to sf_initDevice() .
RETURN VALUE
0 for success
-1 for error
LIBRARY
SFLASH.LIB
488 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
sin
float sin ( float x );
DESCRIPTION
Computes the sine of x.
Note: The Dynamic C functions deg() and
rad() convert radians and degrees.
PARAMETERS x Angle in radians.
RETURN VALUE
Sine of x.
LIBRARY
MATH.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
sinh
float sinh( float x );
DESCRIPTION
Computes the hyperbolic sine of x. This functions takes a unitless number as a parameter and returns a unitless number.
PARAMETERS x Value to compute.
RETURN VALUE
The hyperbolic sine of x.
If x > 89.8 (approx.), the function returns INF and signals a range error. If x
89.8 (approx.), the function returns –INF and signals a range error.
LIBRARY
MATH.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
489
snprintf
int snprintf( char * buffer, int len, char * format, ... );
DESCRIPTION
This function takes a string (pointed to by format), arguments of the format, and outputs the formatted string to the buffer pointed to by buffer. snprintf() will only output up to len characters. The user should make sure that:
• there are enough arguments after format to fill in the format parameters in the format string
• the types of arguments after format match the format fields in format
For example, snprintf(buffer, BUF_LEN, "%s=%x","variable x",256); puts the string “variable x=100” into buffer.
A complete list of valid conversion specifiers (%d, %s, etc.) can be found in the description for printf()
under Dynamic C Conversion Specifiers
.
The macro STDIO_DISABLE_FLOATS can be defined if it is not necessary to format floating point numbers. If this macro is defined, %e, %f and %g will not be recognized. This can save thousands of bytes of code space.
This function can be called by processes of different priorities.
PARAMETERS buffer len format
...
Location of formatted string.
The maximum length of the formatted string.
String to be formatted.
Format arguments.
RETURN VALUE
The number of characters written. If the output is truncated due to the len parameter, then this function returns the number of characters that would have been written had there been enough space.
LIBRARY
STDIO.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
490 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
SPIinit
void SPIinit( void );
DESCRIPTION
Initialize the SPI port parameters for a serial interface only. This function does nothing for a parallel interface. A description of the values that the user may define before the #use SPI.LIB statement is found at the top of the library Lib\Spi\Spi.lib.
LIBRARY
SPI.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
491
SPIRead
void SPIRead( void * DestAddr, int ByteCount );
DESCRIPTION
Reads a block of bytes from the SPI port. The variable SPIxor needs to be set to either 0x00 or 0xFF depending on whether or not the received signal needs to be inverted. Most applications will not need inversion. SPIinit() sets the value of SPIxor to 0x00.
If SPI_SLAVE_RDY_PORT is defined for a slave device the driver will turn on the bit immediately upon activating the receiver. It will then wait for a byte to become available then turn off the bit. The byte will not be available until the master supplies the 8 clock pulses.
If SPI_SLAVE_RDY_PORT is defined for a master device the driver will wait for the bit to become true before activating the receiver and then wait for it to become false after receiving the byte.
Note for Master: the receiving device Chip Select must already be active
PARAMETERS
DestAddr
ByteCount
Address to store the data
Number of bytes to read
RETURN VALUE
Master: none.
Slave: 0 = no CS signal, no received bytes.
1 = CS, bytes received.
LIBRARY
SPI.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
492 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
SPIWrite
int SPIWrite( void * SrcAddr, int ByteCount );
DESCRIPTION
Write a block of bytes to the SPI port.
If SPI_SLAVE_RDY_PORT is defined for a slave device the driver will turn on the bit immediately after loading the transmit register. It will then wait for the buffer to become available then turn off the bit. The buffer will not become available until the master supplies the first clock.
If SPI_SLAVE_RDY_PORT is defined for a master device the driver will wait for the bit to become true before transmitting the byte and then wait for it to become false after transmitting the byte.
Note for Master: the receiving device Chip Select must already be active.
PARAMETERS
SrcAddr
ByteCount
Address of data to write.
Number of bytes to write.
RETURN VALUE
Master: none.
Slave: 0 = no CS signal, no transmitted bytes.
1 = CS, bytes transmitted.
LIBRARY
SPI.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
493
SPIWrRd
void SPIWrRd( void * SrcAddr, void * DstAddr, int ByteCount );
DESCRIPTION
Read and Write a block of bytes from/to the SPI port.
Note for Master: the receiving device Chip Select must already be active.
PARAMETERS
SrcAddr
DstAddr
ByteCount
Address of data to write.
Address to put received data.
Number of bytes to read/write. The maximum value is 255 bytes. This limit is not checked! The receive buffer MUST be at least as large as the number of bytes!
RETURN VALUE
Master: none.
Slave: 0 = no CS signal, no received/transmitted bytes.
1 = CS, bytes received/transmitted.
LIBRARY
SPI.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
494 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
sprintf
int sprintf( char * buffer, char * format, ... );
DESCRIPTION
This function takes a string (pointed to by format), arguments of the format, and outputs the formatted string to buffer (pointed to by buffer). The user should make sure that:
• there are enough arguments after format to fill in the format parameters in the format string
• the types of arguments after format match the format fields in format
• the buffer is large enough to hold the longest possible formatted string
The following is a short list of valid conversion specifiers in the format string. For a complete
list of conversion specifiers, refer to the function description for printf()
.
%d decimal integer (expects type int)
%u decimal unsigned integer (expects type unsigned int)
%x hexadecimal integer (expects type signed int or unsigned int)
%s a string (not interpreted, expects type (char *))
%f a float (expects type float)
For example, sprintf(buffer,"%s = %x","variable x",256); puts the string “variable x = 100” into buffer.
The macro STDIO_DISABLE_FLOATS can be defined if it is not necessary to format floating point numbers. If this macro is defined, %e, %f and %g will not be recognized. This can save thousands of bytes of code space.
This function can be called by processes of different priorities.
PARAMETERS buffer format
...
Result string of the formatted string.
String to be formatted.
Format arguments.
RETURN VALUE
Number of characters written.
LIBRARY
STDIO.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
495
float sqrt( float x );
DESCRIPTION
Calculate the square root of x.
PARAMETERS x
RETURN VALUE
The square root of x.
Value to compute.
LIBRARY
MATH.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
sqrt srand
void srand( unsigned long seed );
DESCRIPTION
Sets the seed value for the rand() function.
PARAMETER seed This must be an odd number.
LIBRARY
MATH.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
496 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
strcat
NEAR SYNTAX: char * _n_strcat( char * dst, char * src );
FAR SYNTAX: char far * _f_strcat( char far * dst, char far * src );
Note: By default, strcat() is defined to _n_strcat().
DESCRIPTION
Concatenate string src to the end of dst.
For Rabbit 4000+ users, this function supports FAR pointers. By default the near version of the function is called. The macro USE_FAR_STRING will change all calls to functions in this library to their far versions. The user may also explicitly call the far version with _f_strfunc where strfunc is the name of the string function.
Because FAR addresses are larger, the far versions of this function will run slightly slower than the near version. To explicitly call the near version when the USE_FAR_STRING macro is defined and all pointers are near pointers, append _n_ to the function name, e.g., _n_strfunc.
For more information about FAR pointers, see the Dynamic C User’s Manual or the samples in
Samples/Rabbit4000/FAR/ .
PARAMETERS dst src
Pointer to location to destination string.
Pointer to location to source string.
RETURN VALUE
Pointer to destination string.
LIBRARY
STRING.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
497
strchr
NEAR SYNTAX: char * _n_strchr( char * src, char ch );
FAR SYNTAX: char far * _f_strchr( char far * src, char ch );
Note: By default, strchr() is defined to _n_strchr().
DESCRIPTION
Scans a string for the first occurrence of a given character.
For Rabbit 4000+ users, this function supports FAR pointers. By default the near version of the function is called. The macro USE_FAR_STRING will change all calls to functions in this library to their far versions. The user may also explicitly call the far version with _f_strfunc where strfunc is the name of the string function.
Because FAR addresses are larger, the far versions of this function will run slightly slower than the near version. To explicitly call the near version when the USE_FAR_STRING macro is defined and all pointers are near pointers, append _n_ to the function name, e.g., _n_strfunc.
For more information about FAR pointers, see the Dynamic C User’s Manual or the samples in
Samples/Rabbit4000/FAR/ .
PARAMETERS src ch
String to be scanned.
Character to search
RETURN VALUE
Pointer to the first occurrence of ch in src.
Null if ch is not found.
LIBRARY
STRING.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
498 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
strcmp
NEAR SYNTAX: int _n_strcmp( char * str1, char * str2 );
FAR SYNTAX: int _f_strcmp( char far * str1, char far * str2 );
Note: By default, strcmp() is defined to _n_strcmp().
DESCRIPTION
Performs unsigned character by character comparison of two null terminated strings.
For Rabbit 4000+ users, this function supports FAR pointers. By default the near version of the function is called. The macro USE_FAR_STRING will change all calls to functions in this library to their far versions. The user may also explicitly call the far version with _f_strfunc where strfunc is the name of the string function.
Because FAR addresses are larger, the far versions of this function will run slightly slower than the near version. To explicitly call the near version when the USE_FAR_STRING macro is defined and all pointers are near pointers, append _n_ to the function name, e.g., _n_strfunc.
For more information about FAR pointers, see the Dynamic C User’s Manual or the samples in
Samples/Rabbit4000/FAR/ .
PARAMETERS str1 str2
Pointer to string 1.
Pointer to string 2.
RETURN VALUE
<0 : str1 is less than str2 because character in str1 is less than corresponding character in str2, or str1 is shorter than but otherwise identical to str2.
=0 : str1 is identical to str2
>0 : str1 is greater than str2 because character in str1 is greater than corresponding character in str2, or str2 is shorter than but otherwise identical to str1.
LIBRARY
STRING.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
499
strcmpi
NEAR SYNTAX: int * _n_strcmpi( char * str1, char * str2 );
FAR SYNTAX: int _f_strcmpi( char far * str1, char far * str2 );
Note: By default, strcmpi() is defined to _n_strcmpi().
DESCRIPTION
Performs case-insensitive unsigned character by character comparison of two null terminated strings.
For Rabbit 4000+ users, this function supports FAR pointers. By default the near version of the function is called. The macro USE_FAR_STRING will change all calls to functions in this library to their far versions. The user may also explicitly call the far version with _f_strfunc where strfunc is the name of the string function.
Because FAR addresses are larger, the far versions of this function will run slightly slower than the near version. To explicitly call the near version when the USE_FAR_STRING macro is defined and all pointers are near pointers, append _n_ to the function name, e.g., _n_strfunc.
For more information about FAR pointers, see the Dynamic C User’s Manual or the samples in
Samples/Rabbit4000/FAR/ .
PARAMETERS str1 str2
Pointer to string 1.
Pointer to string 2.
RETURN VALUE
<0 : str1 is less than str2 because character in str1 is less than corresponding character in str2, or str1 is shorter than but otherwise identical to str2.
=0 : str1 is identical to str2
>0 : str1 is greater than str2 because character in str1 is greater than corresponding character in str2, or str2 is shorter than but otherwise identical to str1.
LIBRARY
STRING.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
500 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
strcpy
NEAR SYNTAX: char * _n_strcpy( char * dst, char * src );
FAR SYNTAX: char far * _f_strcpy( char far * dst, char far * src );
Note: By default, strcpy() is defined to _n_strcpy().
DESCRIPTION
Copies one string into another string, including the null terminator.
For Rabbit 4000+ users, this function supports FAR pointers. By default the near version of the function is called. The macro USE_FAR_STRING will change all calls to functions in this library to their far versions. The user may also explicitly call the far version with _f_strfunc where strfunc is the name of the string function.
Because FAR addresses are larger, the far versions of this function will run slightly slower than the near version. To explicitly call the near version when the USE_FAR_STRING macro is defined and all pointers are near pointers, append _n_ to the function name, e.g., _n_strfunc.
For more information about FAR pointers, see the Dynamic C User’s Manual or the samples in
Samples/Rabbit4000/FAR/ .
PARAMETERS dst src
Pointer to location to receive string.
Pointer to location to supply string.
RETURN VALUE
Pointer to destination string.
LIBRARY
STRING.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
501
strcspn
NEAR SYNTAX: unsigned int _n_strcspn( char * s1, char * s2 );
FAR SYNTAX: size_t _f_strcspn( char far * s1, char far * s2 );
Note: By default, strcspn() is defined to _n_strcpsn().
DESCRIPTION
Scans a string for the occurrence of any of the characters in another string.
For Rabbit 4000+ users, this function supports FAR pointers. By default the near version of the function is called. The macro USE_FAR_STRING will change all calls to functions in this library to their far versions. The user may also explicitly call the far version with _f_strfunc where strfunc is the name of the string function.
Because FAR addresses are larger, the far versions of this function will run slightly slower than the near version. To explicitly call the near version when the USE_FAR_STRING macro is defined and all pointers are near pointers, append _n_ to the function name, e.g., _n_strfunc.
For more information about FAR pointers, see the Dynamic C User’s Manual or the samples in
Samples/Rabbit4000/FAR/ .
PARAMETERS s1 s2
String to be scanned.
Character occurrence string.
RETURN VALUE
Returns the position (less one) of the first occurrence of a character in s1 that matches any character in s2.
LIBRARY
STRING.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
502 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
strlen
NEAR SYNTAX: int _n_strlen( char * s );
FAR SYNTAX: int _f_strlen( char far * s );
Note: By default, strlen() is defined to _n_strlen().
DESCRIPTION
Calculate the length of a string.
For Rabbit 4000+ users, this function supports FAR pointers. By default the near version of the function is called. The macro USE_FAR_STRING will change all calls to functions in this library to their far versions. The user may also explicitly call the far version with _f_strfunc where strfunc is the name of the string function.
Because FAR addresses are larger, the far versions of this function will run slightly slower than the near version. To explicitly call the near version when the USE_FAR_STRING macro is defined and all pointers are near pointers, append _n_ to the function name, e.g., _n_strfunc.
For more information about FAR pointers, see the Dynamic C User’s Manual or the samples in
Samples/Rabbit4000/FAR/ .
PARAMETERS s Character string.
RETURN VALUE
Number of bytes in a string.
LIBRARY
STRING.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
503
strncat
NEAR SYNTAX: char *_n_strncat( char *dst, char *src, unsigned int n );
FAR SYNTAX: char far * _f_strncat( char far * dst, char far * src, size_t n );
Note: By default, strncat() is defined to _n_strncat().
DESCRIPTION
Appends one string to another up to and including the null terminator or until n characters are transferred, followed by a null terminator.
For Rabbit 4000+ users, this function supports FAR pointers. By default the near version of the function is called. The macro USE_FAR_STRING will change all calls to functions in this library to their far versions. The user may also explicitly call the far version with _f_strfunc where strfunc is the name of the string function.
Because FAR addresses are larger, the far versions of this function will run slightly slower than the near version. To explicitly call the near version when the USE_FAR_STRING macro is defined and all pointers are near pointers, append _n_ to the function name, e.g., _n_strfunc.
For more information about FAR pointers, see the Dynamic C User’s Manual or the samples in
Samples/Rabbit4000/FAR/ .
PARAMETERS dst src n
Pointer to location to receive string.
Pointer to location to supply string.
Maximum number of bytes to copy. If equal to zero, this function has no effect.
RETURN VALUE
Pointer to destination string.
LIBRARY
STRING.LIB
SEE ALSO
504 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
strncmp
NEAR SYNTAX: int _n_strncmp( char * str1, char * str2, n );
FAR SYNTAX: int _f_strncmp( char far * str1, char far * str2, unsigned n );
Note: By default, strncmp() is defined to _n_strncmp().
DESCRIPTION
Performs unsigned character by character comparison of two strings of length n.
For Rabbit 4000+ users, this function supports FAR pointers. By default the near version of the function is called. The macro USE_FAR_STRING will change all calls to functions in this library to their far versions. The user may also explicitly call the far version with _f_strfunc where strfunc is the name of the string function.
Because FAR addresses are larger, the far versions of this function will run slightly slower than the near version. To explicitly call the near version when the USE_FAR_STRING macro is defined and all pointers are near pointers, append _n_ to the function name, e.g., _n_strfunc.
For more information about FAR pointers, see the Dynamic C User’s Manual or the samples in
Samples/Rabbit4000/FAR/ .
PARAMETERS str1 str2 n
Pointer to string 1.
Pointer to string 2.
Maximum number of bytes to compare. If zero, both strings are considered equal.
RETURN VALUE
<0 : str1 is less than str2 because char in str1 is less than corresponding char in str2.
=0 : str1 is identical to str2
>0 : str1 is greater than str2 because char in str1 is greater than corresponding char in str2.
LIBRARY
STRING.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
505
strncmpi
NEAR SYNTAX: int _n_strncmpi( char * str1, char * str2, unsigned n );
FAR SYNTAX: int _f_strncmpi( char far * str1, char far * str2, unsigned n );
Note: By default, strncmpi() is defined to _n_strncmpi().
DESCRIPTION
Performs case-insensitive unsigned character by character comparison of two strings of length n .
For Rabbit 4000+ users, this function supports FAR pointers. By default the near version of the function is called. The macro USE_FAR_STRING will change all calls to functions in this library to their far versions. The user may also explicitly call the far version with _f_strfunc where strfunc is the name of the string function.
Because FAR addresses are larger, the far versions of this function will run slightly slower than the near version. To explicitly call the near version when the USE_FAR_STRING macro is defined and all pointers are near pointers, append _n_ to the function name, e.g., _n_strfunc.
For more information about FAR pointers, see the Dynamic C User’s Manual or the samples in
Samples/Rabbit4000/FAR/ .
PARAMETERS str1 str2 n
Pointer to string 1.
Pointer to string 2.
Maximum number of bytes to compare, if zero then strings are considered equal
RETURN VALUE
<0 : str1 is less than str2 because char in str1 is less than corresponding char in str2.
=0 : str1 is identical to str2
>0 : str1 is greater than str2 because char in str1 is greater than corresponding char in str2.
LIBRARY
STRING.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
506 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
strncpy
NEAR SYNTAX: char *_n_strncpy( char *dst, char *src, unsigned int n );
FAR SYNTAX: char far * _f_strncpy( char far * dst, char far * src, size_t n );
Note: By default, strncpy() is defined to _n_strncpy().
DESCRIPTION
Copies a given number of characters from one string to another and padding with null characters or truncating as necessary.
For Rabbit 4000+ users, this function supports FAR pointers. By default the near version of the function is called. The macro USE_FAR_STRING will change all calls to functions in this library to their far versions. The user may also explicitly call the far version with _f_strfunc where strfunc is the name of the string function.
Because FAR addresses are larger, the far versions of this function will run slightly slower than the near version. To explicitly call the near version when the USE_FAR_STRING macro is defined and all pointers are near pointers, append _n_ to the function name, e.g., _n_strfunc.
For more information about FAR pointers, see the Dynamic C User’s Manual or the samples in
Samples/Rabbit4000/FAR/ .
PARAMETERS dst src n
Pointer to location to receive string.
Pointer to location to supply string.
Maximum number of bytes to copy. If equal to zero, this function has no effect.
RETURN VALUE
Pointer to destination string.
LIBRARY
STRING.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
507
strpbrk
NEAR SYNTAX: char * _n_strpbrk( char * s1, char * s2 );
FAR SYNTAX: char far * _f_strpbrk( char far * s1, char far * s2 );
Note: By default, strpbrk() is defined to _n_strpbrk().
DESCRIPTION
Scans a string for the first occurrence of any character from another string.
For Rabbit 4000+ users, this function supports FAR pointers. By default the near version of the function is called. The macro USE_FAR_STRING will change all calls to functions in this library to their far versions. The user may also explicitly call the far version with _f_strfunc where strfunc is the name of the string function.
Because FAR addresses are larger, the far versions of this function will run slightly slower than the near version. To explicitly call the near version when the USE_FAR_STRING macro is defined and all pointers are near pointers, append _n_ to the function name, e.g., _n_strfunc.
For more information about FAR pointers, see the Dynamic C User’s Manual or the samples in
Samples/Rabbit4000/FAR/ .
PARAMETERS s1 s2
String to be scanned.
Character occurrence string.
RETURN VALUE
Pointer pointing to the first occurrence of a character contained in s2 in s1. Returns null if not found.
LIBRARY
STRING.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
508 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
strrchr
NEAR SYNTAX: char * _n_strrchr( char * s, int c );
FAR SYNTAX: char far * _f_strrchr( char far * s, int c );
Note: By default, strrchr() is defined to _n_strrchr().
DESCRIPTION
Similar to strchr, except this function searches backward from the end of s to the beginning.
For Rabbit 4000+ users, this function supports FAR pointers. By default the near version of the function is called. The macro USE_FAR_STRING will change all calls to functions in this library to their far versions. The user may also explicitly call the far version with _f_strfunc where strfunc is the name of the string function.
Because FAR addresses are larger, the far versions of this function will run slightly slower than the near version. To explicitly call the near version when the USE_FAR_STRING macro is defined and all pointers are near pointers, append _n_ to the function name, e.g., _n_strfunc.
For more information about FAR pointers, see the Dynamic C User’s Manual or the samples in
Samples/Rabbit4000/FAR/ .
PARAMETERS s c
String to be searched
Search character
RETURN VALUE
Pointer to last occurrence of c in s. If c is not found in s, return null.
LIBRARY
STRING.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
509
strspn
NEAR SYNTAX: size_t _n_strspn( char * src, char * brk );
FAR SYNTAX: size_t _f_strspn( char far * src, char far * brk );
Note: By default, strspn() is defined to _n_strspn().
DESCRIPTION
Scans a string for the first segment in src containing only characters specified in brk.
For Rabbit 4000+ users, this function supports FAR pointers. By default the near version of the function is called. The macro USE_FAR_STRING will change all calls to functions in this library to their far versions. The user may also explicitly call the far version with _f_strfunc where strfunc is the name of the string function.
Because FAR addresses are larger, the far versions of this function will run slightly slower than the near version. To explicitly call the near version when the USE_FAR_STRING macro is defined and all pointers are near pointers, append _n_ to the function name, e.g., _n_strfunc.
For more information about FAR pointers, see the Dynamic C User’s Manual or the samples in
Samples/Rabbit4000/FAR/ .
PARAMETERS src brk
String to be scanned
Set of characters
RETURN VALUE
Returns the length of the segment.
LIBRARY
STRING.LIB
510 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
strstr
NEAR SYNTAX: char * _n_strstr( char *s1, char *s2 );
FAR SYNTAX: char far * _f_strstr( char far * s1, char far * s2 );
Note: By default, strstr() is defined to _n_strstr().
DESCRIPTION
Finds a substring specified by s2 in string s1.
For Rabbit 4000+ users, this function supports FAR pointers. By default the near version of the function is called. The macro USE_FAR_STRING will change all calls to functions in this library to their far versions. The user may also explicitly call the far version with _f_strfunc where strfunc is the name of the string function.
Because FAR addresses are larger, the far versions of this function will run slightly slower than the near version. To explicitly call the near version when the USE_FAR_STRING macro is defined and all pointers are near pointers, append _n_ to the function name, e.g., _n_strfunc.
For more information about FAR pointers, see the Dynamic C User’s Manual or the samples in
Samples/Rabbit4000/FAR/ .
PARAMETERS s1 s2
String to be scanned.
Substring to search for.
RETURN VALUE
Pointer to the first occurrence of substring s2 in s1. Returns null if s2 is not found in s1.
LIBRARY
STRING.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
511
strtod
NEAR SYNTAX: float _n_strtod( char * s, char ** tailptr );
FAR SYNTAX: float _f_strtod( char far * s, char far * far * tailptr );
Note: By default, strtod() is defined to _n_strtod().
DESCRIPTION
ANSI string to float conversion.
For Rabbit 4000+ users, this function supports FAR pointers. The macro USE_FAR_STRING will change all calls to functions in this library to their far versions by default. The user may also explicitly call the far version with _f_strfunc, where strfunc is the name of the string function.
Because FAR addresses are larger, the far versions of this function will run slightly slower than the near version. To explicitly call the near version when the USE_FAR_STRING macro is defined and all pointers are near pointers, append _n_ to the function name, e.g. _n_strtod.
For more information about FAR pointers, see th Dynamic C User’s Manual or the samples in
Samples/Rabbit4000/FAR/ .
Warning: The far version of strtod is not backwards compatible with near pointers due to the use of a double pointer. The problem is that char ** tailptr is a 16-bit pointer pointing to another 16-bit pointer. The far version, char far * far * tailptr, is a 32-bit pointer pointing to a 32-bit pointer. If you pass a double near pointer as the argument to the double far pointer function, the double dereference (**tailptr) of the double pointer will attempt to access a 32-bit address pointed to by the passed near pointer. The compiler does not know the contents of a pointer and will assume the inner pointer is a 32-bit pointer. For more information about FAR pointers, please see the Dynamic C User’s Man-
ual.
512 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
strtod (cont’d)
In the following examples:
[ ] = 1 byte
[ ][ ][x][x] indicates a NEAR address (16 bit) upcast to FAR
Passing a “char far * far * ptr” as tailptr:
ADDRESS:
[ ][ ][x][x]
[y][y][y][y]
[z][z][z][z]
DATA:
[y][y][y][y] (tailptr)
[z][z][z][z] (*tailptr)
[Correct contents] (**tailptr)
Passing a 'char ** ptr' as tailptr: Note the first pointer can be upcast to FAR but the compiler doesn't know to upcast the internal pointer.
ADDRESS:
[ ][ ][x][x]
[ ][ ][y][y]
[?][?][z][z]
DATA:
[ ][ ][y][y] (tailptr)
[?][?][z][z] (*tailptr)
[Incorrect contents] (**tailptr)
PARAMETERS s tailptr
String to convert.
Pointer to a pointer of character. The next conversion may resume at the location specified by *tailptr.
RETURN VALUE
The float number represented by “s.”
LIBRARY
STRING.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
513
strtok
NEAR SYNTAX: char * _n_strtok( char * src, char * brk );
FAR SYNTAX: char far * _f_strtok( char far * src, char far * brk );
Note: By default, strtok() is defined to _n_strtok().
DESCRIPTION
Scans src for tokens separated by delimiter characters specified in brk.
First call with non-null for src. Subsequent calls with null for src continue to search tokens in the string. If a token is found (i.e., delineators found), replace the first delimiter in src with a null terminator so that src points to a proper null terminated token.
PARAMETERS src brk
String to be scanned, must be in SRAM, cannot be a constant. In contrast, strings initialized when they are declared are stored in flash memory, and are treated as constants.
Character delimiter.
RETURN VALUE
Pointer to a token. If no delimiter (therefore no token) is found, returns null.
LIBRARY
STRING.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
,
514 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
strtol
NEAR SYNTAX: long _n_strtol( char * sptr, char ** tailptr, int base );
FAR SYNTAX: long _f_strtol( char far *sptr, char far * far * tailptr, int base );
Note: By default, strtol() is defined to _n_strtol().
DESCRIPTION
ANSI string to long conversion.
For Rabbit 4000+ users, this function supports FAR pointers. The macro USE_FAR_STRING will change all calls to functions in this library to their far versions by default. The user may also explicitly call the far version with _f_strfunc, where strfunc is the name of the string function.
Because FAR addresses are larger, the far versions of this function will run slightly slower than the near version. To explicitly call the near version when the USE_FAR_STRING macro is defined and all pointers are near pointers, append _n_ to the function name, e.g. _n_strtod.
For more information about FAR pointers, see th Dynamic C User’s Manual or the samples in
Samples/Rabbit4000/FAR/ .
Warning: The far version of strtod is not backwards compatible with near pointers due to the use of a double pointer. The problem is that char ** tailptr is a 16-bit pointer pointing to another 16-bit pointer. The far version, char far * far * tailptr, is a 32-bit pointer pointing to a 32-bit pointer. If you pass a double near pointer as the argument to the double far pointer function, the double dereference (**tailptr) of the double pointer will attempt to access a 32-bit address pointed to by the passed near pointer. The compiler does not know the contents of a pointer and will assume the inner pointer is a 32-bit pointer. For more information about FAR pointers, please see the Dynamic C User’s Man-
ual.
In the following examples:
[ ] = 1 byte
[ ][ ][x][x] indicates a NEAR address (16 bit) upcast to FAR
Passing a “char far * far * ptr” as tailptr:
ADDRESS:
[ ][ ][x][x]
[y][y][y][y]
[z][z][z][z]
DATA:
[y][y][y][y] (tailptr)
[z][z][z][z] (*tailptr)
[Correct contents] (**tailptr)
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
515
strtol (cont’d)
Passing a 'char ** ptr' as tailptr: Note the first pointer can be upcast to FAR but the compiler doesn't know to upcast the internal pointer.
ADDRESS:
[ ][ ][x][x]
[ ][ ][y][y]
[?][?][z][z]
DATA:
[ ][ ][y][y] (tailptr)
[?][?][z][z] (*tailptr)
[Incorrect contents] (**tailptr)
PARAMETERS sptr tailptr base
String to convert.
Assigned the last position of the conversion. The next conversion may resume at the location specified by *tailptr.
Indicates the radix of conversion.
RETURN VALUE
The long integer.
LIBRARY
STRING.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
516 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
_sysIsSoftReset
void _sysIsSoftReset( void );
DESCRIPTION
This function should be called at the start of a program if you are using protected variables. It determines whether this restart of the board is due to a software reset from Dynamic C or a call to forceSoftReset(). If it was a soft reset, this function then does the following:
• Calls _prot_init() to initialize the protected variable mechanisms. It is up to the user to initialize protected variables.
• Calls sysResetChain(). The user my attach functions to this chain to perform additional startup actions (for example, initializing protected variables). If a soft reset did not take place, this function calls _prot_recover() to recover any protected variables.
LIBRARY
SYS.LIB
SEE ALSO
sysResetChain
void sysResetChain ( void );
DESCRIPTION
This is a function chain that should be used to initialize protected variables. By default, it's empty.
LIBRARY
SYS.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
517
tan
float tan ( float x );
DESCRIPTION
Compute the tangent of the argument.
Note: The Dynamic C functions deg() and
rad() convert radians and degrees.
PARAMETERS x Angle in radians.
RETURN VALUE
Returns the tangent of x, where –8 × PI
x
+8 × PI. If x is out of bounds, the function returns
0 and signals a domain error. If the value of x is too close to a multiple of 90° (PI/2) the function returns INF and signals a range error.
LIBRARY
MATH.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
518 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
tanh
float tanh ( float x );
DESCRIPTION
Computes the hyperbolic tangent of argument. This functions takes a unitless number as a parameter and returns a unitless number.
PARAMETERS x Float to use in computation.
RETURN VALUE
Returns the hyperbolic tangent of x. If x > 49.9 (approx.), the function returns INF and signals a range error. If x
49.9 (approx.), the function returns –INF and signals a range error.
LIBRARY
MATH.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
519
TAT1R_SetValue
char TAT1R_SetValue( int requestor, int value );
DESCRIPTION
If not already in use, or if in a compatible use, allocates the TAT1R resource (sets a new or keeps the current TAT1R value) as requested. Also enables or disables the requestor's timer A1 cascade bit(s) in TACR or TBCR, as appropriate. When the timer B cascade from timer A1 is disabled in TBCR the timer B "clocked by PCLK/2" is then enabled.
A run time error occurs if parameter(s) are invalid and also, this function is not reentrant.
Note: This function does not attempt to manage interrupts that are associated with timers
A or B; that work is left entirely up to the application.
PARAMETERS requestor value
The requestor of the TAT1R resource. Use exactly one of the following macros to specify the appropriate requestor:
• TAT1R_A1TIMER_REQ (e.g., direct use of Timer A1)
• TAT1R_A2TIMER_REQ (e.g., use by serial port E)
• TAT1R_A3TIMER_REQ (e.g., use by serial port F)
• TAT1R_A4TIMER_REQ (e.g., use by serial port A)
• TAT1R_A5TIMER_REQ (e.g., use by serial port B)
• TAT1R_A6TIMER_REQ (e.g., use by serial port C)
• TAT1R_A7TIMER_REQ (e.g., use by serial port D)
• TAT1R_BTIMER_REQ (e.g., use with PWM, servo or triac)
Either the new TAT1R setting value (0 to 255, inclusive), or the macro
TAT1R_RELEASE_REQ to release the TAT1R resource in use by the specified requestor.
RETURN VALUE
The new or current TAT1R setting. The caller should check their requested new TAT1R value against this return value. If the two values are not the same, the caller may decide the return value is acceptable after all and make another request using the previous return value. A valid release request always succeeds; in this case there is no need for the caller to check the return value.
LIBRARY sys.lib
520 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
tm_rd
int tm_rd( struct tm * t );
DESCRIPTION
Reads the current system time from SEC_TIMER into the structure t.
WARNING: The variable SEC_TIMER is initialized when a program is started. If you change the Real Time Clock (RTC), this variable will not be updated until you restart a program, and the tm_rd() function will not return the time that the RTC has been reset to. The read_rtc() function will read the actual RTC and can be used if necessary.
PARAMETERS t Pointer to structure to store time and date.
struct tm { char tm_sec; char tm_min; char tm_hour; char tm_mday; char tm_mon; char tm_year; char tm_wday;
};
// seconds 0-59
// 0-59
// 0-23
// 1-31
// 1-12
// 80-147 (1980-2047)
// 0-6 0==Sunday
RETURN VALUE
0 : Successful.
-1 : Clock read failed.
LIBRARY
RTCLOCK.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
521
tm_wr
int tm_wr( struct tm * t );
DESCRIPTION
Sets the system time from a tm struct. It is important to note that although tm_rd() reads the
SEC_TIMER variable, not the RTC, tm_wr() writes to the RTC directly, and SEC_TIMER is not changed until the program is restarted. The reason for this is so that the DelaySec() function continues to work correctly after setting the system time. To make tm_rd() match the new time written to the RTC without restarting the program, the following should be done: tm_wr(tm);
SEC_TIMER = mktime(tm);
But this could cause problems if a waitfor(DelaySec(n)) is pending completion in a cooperative multitasking program or if the SEC_TIMER variable is being used in another way the user, so user beware.
PARAMETERS t Pointer to structure to read date and time from.
struct tm { char tm_sec; char tm_min; char tm_hour; char tm_mday; char tm_mon; char tm_year; char tm_wday;
};
// seconds 0-59
// 0-59
// 0-23
// 1-31
// 1-12
// 80-147 (1980-2047)
// 0-6 0==Sunday
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success .
-1 : Failure.
LIBRARY
RTCLOCK.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
522 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
tolower
int tolower( int c );
DESCRIPTION
Convert alphabetic character to lower case.
PARAMETERS c Character to convert
RETURN VALUE
Lower case alphabetic character.
LIBRARY
STRING.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
toupper
int toupper( int c );
DESCRIPTION
Convert alphabetic character to uppercase.
PARAMETERS c Character to convert.
RETURN VALUE
Upper case alphabetic character.
LIBRARY
STRING.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
523
updateTimers
void updateTimers( void );
DESCRIPTION
Updates the values of TICK_TIMER, MS_TIMER, and SEC_TIMER while running off the 32 kHz oscillator. Since the periodic interrupt is disabled when running at 32 kHz, these values will not updated unless this function is called.
LIBRARY
SYS.LIB
SEE ALSO
use32kHzOsc
void use32kHzOsc( void );
DESCRIPTION
Sets the Rabbit processor to use the 32kHz real-time clock oscillator for both the CPU and peripheral clock, and shuts off the main oscillator. If this is already set, there is no effect. This mode should provide greatly reduced power consumption. Serial communications will be lost since typical baud rates cannot be made from a 32kHz clock. Also note that this function disables the periodic interrupt, so waitfor and related statements will not work properly (although costatements in general will still work). In addition, the values in TICK_TIMER,
MS_TIMER , and SEC_TIMER will not be updated unless you call the function updateTimers() frequently in your code. In addition, you will need to call hitwd() periodically to hit the hardware watchdog timer since the periodic interrupt normally handles that, or disable the watchdog timer before calling this function. The watchdog can be disabled with
Disable_HW_WDT() .
use32kHzOsc() is not task reentrant.
LIBRARY
SYS.LIB
SEE ALSO
524 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
useClockDivider
void useClockDivider( void );
DESCRIPTION
Sets the Rabbit processor to use the main oscillator divided by 8 for the CPU (but not the peripheral clock). If this is already set, there is no effect. Because the peripheral clock is not affected, serial communications should still work. This function also enables the periodic interrupt in case it was disabled by a call to use32kHzOsc().
This function is not task reentrant.
LIBRARY
SYS.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
525
useClockDivider3000
void useClockDivider3000( int setting );
DESCRIPTION
Sets the expanded clock divider options for the Rabbit 3000 processor. Target communications will be lost after changing this setting because of the baud rate change. This function also enables the periodic interrupt in case it was disabled by a call to user32kHzOsc().
The peripheral clock is also affected by this function. If you want to divide the main processor clock and not the peripheral clock, you may use the function useClockDivider() to divide the main processor clock by 8. To divide the main processor clock by any of the other allowable values (2, 4, or 6) means using useClockDivider3000() and thus dividing the peripheral clock as well.
This function is not task reentrant.
PARAMETER setting Divider setting. The following are valid:
• CLKDIV_2 - divide main processor clock by two
• CLKDIV_4 - divide main processor clock by four
• CLKDIV_6 - divide main processor clock by six
• CLKDIV_8 - divide main processor clock by eight
RETURN VALUE
None.
LIBRARY
SYS.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
526 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
useMainOsc
void useMainOsc( void );
DESCRIPTION
Sets the Rabbit processor to use the main oscillator for both the CPU and peripheral clock. If this is already set, there is no effect. This function also enables the periodic interrupt in case it was disabled by a call to use32kHzOsc(), and updates the TICK_TIMER, MS_TIMER, and
SEC_TIMER variables from the real-time clock. This function is not task reentrant.
LIBRARY
SYS.LIB
SEE ALSO
utoa
char * utoa( unsigned value, char * buf );
DESCRIPTION
Places up to 5 digit character string at *buf representing value of unsigned number. Suppresses leading zeros, but leaves one zero digit for value = 0. Max = 65535. 73 program bytes.
PARAMETERS value buf
16-bit number to convert.
Character string of converted number.
RETURN VALUE
Pointer to null at end of string.
LIBRARY
STDIO.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
527
vram2root
int vram2root( void * dest, int start, int length );
DESCRIPTION
This function copies data from the VBAT RAM. Tamper detection on the Rabbit 4000 erases the VBAT RAM with any attempt to enter bootstrap mode.
PARAMETERS dest start length
The address to which the data in the VBAT RAM will be copied.
The start location within the VBAT RAM (0-31).
The length of data to read from VBAT RAM. The length should be greater than 0.
The parameters length + start should not exceed 32.
LIBRARY
VBAT.LIB
SEE ALSO
528 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
VdGetFreeWd
int VdGetFreeWd( char count );
DESCRIPTION
Returns a free virtual watchdog and initializes that watchdog so that the virtual driver begins counting it down from count. The number of available virtual watchdogs is determined by the macro N_WATCHDOG, which is 10 by default. The default can be overridden by the user, e.g.,
#define N_WATCHDOG 11 .
The virtual driver is called every 0.00048828125 second. On every 128th call to it (i.e., every
62.5 ms), the virtual watchdogs are counted down and then tested. If any virtual watchdog reaches zero, this is a fatal error. Once a virtual watchdog is active, it should reset periodically with a call to VdHitWd() to prevent the count from readching zero.
PARAMETERS count 1 < count <= 255
RETURN VALUE
Integer id number of an unused virtual watchdog timer.
LIBRARY
VDRIVER.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
529
VdHitWd
int VdHitWd( int ndog );
DESCRIPTION
Resets virtual watchdog counter to N counts where N is the argument to the call to
VdGetFreeWd() that obtained the virtual watchdog ndog.
The virtual driver counts down watchdogs every 62.5 ms. If a virtual watchdog reaches 0, this is a fatal error. Once a virtual watchdog is active it should reset periodically with a call to
VdHitWd() to prevent this.
If N = 2, VdHitWd() will need to be called again for virtual watchdog ndog within 62.5 ms.
If N = 255, VdHitWd() will need to be called again for virtual watchdog ndog within
15.9375 seconds.
PARAMETERS ndog Id of virtual watchdog returned by VdGetFreeWd()
LIBRARY
VDRIVER.LIB
VdInit
void VdInit( void );
DESCRIPTION
Initializes the Virtual Driver for all Rabbit boards. Supports DelayMs(), DelaySec(),
DelayTick() . VdInit() is called by the BIOS unless it has been disabled.
LIBRARY
VDRIVER.LIB
530 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
VdReleaseWd
int VdReleaseWd( int ndog );
DESCRIPTION
Deactivates a virtual watchdog and makes it available for VdGetFreeWd().
PARAMETERS ndog Handle returned by VdGetFreeWd()
RETURN VALUE
0 : ndog out of range.
1 : Success.
LIBRARY
VDRIVER.LIB
EXAMPLE
// VdReleaseWd virtual watchdog example main() { int wd; unsigned long tm;
// handle for a virtual watchdog tm = SEC_TIMER; wd = VdGetFreeWd(255);
VdHitWd(wd);
// wd activated, 9 virtual watchdogs
// now available. wd must be hit
// at least every 15.875 seconds while(SEC_TIMER - tm < 60) { // let it run for a minute
// reset counter back to 255
}
VdReleaseWd(wd) // now 10 virtual watchdogs available
}
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
531
WriteFlash2
int WriteFlash2( unsigned long flashDst, void * rootSrc, unsigned len );
DESCRIPTION
Write len bytes from rootSrc to physical address flashDst on the 2nd flash device. The source must be in root. The flashDst address plus the sum of numbytes[] area must be within memory quadrant(s) already mapped to the second flash.
This function is not reentrant.
Note: This function should NOT be used if you are using the second flash device for a flash file system, e.g. if you are writing a TCP/IP-based application!
Note: This function is extremely dangerous when used with large sector flash. Don't do it.
PARAMETERS flashDst rootSrc len
Physical address of the flash destination
Pointer to the root source
Number of bytes to write
RETURN VALUE
0: Success.
-1 : Attempt to write non-2nd flash area, nothing written.
-2 : rootsrc not in root.
-3 : Time out while writing flash.
-4 : Attempt to write to ID block
-5 : Sector erase needed; write aborted
LIBRARY
XMEM.LIB
532 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
WriteFlash2Array
int WriteFlash2Array( unsigned long flashDst, void * rootSrc[], unsigned numbytes[], int numsources );
DESCRIPTION
Write a set of scattered information to the 2nd flash in a contiguous block. The sources are given in the rootSrc array, and the corresponding number of bytes in each source is given in the numbytes[] array. All sources must be in root. numsources specifies the number of entries in the rootSrc and numbytes arrays. The flashDst address plus the sum of numbytes[] area must be within memory quadrant(s) already mapped to the second flash.
This function is not reentrant. It was introduced in Dynamic C version 7.30.
Note: This function should NOT be used if you are using the second flash device for a flash file system, e.g. if you are writing a TCP/IP-based application!
Note: This function is extremely dangerous when used with large sector flash. Don't do it.
Note: The sum of the lengths in numbytes[] must not exceed 65535 bytes, else not all data will be written.
PARAMETERS flashDst rootSrc numbytes numsources
Physical address of the flash destination.
Array of pointers to the root sources.
Array of numbers of bytes to write for each source.
Number of sources specified in rootSrc[] and numbytes[].
RETURN VALUE
0: Success.
-1 : Attempt to write non-2nd flash area, nothing written.
-2 : rootsrc[] entry not in root.
-3 : Time-out while writing flash.
LIBRARY
XMEM.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
533
write_rtc
void write_rtc( unsigned long int time );
DESCRIPTION
Writes a 32 bit seconds value to the RTC, zeros other bits. This function does not stop or delay periodic interrupt. It does not affect the SEC_TIMER or MS_TIMER variables.
PARAMETERS time 32-bit value representing the number of seconds since January 1, 1980.
LIBRARY
RTCLOCK.LIB
SEE ALSO
534 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
writeUserBlock
int writeUserBlock( unsigned addr, void *source, unsigned numbytes );
DESCRIPTION
Rabbit-based boards have a System ID block located on the primary flash. (See the Rabbit Mi-
croprocessor Designer's Handbook for more information on the System ID block.) Version 2 and later of this ID block has a pointer to a User ID block: a place intended for storing calibration constants, passwords, and other non-volatile data.
The User block is recommended for storing all non-file data. The User block is where calibration constants are stored for boards with analog I/O. Space in the User block is limited to as small as (8K - sizeof(SysIDBlock)) bytes, or less, if there are calibration constants.
writeUserBlock() writes a number of bytes from root memory to the User block. This block is protected from normal writes to the flash device and can only be accessed through this function or the function writeUserBlockArray().
Using this function can cause all interrupts to be disabled for as long as 20 ms while a flash sector erases, depending on the flash type. A single call can produce as many as four of these erase delays. This will cause periodic interrupts to be missed, and can cause other interrupts to be missed as well. Therefore, it is best to buffer up data to be written rather than to do many writes.
While debugging, several consecutive calls to this function can cause a loss of target serial communications. This effect can be reduced by introducing delays between the calls, lowering the baud rate, or increasing the serial time-out value in the project file.
Note: See the manual for your particular board for more information before overwriting any part of the User block.
Note: When using a board with serial bootflash (e.g., RCM4300, RCM4310), writeUserBlock() should be called until it returns zero or a negative error code. A positive return value indicates that the SPI port needed by the serial flash is in use by another device. However, if using µC/OS-II and _SPI_USE_UCOS_MUTEX is #defined, then this function only needs to be called once. If the mutex times out waiting for the SPI port to free up, the run time error ERR_SPI_MUTEX_ERROR will occur. See the description for _rcm43_InitUCOSMutex() for more information on using µC/OS-II and
_SPI_USE_UCOS_MUTEX .
Backwards Compatibility:
If the version of the System ID block doesn't support the User ID block, or no System ID block is present, then 8K bytes starting 16K bytes from the top of the primary flash are designated the
User ID block area. However, to prevent errors arising from incompatible large sector configurations, this will only work if the flash type is small sector. Rabbit Semiconductor manufactured boards with large sector flash will have valid System and User ID blocks, so this should not be problem on Rabbit boards.
If users create boards with large sector flash, they must install System ID blocks version 2 or greater to use or modify this function.
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
535
writeUserBlock (cont’d)
PARAMETERS addr source numbytes
Address offset in User block to write to.
Pointer to source to copy data from.
Number of bytes to copy.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Successful
-1 : Invalid address or range
The return values below are new with Dynamic C 10.21:
-2 : No valid user block found (block version 3 or later)
-3 : flash writing error
The return values below are applicable only if _SPI_USE_UCOS_MUTEX is not #defined:
-ETIME : (Serial flash only, time out waiting for SPI) postive N: (Serial flash only, SPI in use by device N)
LIBRARY
IDBLOCK.LIB
SEE ALSO
536 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
writeUserBlockArray
int writeUserBlockArray( unsigned addr, void * sources[], unsigned numbytes[], int numsources );
DESCRIPTION
Rabbit Semiconductor boards are released with System ID blocks located on the primary flash.
Version 2 and later of this ID block has a pointer to a User block that can be used for storing calibration constants, passwords, and other non-volatile data. The User block is protected from normal write to the flash device and can only be accessed through this function or writeUserBlock() .
This function writes a set of scattered data from root memory to the User block. If the data to be written are in contiguous bytes, using the function writeUserBlock()is sufficient. Use of writeUserBlockArray() is recommended when the data to be written is in noncontiguous bytes, as may be the case for something like network configuration data.
See the designer’s handbook for your Rabbit processor (e.g., the Rabbit 4000 Designer's Hand-
book) for more information about the System ID and User blocks.
Note: Portions of the User block may be used by the BIOS for your board to store values, e.g., calibration constants. See the manual for your particular board for more information before overwriting any part of the User block.
Note: When using a board with serial bootflash (e.g., RCM4300, RCM4310), writeUserBlockArray() should be called until it returns zero or a negative error code. A positive return value indicates that the SPI port needed by the serial flash is in use by another device. However, if using µC/OS-II and _SPI_USE_UCOS_MUTEX is
#defined, then this function only needs to be called once. If the mutex times out waiting for the SPI port to free up, the run time error ERR_SPI_MUTEX_ERROR will occur. See the description for _rcm43_InitUCOSMutex() for more information on using
µC/OS-II and _SPI_USE_UCOS_MUTEX.
Backwards Compatibility:
If the System ID block on the board doesn't support the User block, or no System ID block is present, then the 8K bytes starting 16K bytes from the top of the primary flash are designated
User block area. This only works if the flash type is small sector. Rabbit manufactured boards with large sector flash will have valid System ID and User blocks, so is not a problem on Rabbit boards. If users create boards with large sector flash, they must install System ID blocks version
3 or greater to use this function, or modify this function.
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
537
writeUserBlockArray
PARAMETERS addr sources numbytes numsources
Address offset in User block to write to.
Array of pointer to sources to copy data from.
Array of number of bytes to copy for each source. The sum of the lengths in this array must not exceed 32767 bytes, or an error will be returned.
Number of data sources.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Successful.
-1 : Invalid address or range.
-2 : No valid User block found (block version 3 or later).
-3 : Flash writing error.
The return values below are applicable only if _SPI_USE_UCOS_MUTEX is not #defined:
-ETIME : (Serial flash only, time out waiting for SPI) postive N: (Serial flash only, SPI in use by device N)
LIBRARY
IDBLOCK.LIB
538 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
WrPortE
void WrPortE( unsigned int port, char * portshadow, int data_value);
DESCRIPTION
Writes an external I/O register with 8 bits and updates shadow for that register. The variable names must be of the form port and portshadow for the most efficient operation. A null pointer may be substituted if shadow support is not desired or needed.
PARAMETERS port portshadow data_value
Address of external data register.
Reference pointer to a variable shadowing the register data. Substitute with null pointer (or 0) if shadowing is not required.
Value to be written to the data register
LIBRARY
SYSIO.LIB
SEE ALSO
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
539
WrPortI
void WrPortI( int port, char * portshadow, int data_value );
DESCRIPTION
Writes an internal I/O register with 8 bits and updates shadow for that register.
PARAMETERS port portshadow data_value
Address of data register.
Reference pointer to a variable shadowing the register data. Substitute with null pointer (or 0) if shadowing is not required.
Value to be written to the data register
LIBRARY
SYSIO.LIB
SEE ALSO
540 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
xalloc
long xalloc( long sz );
DESCRIPTION
Allocates the specified number of bytes in extended memory. Starting with Dynamic C version
7.04P3, the returned address is always even (word) aligned.
Starting with Dynamic C 8, if xalloc() fails, a run-time error will occur. This is a wrapper function for _xalloc(), for backwards compatibility. It is the same as _xalloc(&sz, 1,
XALLOC_MAYBBB) except that the actual allocated amount is not returned since the parameter is not a pointer.
Starting with Dynamic C 9.30, xalloc() and related functions were modified so that they are now driven by the compiler origin directives.
Note: xalloc() is not thread safe since it accesses a global static structure with no locking.
PARAMETERS sz Number of bytes to allocate. This is rounded up to the next higher even number.
RETURN VALUE
The 20-bit physical address of the allocated data: Success.
0 : Failure.
Note: Starting with Dynamic C 8, a run-time exception will occur if the function fails.
LIBRARY
STACK.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
541
_xalloc
long _xalloc( long * sz, word align, word type );
DESCRIPTION
Allocates memory in extended memory. If _xalloc() fails, a runtime error will occur.
PARAMETERS sz align type
On entry, pointer to the number of bytes to allocate. On return, the pointedto value will be updated with the actual number of bytes allocated. This may be larger than requested if an odd number of bytes was requested, or if some space was wasted at the end because of alignment restrictions.
Storage alignment as the log (base 2) of the desired returned memory starting address. For example, if this parameter is “8,” then the returned address will align on a 256-byte boundary. Values between 0 and 16 inclusive are allowed. Any other value is treated as zero, i.e., no required alignment.
This parameter is only meaningful on boards with more than one type of RAM. For example, boards with a fast RAM and a slower battery-backed RAM like the RCM3200 or RCM3300 Use one of the following values, any other value will have undefined results.
• XALLOC_ANY (0) - any type of SRAM storage allowed
• XALLOC_BB (1) - must be battery-backed program execution SRAM
(a.k.a., fast RAM).
• XALLOC_NOTBB (2) - return non-BB SRAM only.
• XALLOC_MAYBBB (3) - return non-BB SRAM in preference to BB.
RETURN VALUE
The 20-bit physical address of the allocated data on success. On error, a runtime error occurs.
Note: This return value cannot be used with pointer arithmetic.
LIBRARY
STACK.LIB
EXCEPTIONS
ERR_BADXALLOC - if could not allocate requested storage, or negative size passed.
542 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
xalloc_stats
void xalloc_stats( word parm );
DESCRIPTION
Prints a table of available xalloc() regions to the Stdio window.
This function was introduced in Dynamic C version 8. It is for debugging and educational purposes. It should not be called in a production program.
PARAMETERS parm Prior to Dynamic C version 9.30: reserved for future use. Set to 0.
Starting with DC 9.30: this parameter is of type long. It is the address of the data structure xbreak_t and must not be 0.
LIBRARY
MEM.LIB (XMEM.LIB prior to DC 9.30)
SEE ALSO
,
,
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
543
xavail
long xavail( long * addr_ptr );
DESCRIPTION
Returns the maximum length of memory that may be successfully obtained by an immediate call to xalloc(), and optionally allocates that amount.
This function was introduced in Dynamic C version 7.04P3.
PARAMETERS addr_ptr Pointer to a long word in root data memory to store the address of the block. If this pointer is null, then the block is not allocated. Otherwise, the block is allocated as if by a call to xalloc().
RETURN VALUE
The size of the largest free block available. If this is zero, then *addr_ptr will not be changed.
LIBRARY
XMEM.LIB (was in STACK.LIB prior to DC 8)
SEE ALSO
544 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
_xavail
long _xavail( long * addr_ptr, word align, word type );
DESCRIPTION
Returns the maximum length of memory that may be successfully obtained by an immediate call to _xalloc(), and optionally allocates that amount. The align and type parameters are the same as would be presented to _xalloc().
PARAMETERS addr_ptr align type
Address of a longword, in root data memory, to store the address of the block. If this pointer is null, then the block is not allocated. Otherwise, the block is allocated as if by a call to _xalloc().
Alignment of returned block, as per _xalloc().
Type of memory, as per _xalloc().
RETURN VALUE
The size of the largest free block available. If this is zero, then *addr_ptr will not be changed.
LIBRARY
XMEM.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
,
,
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
545
xCalculateECC256
long xCalculateECC256( unsigned long data );
DESCRIPTION
Calculates a 3 byte Error Correcting Checksum (ECC, 1 bit correction and 2 bit detection capability) value for a 256 byte (2048 bit) data buffer located in extended memory.
PARAMETERS data Physical address of the 256 byte data buffer.
RETURN VALUE
The calculated ECC in the 3 LSBs of the long (i.e., BCDE) result. Note that the MSB (i.e., B) of the long result is always zero.
LIBRARY
ECC.LIB (This function was introduced in Dynamic C 9.01)
546 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
xChkCorrectECC256
int xChkCorrectECC256( unsigned long data, void * old_ecc, void * new_ecc );
DESCRIPTION
Checks the old versus new ECC values for a 256 byte (2048 bit) data buffer, and if necessary and possible (1 bit correction, 2 bit detection), corrects the data in the specified extended memory buffer.
PARAMETERS data old_ecc new_ecc
Physical address of the 256 byte data buffer
Pointer to the old (original) 3 byte ECC's buffer
Pointer to the new (current) 3 byte ECC's buffer
RETURN VALUE
0 : Data and ECC are good (no correction is necessary)
1 : Data is corrected and ECC is good
2 : Data is good and ECC is corrected
3 : Data and/or ECC are bad and uncorrectable
LIBRARY
ECC.LIB (This function was introduced in Dynamic C 9.01)
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
547
xgetfloat
float xgetfloat( long src );
DESCRIPTION
Returns the float pointed to by src. This is the most efficient function for obtaining 4 bytes from xmem.
PARAMETERS src xmem (linear) address of the float value to retrieve.
RETURN VALUE float value (4 bytes) at src.
LIBRARY
XMEM.LIB
xgetint
int xgetint( long src );
DESCRIPTION
Returns the integer pointed to by src. This is the most efficient function for obtaining 2 bytes from xmem.
PARAMETERS src xmem (linear) address of the integer value to retrieve.
RETURN VALUE
Integer value (2-bytes) at src.
LIBRARY
XMEM.LIB
548 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
xgetlong
long xgetlong( long src );
DESCRIPTION
Return the long word pointed to by src. This is the most efficient function for obtaining 4 bytes from xmem.
PARAMETERS src xmem (linear) address of the long value to retrieve.
RETURN VALUE
Long integer value (4 bytes) at src.
LIBRARY
XMEM.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
549
xmem2root
int xmem2root( void * dest, unsigned long int src, unsigned int len );
DESCRIPTION
Stores len characters from physical address src to logical address dest.
PARAMETERS dest src len
Logical address
Physical address
Numbers of bytes
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success.
-1 : Attempt to write flash memory area, nothing written.
-2 : Destination not all in root.
LIBRARY
XMEM.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
550 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
xmem2xmem
int xmem2xmem( unsigned long dest, unsigned long src, unsigned len );
DESCRIPTION
Stores len characters from physical address src to physical address dest.
PARAMETERS dest src len
Physical address of destination
Physical address of source data
Length of source data in bytes
RETURN VALUE
0 : Success.
-1 : Attempt to write flash memory area, nothing written.
LIBRARY
XMEM.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
551
xmemchr
long xmemchr( long src, char ch, unsigned short n );
DESCRIPTION
Search for the first occurrence of character ch in the xmem area pointed to by src.
PARAMETERS src ch n xmem (linear) address of the first character to search.
Character to search for.
Maximum number of characters to search.
RETURN VALUE
0 : Character was not found within n bytes from the start.
>0 : Physical address of the first character that matched ch.
LIBRARY
XMEM.LIB
552 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
xmemcmp
int xmemcmp( long xstr, char * str, unsigned short n );
DESCRIPTION
Test whether xmem string at xstr matches the root memory string at str. n bytes are compared.
PARAMETERS xstr str n
RETURN VALUE
0 : Exact match.
>0 : xstr > str
<0 : xstr < str xmem (linear) address of the first character of the first string to compare.
root address of the first character of the second string to compare.
Length of each string. If n is zero, returns zero. n must be less than or equal
4097.
LIBRARY
XMEM.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
553
xrelease
void xrelease( long addr, long sz );
DESCRIPTION
Release a block of memory previously obtained by xalloc() or by xavail() with a nonnull parameter. xrelease() may only be called to free the most recent block obtained. It is
NOT a general-purpose malloc/free type of dynamic memory allocation. Calls to xalloc() /xrelease() must be nested in first-allocated/last-released order, similar to the execution stack. The addr parameter must be the return value from xalloc(). If not, then a run-time exception will occur. The sz parameter must also be equal to the actual allocated size, however this is not checked. The actual allocated size may be larger than the requested size (because of alignment overhead). The actual size may be obtained by calling _xalloc() rather than xalloc(). For this reason, it is recommended that your application consistently uses
_xalloc() rather than xalloc() if you intend to use this function.
PARAMETERS addr sz
Address of storage previously obtained by _xalloc().
Size of storage previously returned by _xalloc().
LIBRARY
XMEM.LIB
SEE ALSO
,
,
,
,
554 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
xsetint
void xsetint( long dst, int val );
DESCRIPTION
Set the integer pointed to by dst. This is the most efficient function for writing two bytes to xmem.
PARAMETERS dst val xmem (linear) address of the int value to set.
value to store into the above location.
RETURN VALUE
None
LIBRARY
XMEM.LIB
xsetfloat
void xsetfloat( long dst, float val );
DESCRIPTION
Set the float pointed to by dst. This is the most efficient function for writing 4 bytes to xmem.
PARAMETERS dst val xmem (linear) address of the float value to set.
value to store into the above location.
RETURN VALUE
None
LIBRARY
XMEM.LIB
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
555
xsetlong
void xsetlong( long dst, long val );
DESCRIPTION
Set the long integer pointed to by dst. This is the most efficient function for writing 4 bytes to xmem.
PARAMETERS dst val xmem (linear) address of the long integer value to set.
value to store into the above location.
RETURN VALUE
None
LIBRARY
XMEM.LIB
xstrlen
unsigned int xstrlen( long src );
DESCRIPTION
Return the length of the string in xmem pointed to by src. If there is no null terminator within the first 65536 bytes of the string, then the return value will be meaningless.
PARAMETERS src xmem (linear) address of the first character of the string. Note: to perform a normal null-terminated search, ensure that src is in the range 0..2
20-1
.
If the MSB of src is not zero (i.e., bits 24-31) then that character will be used to terminate the search rather than the standard null terminator. E.g., to determine the length of a string terminated by '@': xstrlen(paddr(my_str) | (long)'@' << 24);
RETURN VALUE
Length of string, not counting the terminator.
LIBRARY
XMEM.LIB
556 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
Software License Agreement
RABBIT
®
SOFTWARE END USER LICENSE
AGREEMENT
IMPORTANT-READ CAREFULLY: BY INSTALLING, COPYING OR OTHERWISE USING THE
ENCLOSED RABBIT DYNAMIC C SOFTWARE, WHICH INCLUDES COMPUTER SOFTWARE
("SOFTWARE") AND MAY INCLUDE ASSOCIATED MEDIA, PRINTED MATERIALS, AND
"ONLINE" OR ELECTRONIC DOCUMENTATION ("DOCUMENTATION"), YOU (ON BEHALF OF
YOURSELF OR AS AN AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE ON BEHALF OF AN ENTITY) AGREE
TO ALL THE TERMS OF THIS END USER LICENSE AGREEMENT ("LICENSE") REGARDING
YOUR USE OF THE SOFTWARE. IF YOU DO NOT AGREE WITH ALL OF THE TERMS OF THIS
LICENSE, DO NOT INSTALL, COPY OR OTHERWISE USE THE SOFTWARE AND IMMEDI-
ATELY CONTACT RABBIT FOR RETURN OF THE SOFTWARE AND A REFUND OF THE PUR-
CHASE PRICE FOR THE SOFTWARE.
We are sorry about the formality of the language below, which our lawyers tell us we need to include to protect our legal rights. If You have any questions, write or call Rabbit at (530) 757-4616, 2900 Spafford
Street, Davis, California 95616.
1. Definitions. In addition to the definitions stated in the first paragraph of this document, capitalized words used in this License shall have the following meanings:
1.1 "Qualified Applications" means an application program developed using the Software and that links with the development libraries of the Software.
1.1.1 "Qualified Applications" is amended to include application programs developed using the Softools WinIDE program for Rabbit processors available from Softools, Inc.
1.1.2 The MicroC/OS-II (µC/OS-II) library and sample code and the Point-to-Point Protocol (PPP) library are not included in this amendment.
1.1.3 Excluding the exceptions in 1.1.2, library and sample code provided with the Software may be modified for use with the Softools WinIDE program in Qualified Systems as defined in 1.2. All other Restrictions specified by this license agreement remain in force.
1.2 "Qualified Systems" means a microprocessor-based computer system which is either (i) manufactured by, for or under license from Rabbit, or (ii) based on the Rabbit 2000 microprocessor, the
Rabbit 3000 microprocessor, the Rabbit 4000 microprocessor, or any other Rabbit microprocessor. Qualified Systems may not be (a) designed or intended to be re-programmable by your customer using the Software, or (b) competitive with Rabbit products, except as otherwise stated in a written agreement between Rabbit and the system manufacturer. Such written agreement may require an end user to pay run time royalties to Rabbit.
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
557
2. License. Rabbit grants to You a nonexclusive, nontransferable license to (i) use and reproduce the Software, solely for internal purposes and only for the number of users for which You have purchased licenses for (the "Users") and not for redistribution or resale; (ii) use and reproduce the Software solely to develop the Qualified Applications; and (iii) use, reproduce and distribute, the Qualified Applications, in object code only, to end users solely for use on Qualified Systems; provided, however, any agreement entered into between You and such end users with respect to a Qualified Application is no less protective of Rabbit’s intellectual property rights than the terms and conditions of this License. (iv) use and distribute with Qualified Applications and Qualified Systems the program files distributed with
Dynamic C named RFU.EXE, PILOT.BIN, and COLDLOAD.BIN in their unaltered forms.
3. Restrictions. Except as otherwise stated, You may not, nor permit anyone else to, decompile, reverse engineer, disassemble or otherwise attempt to reconstruct or discover the source code of the Software, alter, merge, modify, translate, adapt in any way, prepare any derivative work based upon the Software, rent, lease network, loan, distribute or otherwise transfer the Software or any copy thereof. You shall not make copies of the copyrighted Software and/or documentation without the prior written permission of Rabbit; provided that, You may make one (1) hard copy of such documentation for each User and a reasonable number of back-up copies for Your own archival purposes. You may not use copies of the Software as part of a benchmark or comparison test against other similar products in order to produce results strictly for purposes of comparison. The Software contains copyrighted material, trade secrets and other proprietary material of Rabbit and/or its licensors and You must reproduce, on each copy of the Software, all copyright notices and any other proprietary legends that appear on or in the original copy of the Software. Except for the limited license granted above, Rabbit retains all right, title and interest in and to all intellectual property rights embodied in the Software, including but not limited to, patents, copyrights and trade secrets.
4. Export Law Assurances. You agree and certify that neither the Software nor any other technical data received from Rabbit, nor the direct product thereof, will be exported outside the United States or reexported except as authorized and as permitted by the laws and regulations of the United States and/or the laws and regulations of the jurisdiction, (if other than the United States) in which You rightfully obtained the Software. The Software may not be exported to any of the following countries: Cuba, Iran,
Iraq, Libya, North Korea, Sudan, or Syria.
5. Government End Users. If You are acquiring the Software on behalf of any unit or agency of the
United States Government, the following provisions apply. The Government agrees: (i) if the Software is supplied to the Department of Defense ("DOD"), the Software is classified as "Commercial Computer Software" and the Government is acquiring only "restricted rights" in the Software and its documentation as that term is defined in Clause 252.227-7013(c)(1) of the DFARS; and (ii) if the Software is supplied to any unit or agency of the United States Government other than DOD, the Government's rights in the Software and its documentation will be as defined in Clause 52.227-19(c)(2) of the FAR or, in the case of NASA, in Clause 18-52.227-86(d) of the NASA Supplement to the FAR.
558 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
6. Disclaimer of Warranty. You expressly acknowledge and agree that the use of the Software and its documentation is at Your sole risk. THE SOFTWARE, DOCUMENTATION, AND TECHNICAL
SUPPORT ARE PROVIDED ON AN "AS IS" BASIS AND WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY
KIND. Information regarding any third party services included in this package is provided as a convenience only, without any warranty by Rabbit, and will be governed solely by the terms agreed upon between You and the third party providing such services. RABBIT AND ITS LICENSORS
EXPRESSLY DISCLAIM ALL WARRANTIES, EXPRESS, IMPLIED, STATUTORY OR OTHER-
WISE, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANT-
ABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NON-INFRINGEMENT OF THIRD
PARTY RIGHTS. RABBIT DOES NOT WARRANT THAT THE FUNCTIONS CONTAINED IN
THE SOFTWARE WILL MEET YOUR REQUIREMENTS, OR THAT THE OPERATION OF THE
SOFTWARE WILL BE UNINTERRUPTED OR ERROR-FREE, OR THAT DEFECTS IN THE
SOFTWARE WILL BE CORRECTED. FURTHERMORE, RABBIT DOES NOT WARRANT OR
MAKE ANY REPRESENTATIONS REGARDING THE USE OR THE RESULTS OF THE SOFT-
WARE IN TERMS OF ITS CORRECTNESS, ACCURACY, RELIABILITY OR OTHERWISE. NO
ORAL OR WRITTEN INFORMATION OR ADVICE GIVEN BY RABBIT OR ITS AUTHORIZED
REPRESENTATIVES SHALL CREATE A WARRANTY OR IN ANY WAY INCREASE THE
SCOPE OF THIS WARRANTY. SOME JURISDICTIONS DO NOT ALLOW THE EXCLUSION OF
IMPLIED WARRANTIES, SO THE ABOVE EXCLUSION MAY NOT APPLY TO YOU.
7. Limitation of Liability. YOU AGREE THAT UNDER NO CIRCUMSTANCES, INCLUDING NEG-
LIGENCE, SHALL RABBIT BE LIABLE FOR ANY INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL OR CONSEQUEN-
TIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING DAMAGES FOR LOSS OF BUSINESS PROFITS, BUSINESS
INTERRUPTION, LOSS OF BUSINESS INFORMATION AND THE LIKE) ARISING OUT OF
THE USE AND/OR INABILITY TO USE THE SOFTWARE, EVEN IF RABBIT OR ITS AUTHO-
RIZED REPRESENTATIVE HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
SOME JURISDICTIONS DO NOT ALLOW THE LIMITATION OR EXCLUSION OF LIABILITY
FOR INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES SO THE ABOVE LIMITATION OR
EXCLUSION MAY NOT APPLY TO YOU. IN NO EVENT SHALL RABBIT’S TOTAL LIABILITY
TO YOU FOR ALL DAMAGES, LOSSES, AND CAUSES OF ACTION (WHETHER IN CON-
TRACT, TORT, INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE, OR OTHERWISE) EXCEED THE AMOUNT PAID
BY YOU FOR THE SOFTWARE.
8. Termination. This License is effective for the duration of the copyright in the Software unless terminated. You may terminate this License at any time by destroying all copies of the Software and its documentation. This License will terminate immediately without notice from Rabbit if You fail to comply with any provision of this License. Upon termination, You must destroy all copies of the Software and its documentation. Except for Section 2 ("License"), all Sections of this Agreement shall survive any expiration or termination of this License.
Dynamic C Functions rabbit.com
559
9. General Provisions. No delay or failure to take action under this License will constitute a waiver unless expressly waived in writing, signed by a duly authorized representative of Rabbit, and no single waiver will constitute a continuing or subsequent waiver. This License may not be assigned, sublicensed or otherwise transferred by You, by operation of law or otherwise, without Rabbit's prior written consent.
This License shall be governed by and construed in accordance with the laws of the United States and the State of California, exclusive of the conflicts of laws principles. The United Nations Convention on
Contracts for the International Sale of Goods shall not apply to this License. If for any reason a court of competent jurisdiction finds any provision of this License, or portion thereof, to be unenforceable, that provision of the License shall be enforced to the maximum extent permissible so as to affect the intent of the parties, and the remainder of this License shall continue in full force and effect. This License constitutes the entire agreement between the parties with respect to the use of the Software and its documentation, and supersedes all prior or contemporaneous understandings or agreements, written or oral, regarding such subject matter. There shall be no contract for purchase or sale of the Software except upon the terms and conditions specified herein. Any additional or different terms or conditions proposed by You or contained in any purchase order are hereby rejected and shall be of no force and effect unless expressly agreed to in writing by Rabbit. No amendment to or modification of this License will be binding unless in writing and signed by a duly authorized representative of Rabbit.
Digi International Inc. © 2008 • All rights reserved.
560 rabbit.com
Dynamic C Functions
